Provided by: qemu-system-common_6.2+dfsg-2ubuntu6.24_amd64 bug

NAME

       qemu-qmp-ref - QEMU QMP Reference Manual

   ContentsQEMU QMP Reference ManualIntroductionThis document describes all commands currently supported by QMP.Stability ConsiderationsThe  current  QMP command set (described in this file) may be useful for a number of
             use cases, however it's limited and several commands  have  bad  defined  semantics,
             specially with regard to command completion.QMP errorsQapiErrorClass (Enum)Common data typesIoOperationType (Enum)OnOffAuto (Enum)OnOffSplit (Enum)String (Object)StrOrNull (Alternate)OffAutoPCIBAR (Enum)PCIELinkSpeed (Enum)PCIELinkWidth (Enum)HostMemPolicy (Enum)NetFilterDirection (Enum)GrabToggleKeys (Enum)HumanReadableText (Object)Socket data typesNetworkAddressFamily (Enum)InetSocketAddressBase (Object)InetSocketAddress (Object)UnixSocketAddress (Object)VsockSocketAddress (Object)InetSocketAddressWrapper (Object)UnixSocketAddressWrapper (Object)VsockSocketAddressWrapper (Object)StringWrapper (Object)SocketAddressLegacy (Object)SocketAddressType (Enum)SocketAddress (Object)VM run stateRunState (Enum)ShutdownCause (Enum)StatusInfo (Object)query-status (Command)SHUTDOWN (Event)POWERDOWN (Event)RESET (Event)STOP (Event)RESUME (Event)SUSPEND (Event)SUSPEND_DISK (Event)WAKEUP (Event)WATCHDOG (Event)WatchdogAction (Enum)RebootAction (Enum)ShutdownAction (Enum)PanicAction (Enum)watchdog-set-action (Command)set-action (Command)GUEST_PANICKED (Event)GUEST_CRASHLOADED (Event)GuestPanicAction (Enum)GuestPanicInformationType (Enum)GuestPanicInformation (Object)GuestPanicInformationHyperV (Object)S390CrashReason (Enum)GuestPanicInformationS390 (Object)MEMORY_FAILURE (Event)MemoryFailureRecipient (Enum)MemoryFailureAction (Enum)MemoryFailureFlags (Object)CryptographyQCryptoTLSCredsEndpoint (Enum)QCryptoSecretFormat (Enum)QCryptoHashAlgorithm (Enum)QCryptoCipherAlgorithm (Enum)QCryptoCipherMode (Enum)QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm (Enum)QCryptoBlockFormat (Enum)QCryptoBlockOptionsBase (Object)QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow (Object)QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS (Object)QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS (Object)QCryptoBlockOpenOptions (Object)QCryptoBlockCreateOptions (Object)QCryptoBlockInfoBase (Object)QCryptoBlockInfoLUKSSlot (Object)QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS (Object)QCryptoBlockInfo (Object)QCryptoBlockLUKSKeyslotState (Enum)QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS (Object)QCryptoBlockAmendOptions (Object)SecretCommonProperties (Object)SecretProperties (Object)SecretKeyringProperties (Object)TlsCredsProperties (Object)TlsCredsAnonProperties (Object)TlsCredsPskProperties (Object)TlsCredsX509Properties (Object)Block devicesBlock core (VM unrelated)Background jobsAdditional block stuff (VM related)Block device exportsCharacter devicesChardevInfo (Object)query-chardev (Command)ChardevBackendInfo (Object)query-chardev-backends (Command)DataFormat (Enum)ringbuf-write (Command)ringbuf-read (Command)ChardevCommon (Object)ChardevFile (Object)ChardevHostdev (Object)ChardevSocket (Object)ChardevUdp (Object)ChardevMux (Object)ChardevStdio (Object)ChardevSpiceChannel (Object)ChardevSpicePort (Object)ChardevVC (Object)ChardevRingbuf (Object)ChardevQemuVDAgent (Object)ChardevBackendKind (Enum)ChardevFileWrapper (Object)ChardevHostdevWrapper (Object)ChardevSocketWrapper (Object)ChardevUdpWrapper (Object)ChardevCommonWrapper (Object)ChardevMuxWrapper (Object)ChardevStdioWrapper (Object)ChardevSpiceChannelWrapper (Object)ChardevSpicePortWrapper (Object)ChardevQemuVDAgentWrapper (Object)ChardevVCWrapper (Object)ChardevRingbufWrapper (Object)ChardevBackend (Object)ChardevReturn (Object)chardev-add (Command)chardev-change (Command)chardev-remove (Command)chardev-send-break (Command)VSERPORT_CHANGE (Event)Dump guest memoryDumpGuestMemoryFormat (Enum)dump-guest-memory (Command)DumpStatus (Enum)DumpQueryResult (Object)query-dump (Command)DUMP_COMPLETED (Event)DumpGuestMemoryCapability (Object)query-dump-guest-memory-capability (Command)Net devicesset_link (Command)netdev_add (Command)netdev_del (Command)NetLegacyNicOptions (Object)NetdevUserOptions (Object)NetdevTapOptions (Object)NetdevSocketOptions (Object)NetdevL2TPv3Options (Object)NetdevVdeOptions (Object)NetdevBridgeOptions (Object)NetdevHubPortOptions (Object)NetdevNetmapOptions (Object)NetdevVhostUserOptions (Object)NetdevVhostVDPAOptions (Object)NetClientDriver (Enum)Netdev (Object)RxState (Enum)RxFilterInfo (Object)query-rx-filter (Command)NIC_RX_FILTER_CHANGED (Event)AnnounceParameters (Object)announce-self (Command)FAILOVER_NEGOTIATED (Event)RDMA deviceRDMA_GID_STATUS_CHANGED (Event)Rocker switch deviceRockerSwitch (Object)query-rocker (Command)RockerPortDuplex (Enum)RockerPortAutoneg (Enum)RockerPort (Object)query-rocker-ports (Command)RockerOfDpaFlowKey (Object)RockerOfDpaFlowMask (Object)RockerOfDpaFlowAction (Object)RockerOfDpaFlow (Object)query-rocker-of-dpa-flows (Command)RockerOfDpaGroup (Object)query-rocker-of-dpa-groups (Command)TPM (trusted platform module) devicesTpmModel (Enum)query-tpm-models (Command)TpmType (Enum)query-tpm-types (Command)TPMPassthroughOptions (Object)TPMEmulatorOptions (Object)TPMPassthroughOptionsWrapper (Object)TPMEmulatorOptionsWrapper (Object)TpmTypeOptions (Object)TPMInfo (Object)query-tpm (Command)Remote desktopset_password (Command)expire_password (Command)screendump (Command)SpiceVNCInputMouseInfo (Object)query-mice (Command)QKeyCode (Enum)KeyValueKind (Enum)IntWrapper (Object)QKeyCodeWrapper (Object)KeyValue (Object)send-key (Command)InputButton (Enum)InputAxis (Enum)InputKeyEvent (Object)InputBtnEvent (Object)InputMoveEvent (Object)InputEventKind (Enum)InputKeyEventWrapper (Object)InputBtnEventWrapper (Object)InputMoveEventWrapper (Object)InputEvent (Object)input-send-event (Command)DisplayGTK (Object)DisplayEGLHeadless (Object)DisplayGLMode (Enum)DisplayCurses (Object)DisplayType (Enum)DisplayOptions (Object)query-display-options (Command)DisplayReloadType (Enum)DisplayReloadOptionsVNC (Object)DisplayReloadOptions (Object)display-reload (Command)User authorizationQAuthZListPolicy (Enum)QAuthZListFormat (Enum)QAuthZListRule (Object)AuthZListProperties (Object)AuthZListFileProperties (Object)AuthZPAMProperties (Object)AuthZSimpleProperties (Object)MigrationMigrationStats (Object)XBZRLECacheStats (Object)CompressionStats (Object)MigrationStatus (Enum)VfioStats (Object)MigrationInfo (Object)query-migrate (Command)MigrationCapability (Enum)MigrationCapabilityStatus (Object)migrate-set-capabilities (Command)query-migrate-capabilities (Command)MultiFDCompression (Enum)BitmapMigrationBitmapAliasTransform (Object)BitmapMigrationBitmapAlias (Object)BitmapMigrationNodeAlias (Object)MigrationParameter (Enum)MigrateSetParameters (Object)migrate-set-parameters (Command)MigrationParameters (Object)query-migrate-parameters (Command)client_migrate_info (Command)migrate-start-postcopy (Command)MIGRATION (Event)MIGRATION_PASS (Event)COLOMessage (Enum)COLOMode (Enum)FailoverStatus (Enum)COLO_EXIT (Event)COLOExitReason (Enum)x-colo-lost-heartbeat (Command)migrate_cancel (Command)migrate-continue (Command)migrate (Command)migrate-incoming (Command)xen-save-devices-state (Command)xen-set-global-dirty-log (Command)xen-load-devices-state (Command)xen-set-replication (Command)ReplicationStatus (Object)query-xen-replication-status (Command)xen-colo-do-checkpoint (Command)COLOStatus (Object)query-colo-status (Command)migrate-recover (Command)migrate-pause (Command)UNPLUG_PRIMARY (Event)DirtyRateVcpu (Object)DirtyRateStatus (Enum)DirtyRateMeasureMode (Enum)DirtyRateInfo (Object)calc-dirty-rate (Command)query-dirty-rate (Command)snapshot-save (Command)snapshot-load (Command)snapshot-delete (Command)TransactionsAbort (Object)ActionCompletionMode (Enum)TransactionActionKind (Enum)AbortWrapper (Object)BlockDirtyBitmapAddWrapper (Object)BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper (Object)BlockDirtyBitmapMergeWrapper (Object)BlockdevBackupWrapper (Object)BlockdevSnapshotWrapper (Object)BlockdevSnapshotInternalWrapper (Object)BlockdevSnapshotSyncWrapper (Object)DriveBackupWrapper (Object)TransactionAction (Object)TransactionProperties (Object)transaction (Command)TracingTraceEventState (Enum)TraceEventInfo (Object)trace-event-get-state (Command)trace-event-set-state (Command)Compatibility policyCompatPolicyInput (Enum)CompatPolicyOutput (Enum)CompatPolicy (Object)QMP monitor controlqmp_capabilities (Command)QMPCapability (Enum)VersionTriple (Object)VersionInfo (Object)query-version (Command)CommandInfo (Object)query-commands (Command)quit (Command)MonitorMode (Enum)MonitorOptions (Object)QMP introspectionquery-qmp-schema (Command)SchemaMetaType (Enum)SchemaInfo (Object)SchemaInfoBuiltin (Object)JSONType (Enum)SchemaInfoEnum (Object)SchemaInfoEnumMember (Object)SchemaInfoArray (Object)SchemaInfoObject (Object)SchemaInfoObjectMember (Object)SchemaInfoObjectVariant (Object)SchemaInfoAlternate (Object)SchemaInfoAlternateMember (Object)SchemaInfoCommand (Object)SchemaInfoEvent (Object)QEMU Object Model (QOM)ObjectPropertyInfo (Object)qom-list (Command)qom-get (Command)qom-set (Command)ObjectTypeInfo (Object)qom-list-types (Command)qom-list-properties (Command)CanHostSocketcanProperties (Object)ColoCompareProperties (Object)CryptodevBackendProperties (Object)CryptodevVhostUserProperties (Object)DBusVMStateProperties (Object)NetfilterInsert (Enum)NetfilterProperties (Object)FilterBufferProperties (Object)FilterDumpProperties (Object)FilterMirrorProperties (Object)FilterRedirectorProperties (Object)FilterRewriterProperties (Object)InputBarrierProperties (Object)InputLinuxProperties (Object)IothreadProperties (Object)MemoryBackendProperties (Object)MemoryBackendFileProperties (Object)MemoryBackendMemfdProperties (Object)MemoryBackendEpcProperties (Object)PrManagerHelperProperties (Object)QtestProperties (Object)RemoteObjectProperties (Object)RngProperties (Object)RngEgdProperties (Object)RngRandomProperties (Object)SevGuestProperties (Object)ObjectType (Enum)ObjectOptions (Object)object-add (Command)object-del (Command)Device infrastructure (qdev)device-list-properties (Command)device_add (Command)device_del (Command)DEVICE_DELETED (Event)DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR (Event)MachinesSysEmuTarget (Enum)CpuS390State (Enum)CpuInfoS390 (Object)CpuInfoFast (Object)query-cpus-fast (Command)MachineInfo (Object)query-machines (Command)CurrentMachineParams (Object)query-current-machine (Command)TargetInfo (Object)query-target (Command)UuidInfo (Object)query-uuid (Command)GuidInfo (Object)query-vm-generation-id (Command)system_reset (Command)system_powerdown (Command)system_wakeup (Command)LostTickPolicy (Enum)inject-nmi (Command)KvmInfo (Object)query-kvm (Command)NumaOptionsType (Enum)NumaOptions (Object)NumaNodeOptions (Object)NumaDistOptions (Object)X86CPURegister32 (Enum)X86CPUFeatureWordInfo (Object)DummyForceArrays (Object)NumaCpuOptions (Object)HmatLBMemoryHierarchy (Enum)HmatLBDataType (Enum)NumaHmatLBOptions (Object)HmatCacheAssociativity (Enum)HmatCacheWritePolicy (Enum)NumaHmatCacheOptions (Object)memsave (Command)pmemsave (Command)Memdev (Object)query-memdev (Command)CpuInstanceProperties (Object)HotpluggableCPU (Object)query-hotpluggable-cpus (Command)set-numa-node (Command)balloon (Command)BalloonInfo (Object)query-balloon (Command)BALLOON_CHANGE (Event)MemoryInfo (Object)query-memory-size-summary (Command)PCDIMMDeviceInfo (Object)VirtioPMEMDeviceInfo (Object)VirtioMEMDeviceInfo (Object)SgxEPCDeviceInfo (Object)MemoryDeviceInfoKind (Enum)PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object)VirtioPMEMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object)VirtioMEMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object)SgxEPCDeviceInfoWrapper (Object)MemoryDeviceInfo (Object)SgxEPC (Object)SgxEPCProperties (Object)query-memory-devices (Command)MEMORY_DEVICE_SIZE_CHANGE (Event)MEM_UNPLUG_ERROR (Event)SMPConfiguration (Object)x-query-irq (Command)x-query-jit (Command)x-query-numa (Command)x-query-opcount (Command)x-query-profile (Command)x-query-ramblock (Command)x-query-rdma (Command)x-query-roms (Command)x-query-usb (Command)CpuModelInfo (Object)CpuModelExpansionType (Enum)CpuModelCompareResult (Enum)CpuModelBaselineInfo (Object)CpuModelCompareInfo (Object)query-cpu-model-comparison (Command)query-cpu-model-baseline (Command)CpuModelExpansionInfo (Object)query-cpu-model-expansion (Command)CpuDefinitionInfo (Object)query-cpu-definitions (Command)Record/replayReplayMode (Enum)ReplayInfo (Object)query-replay (Command)replay-break (Command)replay-delete-break (Command)replay-seek (Command)Yank featureYankInstanceType (Enum)YankInstanceBlockNode (Object)YankInstanceChardev (Object)YankInstance (Object)yank (Command)query-yank (Command)Miscellaneaadd_client (Command)NameInfo (Object)query-name (Command)IOThreadInfo (Object)query-iothreads (Command)stop (Command)cont (Command)x-exit-preconfig (Command)human-monitor-command (Command)getfd (Command)closefd (Command)AddfdInfo (Object)add-fd (Command)remove-fd (Command)FdsetFdInfo (Object)FdsetInfo (Object)query-fdsets (Command)CommandLineParameterType (Enum)CommandLineParameterInfo (Object)CommandLineOptionInfo (Object)query-command-line-options (Command)RTC_CHANGE (Event)rtc-reset-reinjection (Command)SevState (Enum)SevInfo (Object)query-sev (Command)SevLaunchMeasureInfo (Object)query-sev-launch-measure (Command)SevCapability (Object)query-sev-capabilities (Command)sev-inject-launch-secret (Command)SevAttestationReport (Object)query-sev-attestation-report (Command)dump-skeys (Command)GICCapability (Object)query-gic-capabilities (Command)SGXInfo (Object)query-sgx (Command)query-sgx-capabilities (Command)AudioAudiodevPerDirectionOptions (Object)AudiodevGenericOptions (Object)AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions (Object)AudiodevAlsaOptions (Object)AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions (Object)AudiodevCoreaudioOptions (Object)AudiodevDsoundOptions (Object)AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions (Object)AudiodevJackOptions (Object)AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions (Object)AudiodevOssOptions (Object)AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions (Object)AudiodevPaOptions (Object)AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions (Object)AudiodevSdlOptions (Object)AudiodevWavOptions (Object)AudioFormat (Enum)AudiodevDriver (Enum)Audiodev (Object)ACPIAcpiTableOptions (Object)ACPISlotType (Enum)ACPIOSTInfo (Object)query-acpi-ospm-status (Command)ACPI_DEVICE_OST (Event)PCIPciMemoryRange (Object)PciMemoryRegion (Object)PciBusInfo (Object)PciBridgeInfo (Object)PciDeviceClass (Object)PciDeviceId (Object)PciDeviceInfo (Object)PciInfo (Object)query-pci (Command)

INTRODUCTION

       This document describes all commands currently supported by QMP.

       Most  of  the time their usage is exactly the same as in the user Monitor, this means that
       any other document which also describe commands (the manpage, QEMU's manual, etc) can  and
       should be consulted.

       QMP has two types of commands: regular and query commands. Regular commands usually change
       the Virtual Machine's state someway, while query commands  just  return  information.  The
       sections below are divided accordingly.

       It's   important   to   observe  that  all  communication  examples  are  formatted  in  a
       reader-friendly way, so that they're easier  to  understand.  However,  in  real  protocol
       usage, they're emitted as a single line.

       Also, the following notation is used to denote data flow:

       Example:

          -> data issued by the Client
          <- Server data response

       Please,   refer   to   the  QMP  specification  (docs/interop/qmp-spec.txt)  for  detailed
       information on the Server command and response formats.

STABILITY CONSIDERATIONS

       The current QMP command set (described in this file) may be useful for  a  number  of  use
       cases,  however  it's  limited  and several commands have bad defined semantics, specially
       with regard to command completion.

       These problems are going to be solved incrementally in the next QEMU  releases  and  we're
       going to establish a deprecation policy for badly defined commands.

       If you're planning to adopt QMP, please observe the following:

          1. The  deprecation  policy  will  take effect and be documented soon, please check the
             documentation of each used command as soon as a new release of QEMU is available

          2. DO NOT rely on anything which is not explicit documented

          3. Errors, in special, are not documented. Applications should NOT check  for  specific
             errors classes or data (it's strongly recommended to only check for the "error" key)

QMP ERRORS

   QapiErrorClass (Enum)
       QEMU error classes

   Values
       GenericError
              this  is  used for errors that don't require a specific error class. This should be
              the default case for most errors

       CommandNotFound
              the requested command has not been found

       DeviceNotActive
              a device has failed to be become active

       DeviceNotFound
              the requested device has not been found

       KVMMissingCap
              the requested operation can't be fulfilled because a  required  KVM  capability  is
              missing

   Since
       1.2

COMMON DATA TYPES

   IoOperationType (Enum)
       An enumeration of the I/O operation types

   Values
       read   read operation

       write  write operation

   Since
       2.1

   OnOffAuto (Enum)
       An enumeration of three options: on, off, and auto

   Values
       auto   QEMU selects the value between on and off

       on     Enabled

       off    Disabled

   Since
       2.2

   OnOffSplit (Enum)
       An enumeration of three values: on, off, and split

   Values
       on     Enabled

       off    Disabled

       split  Mixed

   Since
       2.6

   String (Object)
       A fat type wrapping 'str', to be embedded in lists.

   Members
       str: string
              Not documented

   Since
       1.2

   StrOrNull (Alternate)
       This is a string value or the explicit lack of a string (null pointer in C).  Intended for
       cases when 'optional absent' already has a different meaning.

   Members
       s: string
              the string value

       n: null
              no string value

   Since
       2.10

   OffAutoPCIBAR (Enum)
       An enumeration of options for specifying a PCI BAR

   Values
       off    The specified feature is disabled

       auto   The PCI BAR for the feature is automatically selected

       bar0   PCI BAR0 is used for the feature

       bar1   PCI BAR1 is used for the feature

       bar2   PCI BAR2 is used for the feature

       bar3   PCI BAR3 is used for the feature

       bar4   PCI BAR4 is used for the feature

       bar5   PCI BAR5 is used for the feature

   Since
       2.12

   PCIELinkSpeed (Enum)
       An enumeration of PCIe link speeds in units of GT/s

   Values
       2_5    2.5GT/s

       5      5.0GT/s

       8      8.0GT/s

       16     16.0GT/s

   Since
       4.0

   PCIELinkWidth (Enum)
       An enumeration of PCIe link width

   Values
       1      x1

       2      x2

       4      x4

       8      x8

       12     x12

       16     x16

       32     x32

   Since
       4.0

   HostMemPolicy (Enum)
       Host memory policy types

   Values
       default
              restore default policy, remove any nondefault policy

       preferred
              set the preferred host nodes for allocation

       bind   a strict policy that restricts memory allocation to the host nodes specified

       interleave
              memory allocations are interleaved across the set of host nodes specified

   Since
       2.1

   NetFilterDirection (Enum)
       Indicates whether a netfilter is attached to a netdev's transmit queue or receive queue or
       both.

   Values
       all    the  filter  is  attached  both to the receive and the transmit queue of the netdev
              (default).

       rx     the filter is attached to the receive queue of the netdev, where  it  will  receive
              packets sent to the netdev.

       tx     the  filter  is attached to the transmit queue of the netdev, where it will receive
              packets sent by the netdev.

   Since
       2.5

   GrabToggleKeys (Enum)
       Keys to toggle input-linux between host and guest.

   Values
       ctrl-ctrl
              Not documented

       alt-alt
              Not documented

       shift-shift
              Not documented

       meta-meta
              Not documented

       scrolllock
              Not documented

       ctrl-scrolllock
              Not documented

   Since
       4.0

   HumanReadableText (Object)
   Members
       human-readable-text: string
              Formatted output intended for humans.

   Since
       6.2

SOCKET DATA TYPES

   NetworkAddressFamily (Enum)
       The network address family

   Values
       ipv4   IPV4 family

       ipv6   IPV6 family

       unix   unix socket

       vsock  vsock family (since 2.8)

       unknown
              otherwise

   Since
       2.1

   InetSocketAddressBase (Object)
   Members
       host: string
              host part of the address

       port: string
              port part of the address

   InetSocketAddress (Object)
       Captures a socket address or address range in the Internet namespace.

   Members
       numeric: boolean (optional)
              true if the host/port are guaranteed to be numeric, false if name resolution should
              be attempted. Defaults to false.  (Since 2.9)

       to: int (optional)
              If present, this is range of possible addresses, with port between port and to.

       ipv4: boolean (optional)
              whether to accept IPv4 addresses, default try both IPv4 and IPv6

       ipv6: boolean (optional)
              whether to accept IPv6 addresses, default try both IPv4 and IPv6

       keep-alive: boolean (optional)
              enable  keep-alive  when  connecting  to  this  socket.  Not  supported for passive
              sockets. (Since 4.2)

       mptcp: boolean (optional) (If: HAVE_IPPROTO_MPTCP)
              enable multi-path TCP. (Since 6.1)

       The members of InetSocketAddressBase

   Since
       1.3

   UnixSocketAddress (Object)
       Captures a socket address in the local ("Unix socket") namespace.

   Members
       path: string
              filesystem path to use

       abstract: boolean (optional) (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
              if true, this is a Linux abstract socket address.  path will be prefixed by a  null
              byte, and optionally padded with null bytes.  Defaults to false.  (Since 5.1)

       tight: boolean (optional) (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
              if  false,  pad  an  abstract socket address with enough null bytes to make it fill
              struct sockaddr_un member sun_path.  Defaults to true.  (Since 5.1)

   Since
       1.3

   VsockSocketAddress (Object)
       Captures a socket address in the vsock namespace.

   Members
       cid: string
              unique host identifier

       port: string
              port

   Note
       string types are used to allow for possible future hostname or service resolution support.

   Since
       2.8

   InetSocketAddressWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: InetSocketAddress
              Not documented

   Since
       1.3

   UnixSocketAddressWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: UnixSocketAddress
              Not documented

   Since
       1.3

   VsockSocketAddressWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: VsockSocketAddress
              Not documented

   Since
       2.8

   StringWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: String
              Not documented

   Since
       1.3

   SocketAddressLegacy (Object)
       Captures the address of a socket, which could also be a named file descriptor

   Members
       type: SocketAddressType
              Not documented

       The members of InetSocketAddressWrapper when type is "inet"

       The members of UnixSocketAddressWrapper when type is "unix"

       The members of VsockSocketAddressWrapper when type is "vsock"

       The members of StringWrapper when type is "fd"

   Note
       This  type  is  deprecated  in   favor   of   SocketAddress.    The   difference   between
       SocketAddressLegacy and SocketAddress is that the latter is has fewer {} on the wire.

   Since
       1.3

   SocketAddressType (Enum)
       Available SocketAddress types

   Values
       inet   Internet address

       unix   Unix domain socket

       vsock  VMCI address

       fd     decimal  is  for  file  descriptor number, otherwise a file descriptor name.  Named
              file descriptors are permitted in monitor commands, in combination with the 'getfd'
              command.  Decimal file descriptors are permitted at startup or other contexts where
              no monitor context is active.

   Since
       2.9

   SocketAddress (Object)
       Captures the address of a socket, which could also be a named file descriptor

   Members
       type: SocketAddressType
              Transport type

       The members of InetSocketAddress when type is "inet"

       The members of UnixSocketAddress when type is "unix"

       The members of VsockSocketAddress when type is "vsock"

       The members of String when type is "fd"

   Since
       2.9

VM RUN STATE

   RunState (Enum)
       An enumeration of VM run states.

   Values
       debug  QEMU is running on a debugger

       finish-migrate
              guest is paused to finish the migration process

       inmigrate
              guest is paused waiting for an incoming migration.  Note that this state  does  not
              tell  whether  the machine will start at the end of the migration.  This depends on
              the command-line -S option and any invocation of 'stop' or 'cont' that has happened
              since QEMU was started.

       internal-error
              An internal error that prevents further guest execution has occurred

       io-error
              the last IOP has failed and the device is configured to pause on I/O errors

       paused guest has been paused via the 'stop' command

       postmigrate
              guest is paused following a successful 'migrate'

       prelaunch
              QEMU was started with -S and guest has not started

       restore-vm
              guest is paused to restore VM state

       running
              guest is actively running

       save-vm
              guest is paused to save the VM state

       shutdown
              guest is shut down (and -no-shutdown is in use)

       suspended
              guest is suspended (ACPI S3)

       watchdog
              the watchdog action is configured to pause and has been triggered

       guest-panicked
              guest has been panicked as a result of guest OS panic

       colo   guest is paused to save/restore VM state under colo checkpoint, VM can not get into
              this state unless colo capability is enabled for migration. (since 2.8)

   ShutdownCause (Enum)
       An enumeration of reasons for a Shutdown.

   Values
       none   No shutdown request pending

       host-error
              An error prevents further use of guest

       host-qmp-quit
              Reaction to the QMP command 'quit'

       host-qmp-system-reset
              Reaction to the QMP command 'system_reset'

       host-signal
              Reaction to a signal, such as SIGINT

       host-ui
              Reaction to a UI event, like window close

       guest-shutdown
              Guest shutdown/suspend request, via ACPI or other hardware-specific means

       guest-reset
              Guest reset request, and command line turns that into a shutdown

       guest-panic
              Guest panicked, and command line turns that into a shutdown

       subsystem-reset
              Partial guest reset that does not trigger QMP events and ignores --no-reboot.  This
              is useful for sanitizing hypercalls on s390 that are used during kexec/kdump/boot

   StatusInfo (Object)
       Information about VCPU run state

   Members
       running: boolean
              true if all VCPUs are runnable, false if not runnable

       singlestep: boolean
              true if VCPUs are in single-step mode

       status: RunState
              the virtual machine RunState

   Since
       0.14

   Notes
       singlestep is enabled through the GDB stub

   query-status (Command)
       Query the run status of all VCPUs

   Returns
       StatusInfo reflecting all VCPUs

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-status" }
          <- { "return": { "running": true,
                           "singlestep": false,
                           "status": "running" } }

   SHUTDOWN (Event)
       Emitted when the virtual machine has shut down, indicating that qemu is about to exit.

   Arguments
       guest: boolean
              If  true,  the shutdown was triggered by a guest request (such as a guest-initiated
              ACPI shutdown request or other hardware-specific action) rather than a host request
              (such as sending qemu a SIGINT). (since 2.10)

       reason: ShutdownCause
              The ShutdownCause which resulted in the SHUTDOWN. (since 4.0)

   Note
       If  the  command-line  option "-no-shutdown" has been specified, qemu will not exit, and a
       STOP event will eventually follow the SHUTDOWN event

   Since
       0.12

   Example
          <- { "event": "SHUTDOWN", "data": { "guest": true },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267040730, "microseconds": 682951 } }

   POWERDOWN (Event)
       Emitted when the virtual machine is powered down through the power control system, such as
       via ACPI.

   Since
       0.12

   Example
          <- { "event": "POWERDOWN",
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267040730, "microseconds": 682951 } }

   RESET (Event)
       Emitted when the virtual machine is reset

   Arguments
       guest: boolean
              If true, the reset was triggered by a guest request (such as a guest-initiated ACPI
              reboot request or other hardware-specific action) rather than a host request  (such
              as the QMP command system_reset).  (since 2.10)

       reason: ShutdownCause
              The ShutdownCause of the RESET. (since 4.0)

   Since
       0.12

   Example
          <- { "event": "RESET", "data": { "guest": false },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267041653, "microseconds": 9518 } }

   STOP (Event)
       Emitted when the virtual machine is stopped

   Since
       0.12

   Example
          <- { "event": "STOP",
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267041730, "microseconds": 281295 } }

   RESUME (Event)
       Emitted when the virtual machine resumes execution

   Since
       0.12

   Example
          <- { "event": "RESUME",
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1271770767, "microseconds": 582542 } }

   SUSPEND (Event)
       Emitted  when  guest  enters  a hardware suspension state, for example, S3 state, which is
       sometimes called standby state

   Since
       1.1

   Example
          <- { "event": "SUSPEND",
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344456160, "microseconds": 309119 } }

   SUSPEND_DISK (Event)
       Emitted when guest enters a hardware  suspension  state  with  data  saved  on  disk,  for
       example, S4 state, which is sometimes called hibernate state

   Note
       QEMU shuts down (similar to event SHUTDOWN) when entering this state

   Since
       1.2

   Example
          <-   { "event": "SUSPEND_DISK",
                 "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344456160, "microseconds": 309119 } }

   WAKEUP (Event)
       Emitted when the guest has woken up from suspend state and is running

   Since
       1.1

   Example
          <- { "event": "WAKEUP",
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } }

   WATCHDOG (Event)
       Emitted when the watchdog device's timer is expired

   Arguments
       action: WatchdogAction
              action that has been taken

   Note
       If  action  is "reset", "shutdown", or "pause" the WATCHDOG event is followed respectively
       by the RESET, SHUTDOWN, or STOP events

   Note
       This event is rate-limited.

   Since
       0.13

   Example
          <- { "event": "WATCHDOG",
               "data": { "action": "reset" },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } }

   WatchdogAction (Enum)
       An enumeration of the actions taken when the watchdog device's timer is expired

   Values
       reset  system resets

       shutdown
              system shutdown, note that it is similar to powerdown, which tries to set to system
              status and notify guest

       poweroff
              system poweroff, the emulator program exits

       pause  system pauses, similar to stop

       debug  system enters debug state

       none   nothing is done

       inject-nmi
              a  non-maskable interrupt is injected into the first VCPU (all VCPUS on x86) (since
              2.4)

   Since
       2.1

   RebootAction (Enum)
       Possible QEMU actions upon guest reboot

   Values
       reset  Reset the VM

       shutdown
              Shutdown the VM and exit, according to the shutdown action

   Since
       6.0

   ShutdownAction (Enum)
       Possible QEMU actions upon guest shutdown

   Values
       poweroff
              Shutdown the VM and exit

       pause  pause the VM#

   Since
       6.0

   PanicAction (Enum)
   Values
       none   Continue VM execution

       pause  Pause the VM

       shutdown
              Shutdown the VM and exit, according to the shutdown action

   Since
       6.0

   watchdog-set-action (Command)
       Set watchdog action

   Arguments
       action: WatchdogAction
              Not documented

   Since
       2.11

   set-action (Command)
       Set the actions that will be taken by the emulator in response to guest events.

   Arguments
       reboot: RebootAction (optional)
              RebootAction action taken on guest reboot.

       shutdown: ShutdownAction (optional)
              ShutdownAction action taken on guest shutdown.

       panic: PanicAction (optional)
              PanicAction action taken on guest panic.

       watchdog: WatchdogAction (optional)
              WatchdogAction action taken when watchdog timer expires .

   Returns
       Nothing on success.

   Since
       6.0

   Example
          -> { "execute": "set-action",
               "arguments": { "reboot": "shutdown",
                              "shutdown" : "pause",
                              "panic": "pause",
                              "watchdog": "inject-nmi" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   GUEST_PANICKED (Event)
       Emitted when guest OS panic is detected

   Arguments
       action: GuestPanicAction
              action that has been taken, currently always "pause"

       info: GuestPanicInformation (optional)
              information about a panic (since 2.9)

   Since
       1.5

   Example
          <- { "event": "GUEST_PANICKED",
               "data": { "action": "pause" } }

   GUEST_CRASHLOADED (Event)
       Emitted when guest OS crash loaded is detected

   Arguments
       action: GuestPanicAction
              action that has been taken, currently always "run"

       info: GuestPanicInformation (optional)
              information about a panic

   Since
       5.0

   Example
          <- { "event": "GUEST_CRASHLOADED",
               "data": { "action": "run" } }

   GuestPanicAction (Enum)
       An enumeration of the actions taken when guest OS panic is detected

   Values
       pause  system pauses

       poweroff
              Not documented

       run    Not documented

   Since
       2.1 (poweroff since 2.8, run since 5.0)

   GuestPanicInformationType (Enum)
       An enumeration of the guest panic information types

   Values
       hyper-v
              hyper-v guest panic information type

       s390   s390 guest panic information type (Since: 2.12)

   Since
       2.9

   GuestPanicInformation (Object)
       Information about a guest panic

   Members
       type: GuestPanicInformationType
              Crash type that defines the hypervisor specific information

       The members of GuestPanicInformationHyperV when type is "hyper-v"

       The members of GuestPanicInformationS390 when type is "s390"

   Since
       2.9

   GuestPanicInformationHyperV (Object)
       Hyper-V specific guest panic information (HV crash MSRs)

   Members
       arg1: int
              Not documented

       arg2: int
              Not documented

       arg3: int
              Not documented

       arg4: int
              Not documented

       arg5: int
              Not documented

   Since
       2.9

   S390CrashReason (Enum)
       Reason why the CPU is in a crashed state.

   Values
       unknown
              no crash reason was set

       disabled-wait
              the CPU has entered a disabled wait state

       extint-loop
              clock comparator  or  cpu  timer  interrupt  with  new  PSW  enabled  for  external
              interrupts

       pgmint-loop
              program interrupt with BAD new PSW

       opint-loop
              operation exception interrupt with invalid code at the program interrupt new PSW

   Since
       2.12

   GuestPanicInformationS390 (Object)
       S390 specific guest panic information (PSW)

   Members
       core: int
              core id of the CPU that crashed

       psw-mask: int
              control fields of guest PSW

       psw-addr: int
              guest instruction address

       reason: S390CrashReason
              guest crash reason

   Since
       2.12

   MEMORY_FAILURE (Event)
       Emitted when a memory failure occurs on host side.

   Arguments
       recipient: MemoryFailureRecipient
              recipient is defined as MemoryFailureRecipient.

       action: MemoryFailureAction
              action that has been taken. action is defined as MemoryFailureAction.

       flags: MemoryFailureFlags
              flags for MemoryFailureAction. action is defined as MemoryFailureFlags.

   Since
       5.2

   Example
          <- { "event": "MEMORY_FAILURE",
               "data": { "recipient": "hypervisor",
                         "action": "fatal",
                         "flags": { 'action-required': false } }

   MemoryFailureRecipient (Enum)
       Hardware memory failure occurs, handled by recipient.

   Values
       hypervisor
              memory failure at QEMU process address space.  (none guest memory, but used by QEMU
              itself).

       guest  memory failure at guest memory,

   Since
       5.2

   MemoryFailureAction (Enum)
       Actions taken by QEMU in response to a hardware memory failure.

   Values
       ignore the  memory  failure  could  be  ignored.   This  will  only  be   the   case   for
              action-optional failures.

       inject memory  failure occurred in guest memory, the guest enabled MCE handling mechanism,
              and QEMU could inject the MCE into the guest successfully.

       fatal  the failure is unrecoverable.  This occurs  for  action-required  failures  if  the
              recipient is the hypervisor; QEMU will exit.

       reset  the  failure  is  unrecoverable  but  confined  to  the  guest.  This occurs if the
              recipient is a guest guest which is not ready to handle memory failures.

   Since
       5.2

   MemoryFailureFlags (Object)
       Additional information on memory failures.

   Members
       action-required: boolean
              whether a memory failure  event  is  action-required  or  action-optional  (e.g.  a
              failure during memory scrub).

       recursive: boolean
              whether the failure occurred while the previous failure was still in progress.

   Since
       5.2

CRYPTOGRAPHY

   QCryptoTLSCredsEndpoint (Enum)
       The type of network endpoint that will be using the credentials.  Most types of credential
       require different setup / structures depending on whether they will be used  in  a  server
       versus a client.

   Values
       client the network endpoint is acting as the client

       server the network endpoint is acting as the server

   Since
       2.5

   QCryptoSecretFormat (Enum)
       The data format that the secret is provided in

   Values
       raw    raw bytes. When encoded in JSON only valid UTF-8 sequences can be used

       base64 arbitrary base64 encoded binary data

   Since
       2.6

   QCryptoHashAlgorithm (Enum)
       The supported algorithms for computing content digests

   Values
       md5    MD5. Should not be used in any new code, legacy compat only

       sha1   SHA-1. Should not be used in any new code, legacy compat only

       sha224 SHA-224. (since 2.7)

       sha256 SHA-256. Current recommended strong hash.

       sha384 SHA-384. (since 2.7)

       sha512 SHA-512. (since 2.7)

       ripemd160
              RIPEMD-160. (since 2.7)

   Since
       2.6

   QCryptoCipherAlgorithm (Enum)
       The supported algorithms for content encryption ciphers

   Values
       aes-128
              AES with 128 bit / 16 byte keys

       aes-192
              AES with 192 bit / 24 byte keys

       aes-256
              AES with 256 bit / 32 byte keys

       des    DES with 56 bit / 8 byte keys. Do not use except in VNC. (since 6.1)

       3des   3DES(EDE) with 192 bit / 24 byte keys (since 2.9)

       cast5-128
              Cast5 with 128 bit / 16 byte keys

       serpent-128
              Serpent with 128 bit / 16 byte keys

       serpent-192
              Serpent with 192 bit / 24 byte keys

       serpent-256
              Serpent with 256 bit / 32 byte keys

       twofish-128
              Twofish with 128 bit / 16 byte keys

       twofish-192
              Twofish with 192 bit / 24 byte keys

       twofish-256
              Twofish with 256 bit / 32 byte keys

   Since
       2.6

   QCryptoCipherMode (Enum)
       The supported modes for content encryption ciphers

   Values
       ecb    Electronic Code Book

       cbc    Cipher Block Chaining

       xts    XEX with tweaked code book and ciphertext stealing

       ctr    Counter (Since 2.8)

   Since
       2.6

   QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm (Enum)
       The  supported  algorithms for generating initialization vectors for full disk encryption.
       The 'plain' generator should not be used for disks with sector numbers larger  than  2^32,
       except where compatibility with pre-existing Linux dm-crypt volumes is required.

   Values
       plain  64-bit sector number truncated to 32-bits

       plain64
              64-bit sector number

       essiv  64-bit sector number encrypted with a hash of the encryption key

   Since
       2.6

   QCryptoBlockFormat (Enum)
       The supported full disk encryption formats

   Values
       qcow   QCow/QCow2  built-in  AES-CBC  encryption.  Use  only  for liberating data from old
              images.

       luks   LUKS encryption format. Recommended for new images

   Since
       2.6

   QCryptoBlockOptionsBase (Object)
       The common options that apply to all full disk encryption formats

   Members
       format: QCryptoBlockFormat
              the encryption format

   Since
       2.6

   QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow (Object)
       The options that apply to QCow/QCow2 AES-CBC encryption format

   Members
       key-secret: string (optional)
              the ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the  decryption  key.  Mandatory  except
              when probing image for metadata only.

   Since
       2.6

   QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS (Object)
       The options that apply to LUKS encryption format

   Members
       key-secret: string (optional)
              the  ID  of  a  QCryptoSecret object providing the decryption key. Mandatory except
              when probing image for metadata only.

   Since
       2.6

   QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS (Object)
       The options that apply to LUKS encryption format initialization

   Members
       cipher-alg: QCryptoCipherAlgorithm (optional)
              the cipher algorithm for data encryption Currently defaults to 'aes-256'.

       cipher-mode: QCryptoCipherMode (optional)
              the cipher mode for data encryption Currently defaults to 'xts'

       ivgen-alg: QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm (optional)
              the initialization vector generator Currently defaults to 'plain64'

       ivgen-hash-alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm (optional)
              the initialization vector generator hash Currently defaults to 'sha256'

       hash-alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm (optional)
              the master key hash algorithm Currently defaults to 'sha256'

       iter-time: int (optional)
              number of milliseconds to spend in PBKDF passphrase processing. Currently  defaults
              to 2000. (since 2.8)

       The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS

   Since
       2.6

   QCryptoBlockOpenOptions (Object)
       The options that are available for all encryption formats when opening an existing volume

   Members
       The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsBase

       The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow when format is "qcow"

       The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS when format is "luks"

   Since
       2.6

   QCryptoBlockCreateOptions (Object)
       The options that are available for all encryption formats when initializing a new volume

   Members
       The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsBase

       The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow when format is "qcow"

       The members of QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS when format is "luks"

   Since
       2.6

   QCryptoBlockInfoBase (Object)
       The common information that applies to all full disk encryption formats

   Members
       format: QCryptoBlockFormat
              the encryption format

   Since
       2.7

   QCryptoBlockInfoLUKSSlot (Object)
       Information about the LUKS block encryption key slot options

   Members
       active: boolean
              whether the key slot is currently in use

       key-offset: int
              offset to the key material in bytes

       iters: int (optional)
              number of PBKDF2 iterations for key material

       stripes: int (optional)
              number of stripes for splitting key material

   Since
       2.7

   QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS (Object)
       Information about the LUKS block encryption options

   Members
       cipher-alg: QCryptoCipherAlgorithm
              the cipher algorithm for data encryption

       cipher-mode: QCryptoCipherMode
              the cipher mode for data encryption

       ivgen-alg: QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm
              the initialization vector generator

       ivgen-hash-alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm (optional)
              the initialization vector generator hash

       hash-alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm
              the master key hash algorithm

       payload-offset: int
              offset to the payload data in bytes

       master-key-iters: int
              number of PBKDF2 iterations for key material

       uuid: string
              unique identifier for the volume

       slots: array of QCryptoBlockInfoLUKSSlot
              information about each key slot

   Since
       2.7

   QCryptoBlockInfo (Object)
       Information about the block encryption options

   Members
       The members of QCryptoBlockInfoBase

       The members of QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS when format is "luks"

   Since
       2.7

   QCryptoBlockLUKSKeyslotState (Enum)
       Defines state of keyslots that are affected by the update

   Values
       active The slots contain the given password and marked as active

       inactive
              The slots are erased (contain garbage) and marked as inactive

   Since
       5.1

   QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS (Object)
       This struct defines the update parameters that activate/de-activate set of keyslots

   Members
       state: QCryptoBlockLUKSKeyslotState
              the desired state of the keyslots

       new-secret: string (optional)
              The  ID  of  a QCryptoSecret object providing the password to be written into added
              active keyslots

       old-secret: string (optional)
              Optional (for deactivation only) If given will deactivate all keyslots  that  match
              password located in QCryptoSecret with this ID

       iter-time: int (optional)
              Optional  (for activation only) Number of milliseconds to spend in PBKDF passphrase
              processing for the newly activated keyslot.  Currently defaults to 2000.

       keyslot: int (optional)
              Optional. ID of  the  keyslot  to  activate/deactivate.   For  keyslot  activation,
              keyslot  should not be active already (this is unsafe to update an active keyslot),
              but possible if 'force' parameter is given.  If keyslot is not  given,  first  free
              keyslot will be written.

              For keyslot deactivation, this parameter specifies the exact keyslot to deactivate

       secret: string (optional)
              Optional.  The  ID  of  a  QCryptoSecret  object  providing  the password to use to
              retrieve current master key.  Defaults to the same secret that was used to open the
              image
       Since 5.1

   QCryptoBlockAmendOptions (Object)
       The  options  that  are  available  for  all  encryption  formats when amending encryption
       settings

   Members
       The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsBase

       The members of QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS when format is "luks"

   Since
       5.1

   SecretCommonProperties (Object)
       Properties for objects of classes derived from secret-common.

   Members
       loaded: boolean (optional)
              if true, the secret is loaded  immediately  when  applying  this  option  and  will
              probably  fail  when  processing  the  next  option.  Don't  use; only provided for
              compatibility. (default: false)

       format: QCryptoSecretFormat (optional)
              the data format that the secret is provided in (default: raw)

       keyid: string (optional)
              the name of another secret that should be used to decrypt the provided data. If not
              present, the data is assumed to be unencrypted.

       iv: string (optional)
              the  random  initialization  vector  used for encryption of this particular secret.
              Should be a base64 encrypted string of the 16-byte IV. Mandatory if keyid is given.
              Ignored if keyid is absent.

   Features
       deprecated
              Member loaded is deprecated.  Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already
              the default.

   Since
       2.6

   SecretProperties (Object)
       Properties for secret objects.

       Either data or file must be provided, but not both.

   Members
       data: string (optional)
              the associated with the secret from

       file: string (optional)
              the filename to load the data associated with the secret from

       The members of SecretCommonProperties

   Since
       2.6

   SecretKeyringProperties (Object)
       Properties for secret_keyring objects.

   Members
       serial: int
              serial number that identifies a key to get from the kernel

       The members of SecretCommonProperties

   Since
       5.1

   TlsCredsProperties (Object)
       Properties for objects of classes derived from tls-creds.

   Members
       verify-peer: boolean (optional)
              if true the peer credentials will be verified  once  the  handshake  is  completed.
              This is a no-op for anonymous credentials. (default: true)

       dir: string (optional)
              the path of the directory that contains the credential files

       endpoint: QCryptoTLSCredsEndpoint (optional)
              whether  the  QEMU  network  backend  that uses the credentials will be acting as a
              client or as a server (default: client)

       priority: string (optional)
              a        gnutls        priority        string        as        described         at
              https://gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html

   Since
       2.5

   TlsCredsAnonProperties (Object)
       Properties for tls-creds-anon objects.

   Members
       loaded: boolean (optional)
              if  true, the credentials are loaded immediately when applying this option and will
              ignore  options  that  are  processed  later.  Don't   use;   only   provided   for
              compatibility. (default: false)

       The members of TlsCredsProperties

   Features
       deprecated
              Member loaded is deprecated.  Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already
              the default.

   Since
       2.5

   TlsCredsPskProperties (Object)
       Properties for tls-creds-psk objects.

   Members
       loaded: boolean (optional)
              if true, the credentials are loaded immediately when applying this option and  will
              ignore   options   that   are   processed  later.  Don't  use;  only  provided  for
              compatibility. (default: false)

       username: string (optional)
              the username which will be sent to the  server.   For  clients  only.   If  absent,
              "qemu" is sent and the property will read back as an empty string.

       The members of TlsCredsProperties

   Features
       deprecated
              Member loaded is deprecated.  Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already
              the default.

   Since
       3.0

   TlsCredsX509Properties (Object)
       Properties for tls-creds-x509 objects.

   Members
       loaded: boolean (optional)
              if true, the credentials are loaded immediately when applying this option and  will
              ignore   options   that   are   processed  later.  Don't  use;  only  provided  for
              compatibility. (default: false)

       sanity-check: boolean (optional)
              if true, perform some sanity checks before using the credentials (default: true)

       passwordid: string (optional)
              For the server-key.pem and client-key.pem files  which  contain  sensitive  private
              keys,  it  is  possible  to  use  an  encrypted version by providing the passwordid
              parameter.  This provides the ID of a previously created secret  object  containing
              the password for decryption.

       The members of TlsCredsProperties

   Features
       deprecated
              Member loaded is deprecated.  Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already
              the default.

   Since
       2.5

BLOCK DEVICES

   Block core (VM unrelated)
   Background jobs
   JobType (Enum)
       Type of a background job.

   Values
       commit block commit job type, see "block-commit"

       stream block stream job type, see "block-stream"

       mirror drive mirror job type, see "drive-mirror"

       backup drive backup job type, see "drive-backup"

       create image creation job type, see "blockdev-create" (since 3.0)

       amend  image options amend job type, see "x-blockdev-amend" (since 5.1)

       snapshot-load
              snapshot load job type, see "snapshot-load" (since 6.0)

       snapshot-save
              snapshot save job type, see "snapshot-save" (since 6.0)

       snapshot-delete
              snapshot delete job type, see "snapshot-delete" (since 6.0)

   Since
       1.7

   JobStatus (Enum)
       Indicates the present state of a given job in its lifetime.

   Values
       undefined
              Erroneous, default state. Should not ever be visible.

       created
              The job has been created, but not yet started.

       running
              The job is currently running.

       paused The job is running, but paused. The pause may be requested by either the  QMP  user
              or by internal processes.

       ready  The  job  is running, but is ready for the user to signal completion.  This is used
              for long-running jobs like mirror that are designed to run indefinitely.

       standby
              The job is ready, but paused. This is nearly identical  to  paused.   The  job  may
              return to ready or otherwise be canceled.

       waiting
              The  job  is  waiting  for other jobs in the transaction to converge to the waiting
              state. This status will likely not be visible for the last job in a transaction.

       pending
              The job has finished its work, but has finalization steps that  it  needs  to  make
              prior   to   completing.   These  changes  will  require  manual  intervention  via
              job-finalize if auto-finalize was set to false. These  pending  changes  may  still
              fail.

       aborting
              The  job is in the process of being aborted, and will finish with an error. The job
              will afterwards report that it is concluded.  This status may not be visible to the
              management process.

       concluded
              The  job  has  finished  all  work.  If auto-dismiss was set to false, the job will
              remain in the query list until it is dismissed via job-dismiss.

       null   The job is in the process of being  dismantled.  This  state  should  not  ever  be
              visible externally.

   Since
       2.12

   JobVerb (Enum)
       Represents command verbs that can be applied to a job.

   Values
       cancel see job-cancel

       pause  see job-pause

       resume see job-resume

       set-speed
              see block-job-set-speed

       complete
              see job-complete

       dismiss
              see job-dismiss

       finalize
              see job-finalize

   Since
       2.12

   JOB_STATUS_CHANGE (Event)
       Emitted when a job transitions to a different status.

   Arguments
       id: string
              The job identifier

       status: JobStatus
              The new job status

   Since
       3.0

   job-pause (Command)
       Pause an active job.

       This  command  returns  immediately  after marking the active job for pausing.  Pausing an
       already paused job is an error.

       The job will pause as soon as possible, which means transitioning into the PAUSED state if
       it was RUNNING, or into STANDBY if it was READY. The corresponding JOB_STATUS_CHANGE event
       will be emitted.

       Cancelling a paused job automatically resumes it.

   Arguments
       id: string
              The job identifier.

   Since
       3.0

   job-resume (Command)
       Resume a paused job.

       This command returns immediately after resuming a paused job. Resuming an already  running
       job is an error.

       id : The job identifier.

   Arguments
       id: string
              Not documented

   Since
       3.0

   job-cancel (Command)
       Instruct an active background job to cancel at the next opportunity.  This command returns
       immediately after marking the active job for cancellation.

       The job will cancel as soon as possible and then emit a JOB_STATUS_CHANGE event.  Usually,
       the  status  will change to ABORTING, but it is possible that a job successfully completes
       (e.g. because it was almost done and there was  no  opportunity  to  cancel  earlier  than
       completing the job) and transitions to PENDING instead.

   Arguments
       id: string
              The job identifier.

   Since
       3.0

   job-complete (Command)
       Manually trigger completion of an active job in the READY state.

   Arguments
       id: string
              The job identifier.

   Since
       3.0

   job-dismiss (Command)
       Deletes a job that is in the CONCLUDED state. This command only needs to be run explicitly
       for jobs that don't have automatic dismiss enabled.

       This command will refuse to operate on any job that  has  not  yet  reached  its  terminal
       state,  JOB_STATUS_CONCLUDED.  For  jobs  that  make use of JOB_READY event, job-cancel or
       job-complete will still need to be used as appropriate.

   Arguments
       id: string
              The job identifier.

   Since
       3.0

   job-finalize (Command)
       Instructs all jobs in a transaction (or a single job if it is not part of any transaction)
       to finalize any graph changes and do any necessary cleanup. This command requires that all
       involved jobs are in the PENDING state.

       For jobs in a transaction, instructing one job to finalize will  force  ALL  jobs  in  the
       transaction  to  finalize,  so  it  is  only  necessary to instruct a single member job to
       finalize.

   Arguments
       id: string
              The identifier of any job in the transaction, or of a job that is not part  of  any
              transaction.

   Since
       3.0

   JobInfo (Object)
       Information about a job.

   Members
       id: string
              The job identifier

       type: JobType
              The kind of job that is being performed

       status: JobStatus
              Current job state/status

       current-progress: int
              Progress  made until now. The unit is arbitrary and the value can only meaningfully
              be used  for  the  ratio  of  current-progress  to  total-progress.  The  value  is
              monotonically increasing.

       total-progress: int
              Estimated  current-progress  value  at  the  completion  of the job. This value can
              arbitrarily change while the job is running, in both directions.

       error: string (optional)
              If this field is present, the job failed; if it is still missing in  the  CONCLUDED
              state, this indicates successful completion.

              The  value  is  a  human-readable  error message to describe the reason for the job
              failure. It should not be parsed by applications.

   Since
       3.0

   query-jobs (Command)
       Return information about jobs.

   Returns
       a list with a JobInfo for each active job

   Since
       3.0

   SnapshotInfo (Object)
   Members
       id: string
              unique snapshot id

       name: string
              user chosen name

       vm-state-size: int
              size of the VM state

       date-sec: int
              UTC date of the snapshot in seconds

       date-nsec: int
              fractional part in nano seconds to be used with date-sec

       vm-clock-sec: int
              VM clock relative to boot in seconds

       vm-clock-nsec: int
              fractional part in nano seconds to be used with vm-clock-sec

       icount: int (optional)
              Current instruction count. Appears when execution record/replay  is  enabled.  Used
              for  "time-traveling"  to  match  the  moment  in  the  recorded execution with the
              snapshots. This counter may be obtained through query-replay command (since 5.2)

   Since
       1.3

   ImageInfoSpecificQCow2EncryptionBase (Object)
   Members
       format: BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat
              The encryption format

   Since
       2.10

   ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Encryption (Object)
   Members
       The members of ImageInfoSpecificQCow2EncryptionBase

       The members of QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS when format is "luks"

   Since
       2.10

   ImageInfoSpecificQCow2 (Object)
   Members
       compat: string
              compatibility level

       data-file: string (optional)
              the filename of the external data file that is stored in the image and  used  as  a
              default for opening the image (since: 4.0)

       data-file-raw: boolean (optional)
              True  if  the  external  data  file must stay valid as a standalone (read-only) raw
              image without looking at qcow2 metadata (since: 4.0)

       extended-l2: boolean (optional)
              true if the image has extended L2 entries; only valid for compat >= 1.1 (since 5.2)

       lazy-refcounts: boolean (optional)
              on or off; only valid for compat >= 1.1

       corrupt: boolean (optional)
              true if the image has been marked corrupt; only valid for compat >= 1.1 (since 2.2)

       refcount-bits: int
              width of a refcount entry in bits (since 2.3)

       encrypt: ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Encryption (optional)
              details about encryption parameters; only set if image is encrypted (since 2.10)

       bitmaps: array of Qcow2BitmapInfo (optional)
              A list of qcow2 bitmap details (since 4.0)

       compression-type: Qcow2CompressionType
              the image cluster compression method (since 5.1)

   Since
       1.7

   ImageInfoSpecificVmdk (Object)
   Members
       create-type: string
              The create type of VMDK image

       cid: int
              Content id of image

       parent-cid: int
              Parent VMDK image's cid

       extents: array of ImageInfo
              List of extent files

   Since
       1.7

   ImageInfoSpecificRbd (Object)
   Members
       encryption-format: RbdImageEncryptionFormat (optional)
              Image encryption format

   Since
       6.1

   ImageInfoSpecificKind (Enum)
   Values
       luks   Since 2.7

       rbd    Since 6.1

       qcow2  Not documented

       vmdk   Not documented

   Since
       1.7

   ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Wrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ImageInfoSpecificQCow2
              Not documented

   Since
       1.7

   ImageInfoSpecificVmdkWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ImageInfoSpecificVmdk
              Not documented

   Since
       6.1

   ImageInfoSpecificLUKSWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS
              Not documented

   Since
       2.7

   ImageInfoSpecificRbdWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ImageInfoSpecificRbd
              Not documented

   Since
       6.1

   ImageInfoSpecific (Object)
       A discriminated record of image format specific information structures.

   Members
       type: ImageInfoSpecificKind
              Not documented

       The members of ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Wrapper when type is "qcow2"

       The members of ImageInfoSpecificVmdkWrapper when type is "vmdk"

       The members of ImageInfoSpecificLUKSWrapper when type is "luks"

       The members of ImageInfoSpecificRbdWrapper when type is "rbd"

   Since
       1.7

   ImageInfo (Object)
       Information about a QEMU image file

   Members
       filename: string
              name of the image file

       format: string
              format of the image file

       virtual-size: int
              maximum capacity in bytes of the image

       actual-size: int (optional)
              actual size on disk in bytes of the image

       dirty-flag: boolean (optional)
              true if image is not cleanly closed

       cluster-size: int (optional)
              size of a cluster in bytes

       encrypted: boolean (optional)
              true if the image is encrypted

       compressed: boolean (optional)
              true if the image is compressed (Since 1.7)

       backing-filename: string (optional)
              name of the backing file

       full-backing-filename: string (optional)
              full path of the backing file

       backing-filename-format: string (optional)
              the format of the backing file

       snapshots: array of SnapshotInfo (optional)
              list of VM snapshots

       backing-image: ImageInfo (optional)
              info of the backing image (since 1.6)

       format-specific: ImageInfoSpecific (optional)
              structure supplying additional format-specific information (since 1.7)

   Since
       1.3

   ImageCheck (Object)
       Information about a QEMU image file check

   Members
       filename: string
              name of the image file checked

       format: string
              format of the image file checked

       check-errors: int
              number of unexpected errors occurred during check

       image-end-offset: int (optional)
              offset (in bytes) where the image ends, this field is present if the driver for the
              image format supports it

       corruptions: int (optional)
              number of corruptions found during the check if any

       leaks: int (optional)
              number of leaks found during the check if any

       corruptions-fixed: int (optional)
              number of corruptions fixed during the check if any

       leaks-fixed: int (optional)
              number of leaks fixed during the check if any

       total-clusters: int (optional)
              total  number of clusters, this field is present if the driver for the image format
              supports it

       allocated-clusters: int (optional)
              total number of allocated clusters, this field is present if  the  driver  for  the
              image format supports it

       fragmented-clusters: int (optional)
              total  number  of  fragmented clusters, this field is present if the driver for the
              image format supports it

       compressed-clusters: int (optional)
              total number of compressed clusters, this field is present if the  driver  for  the
              image format supports it

   Since
       1.4

   MapEntry (Object)
       Mapping information from a virtual block range to a host file range

   Members
       start: int
              virtual (guest) offset of the first byte described by this entry

       length: int
              the number of bytes of the mapped virtual range

       data: boolean
              reading  the image will actually read data from a file (in particular, if offset is
              present this means that the sectors are not simply preallocated, but contain actual
              data in raw format)

       zero: boolean
              whether the virtual blocks read as zeroes

       depth: int
              number  of layers (0 = top image, 1 = top image's backing file, ..., n - 1 = bottom
              image (where n is the number of images in the chain)) before reaching one for which
              the range is allocated

       present: boolean
              true  if this layer provides the data, false if adding a backing layer could impact
              this region (since 6.1)

       offset: int (optional)
              if present, the image file stores the data for this range  in  raw  format  at  the
              given (host) offset

       filename: string (optional)
              filename that is referred to by offset

   Since
       2.6

   BlockdevCacheInfo (Object)
       Cache mode information for a block device

   Members
       writeback: boolean
              true if writeback mode is enabled

       direct: boolean
              true if the host page cache is bypassed (O_DIRECT)

       no-flush: boolean
              true if flush requests are ignored for the device

   Since
       2.3

   BlockDeviceInfo (Object)
       Information about the backing device for a block device.

   Members
       file: string
              the filename of the backing device

       node-name: string (optional)
              the name of the block driver node (Since 2.0)

       ro: boolean
              true if the backing device was open read-only

       drv: string
              the  name  of the block format used to open the backing device. As of 0.14 this can
              be: 'blkdebug', 'bochs', 'cloop', 'cow',  'dmg',  'file',  'file',  'ftp',  'ftps',
              'host_cdrom',  'host_device',  'http', 'https', 'luks', 'nbd', 'parallels', 'qcow',
              'qcow2', 'raw', 'vdi', 'vmdk',  'vpc',  'vvfat'  2.2:  'archipelago'  added,  'cow'
              dropped  2.3: 'host_floppy' deprecated 2.5: 'host_floppy' dropped 2.6: 'luks' added
              2.8: 'replication' added, 'tftp' dropped 2.9: 'archipelago' dropped

       backing_file: string (optional)
              the name of the backing file (for copy-on-write)

       backing_file_depth: int
              number of files in the backing file chain (since: 1.2)

       encrypted: boolean
              true if the backing device is encrypted

       detect_zeroes: BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions
              detect and optimize zero writes (Since 2.1)

       bps: int
              total throughput limit in bytes per second is specified

       bps_rd: int
              read throughput limit in bytes per second is specified

       bps_wr: int
              write throughput limit in bytes per second is specified

       iops: int
              total I/O operations per second is specified

       iops_rd: int
              read I/O operations per second is specified

       iops_wr: int
              write I/O operations per second is specified

       image: ImageInfo
              the info of image used (since: 1.6)

       bps_max: int (optional)

              total throughput limit during bursts,
                     in bytes (Since 1.7)

       bps_rd_max: int (optional)

              read throughput limit during bursts,
                     in bytes (Since 1.7)

       bps_wr_max: int (optional)

              write throughput limit during bursts,
                     in bytes (Since 1.7)

       iops_max: int (optional)

              total I/O operations per second during bursts,
                     in bytes (Since 1.7)

       iops_rd_max: int (optional)

              read I/O operations per second during bursts,
                     in bytes (Since 1.7)

       iops_wr_max: int (optional)

              write I/O operations per second during bursts,
                     in bytes (Since 1.7)

       bps_max_length: int (optional)

              maximum length of the bps_max burst
                     period, in seconds. (Since 2.6)

       bps_rd_max_length: int (optional)

              maximum length of the bps_rd_max
                     burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6)

       bps_wr_max_length: int (optional)

              maximum length of the bps_wr_max
                     burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6)

       iops_max_length: int (optional)

              maximum length of the iops burst
                     period, in seconds. (Since 2.6)

       iops_rd_max_length: int (optional)

              maximum length of the iops_rd_max
                     burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6)

       iops_wr_max_length: int (optional)

              maximum length of the iops_wr_max
                     burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6)

       iops_size: int (optional)
              an I/O size in bytes (Since 1.7)

       group: string (optional)
              throttle group name (Since 2.4)

       cache: BlockdevCacheInfo
              the cache mode used for the block device (since: 2.3)

       write_threshold: int
              configured write threshold for the device.  0 if disabled. (Since 2.3)

       dirty-bitmaps: array of BlockDirtyInfo (optional)
              dirty bitmaps information (only present if node has  one  or  more  dirty  bitmaps)
              (Since 4.2)

   Since
       0.14

   BlockDeviceIoStatus (Enum)
       An enumeration of block device I/O status.

   Values
       ok     The last I/O operation has succeeded

       failed The last I/O operation has failed

       nospace
              The last I/O operation has failed due to a no-space condition

   Since
       1.0

   BlockDirtyInfo (Object)
       Block dirty bitmap information.

   Members
       name: string (optional)
              the name of the dirty bitmap (Since 2.4)

       count: int
              number of dirty bytes according to the dirty bitmap

       granularity: int
              granularity of the dirty bitmap in bytes (since 1.4)

       recording: boolean
              true  if  the  bitmap  is recording new writes from the guest.  Replaces active and
              disabled statuses. (since 4.0)

       busy: boolean
              true if the bitmap is in-use by some operation (NBD or jobs) and cannot be modified
              via  QMP or used by another operation.  Replaces locked and frozen statuses. (since
              4.0)

       persistent: boolean
              true if the bitmap was stored on disk, is scheduled to be stored on disk, or  both.
              (since 4.0)

       inconsistent: boolean (optional)
              true  if this is a persistent bitmap that was improperly stored. Implies persistent
              to be true; recording and busy to be false. This bitmap cannot be used.  To  remove
              it, use block-dirty-bitmap-remove. (Since 4.0)

   Since
       1.3

   Qcow2BitmapInfoFlags (Enum)
       An enumeration of flags that a bitmap can report to the user.

   Values
       in-use This flag is set by any process actively modifying the qcow2 file, and cleared when
              the updated bitmap is flushed to the qcow2 image.  The presence of this flag in  an
              offline  image  means that the bitmap was not saved correctly after its last usage,
              and may contain inconsistent data.

       auto   The bitmap must reflect all changes of the virtual disk  by  any  application  that
              would write to this qcow2 file.

   Since
       4.0

   Qcow2BitmapInfo (Object)
       Qcow2 bitmap information.

   Members
       name: string
              the name of the bitmap

       granularity: int
              granularity of the bitmap in bytes

       flags: array of Qcow2BitmapInfoFlags
              flags of the bitmap

   Since
       4.0

   BlockLatencyHistogramInfo (Object)
       Block latency histogram.

   Members
       boundaries: array of int
              list  of  interval  boundary  values  in  nanoseconds, all greater than zero and in
              ascending order.  For example, the  list  [10,  50,  100]  produces  the  following
              histogram intervals: [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf).

       bins: array of int
              list  of  io  request  counts  corresponding  to  histogram intervals.  len(bins) =
              len(boundaries) + 1 For the example above, bins may be something like [3, 1, 5, 2],
              and corresponding histogram looks like:

          5|           *
          4|           *
          3| *         *
          2| *         *    *
          1| *    *    *    *
           +------------------
               10   50   100

   Since
       4.0

   BlockInfo (Object)
       Block  device  information.   This  structure  describes  a virtual device and the backing
       device associated with it.

   Members
       device: string
              The device name associated with the virtual device.

       qdev: string (optional)
              The qdev ID, or if no ID is assigned, the QOM path  of  the  block  device.  (since
              2.10)

       type: string
              This  field  is  returned  only  for  compatibility  reasons, it should not be used
              (always returns 'unknown')

       removable: boolean
              True if the device supports removable media.

       locked: boolean
              True if the guest has locked this device from having its media removed

       tray_open: boolean (optional)
              True if the device's tray is open (only present if it has a tray)

       io-status: BlockDeviceIoStatus (optional)
              BlockDeviceIoStatus. Only  present  if  the  device  supports  it  and  the  VM  is
              configured to stop on errors (supported device models: virtio-blk, IDE, SCSI except
              scsi-generic)

       inserted: BlockDeviceInfo (optional)
              BlockDeviceInfo describing the device if media is present

   Since
       0.14

   BlockMeasureInfo (Object)
       Image file size calculation information.  This structure describes the  size  requirements
       for creating a new image file.

       The  size  requirements  depend  on  the  new  image file format.  File size always equals
       virtual disk size for the 'raw' format, even for sparse POSIX files.  Compact formats such
       as  'qcow2' represent unallocated and zero regions efficiently so file size may be smaller
       than virtual disk size.

       The values are upper bounds that are guaranteed to fit the  new  image  file.   Subsequent
       modification, such as internal snapshot or further bitmap creation, may require additional
       space and is not covered here.

   Members
       required: int
              Size required for  a  new  image  file,  in  bytes,  when  copying  just  allocated
              guest-visible contents.

       fully-allocated: int
              Image  file size, in bytes, once data has been written to all sectors, when copying
              just guest-visible contents.

       bitmaps: int (optional)
              Additional size required if all the top-level bitmap metadata in the  source  image
              were to be copied to the destination, present only when source and destination both
              support persistent bitmaps. (since 5.1)

   Since
       2.10

   query-block (Command)
       Get a list of BlockInfo for all virtual block devices.

   Returns
       a list of BlockInfo describing each virtual block device. Filter nodes that  were  created
       implicitly are skipped over.

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-block" }
          <- {
                "return":[
                   {
                      "io-status": "ok",
                      "device":"ide0-hd0",
                      "locked":false,
                      "removable":false,
                      "inserted":{
                         "ro":false,
                         "drv":"qcow2",
                         "encrypted":false,
                         "file":"disks/test.qcow2",
                         "backing_file_depth":1,
                         "bps":1000000,
                         "bps_rd":0,
                         "bps_wr":0,
                         "iops":1000000,
                         "iops_rd":0,
                         "iops_wr":0,
                         "bps_max": 8000000,
                         "bps_rd_max": 0,
                         "bps_wr_max": 0,
                         "iops_max": 0,
                         "iops_rd_max": 0,
                         "iops_wr_max": 0,
                         "iops_size": 0,
                         "detect_zeroes": "on",
                         "write_threshold": 0,
                         "image":{
                            "filename":"disks/test.qcow2",
                            "format":"qcow2",
                            "virtual-size":2048000,
                            "backing_file":"base.qcow2",
                            "full-backing-filename":"disks/base.qcow2",
                            "backing-filename-format":"qcow2",
                            "snapshots":[
                               {
                                  "id": "1",
                                  "name": "snapshot1",
                                  "vm-state-size": 0,
                                  "date-sec": 10000200,
                                  "date-nsec": 12,
                                  "vm-clock-sec": 206,
                                  "vm-clock-nsec": 30
                               }
                            ],
                            "backing-image":{
                                "filename":"disks/base.qcow2",
                                "format":"qcow2",
                                "virtual-size":2048000
                            }
                         }
                      },
                      "qdev": "ide_disk",
                      "type":"unknown"
                   },
                   {
                      "io-status": "ok",
                      "device":"ide1-cd0",
                      "locked":false,
                      "removable":true,
                      "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[23]",
                      "tray_open": false,
                      "type":"unknown"
                   },
                   {
                      "device":"floppy0",
                      "locked":false,
                      "removable":true,
                      "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[20]",
                      "type":"unknown"
                   },
                   {
                      "device":"sd0",
                      "locked":false,
                      "removable":true,
                      "type":"unknown"
                   }
                ]
             }

   BlockDeviceTimedStats (Object)
       Statistics of a block device during a given interval of time.

   Members
       interval_length: int
              Interval used for calculating the statistics, in seconds.

       min_rd_latency_ns: int
              Minimum latency of read operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.

       min_wr_latency_ns: int
              Minimum latency of write operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.

       min_flush_latency_ns: int
              Minimum latency of flush operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.

       max_rd_latency_ns: int
              Maximum latency of read operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.

       max_wr_latency_ns: int
              Maximum latency of write operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.

       max_flush_latency_ns: int
              Maximum latency of flush operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.

       avg_rd_latency_ns: int
              Average latency of read operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.

       avg_wr_latency_ns: int
              Average latency of write operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.

       avg_flush_latency_ns: int
              Average latency of flush operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.

       avg_rd_queue_depth: number
              Average number of pending read operations in the defined interval.

       avg_wr_queue_depth: number
              Average number of pending write operations in the defined interval.

   Since
       2.5

   BlockDeviceStats (Object)
       Statistics of a virtual block device or a block backing device.

   Members
       rd_bytes: int
              The number of bytes read by the device.

       wr_bytes: int
              The number of bytes written by the device.

       unmap_bytes: int
              The number of bytes unmapped by the device (Since 4.2)

       rd_operations: int
              The number of read operations performed by the device.

       wr_operations: int
              The number of write operations performed by the device.

       flush_operations: int
              The number of cache flush operations performed by the device (since 0.15)

       unmap_operations: int
              The number of unmap operations performed by the device (Since 4.2)

       rd_total_time_ns: int
              Total time spent on reads in nanoseconds (since 0.15).

       wr_total_time_ns: int
              Total time spent on writes in nanoseconds (since 0.15).

       flush_total_time_ns: int
              Total time spent on cache flushes in nanoseconds (since 0.15).

       unmap_total_time_ns: int
              Total time spent on unmap operations in nanoseconds (Since 4.2)

       wr_highest_offset: int
              The offset after the greatest byte written to the device.  The intended use of this
              information is for growable sparse files (like qcow2) that are used  on  top  of  a
              physical device.

       rd_merged: int
              Number of read requests that have been merged into another request (Since 2.3).

       wr_merged: int
              Number of write requests that have been merged into another request (Since 2.3).

       unmap_merged: int
              Number of unmap requests that have been merged into another request (Since 4.2)

       idle_time_ns: int (optional)
              Time  since the last I/O operation, in nanoseconds. If the field is absent it means
              that there haven't been any operations yet (Since 2.5).

       failed_rd_operations: int
              The number of failed read operations performed by the device (Since 2.5)

       failed_wr_operations: int
              The number of failed write operations performed by the device (Since 2.5)

       failed_flush_operations: int
              The number of failed flush operations performed by the device (Since 2.5)

       failed_unmap_operations: int
              The number of failed unmap operations performed by the device (Since 4.2)

       invalid_rd_operations: int

              The number of invalid read operations
                     performed by the device (Since 2.5)

       invalid_wr_operations: int
              The number of invalid write operations performed by the device (Since 2.5)

       invalid_flush_operations: int
              The number of invalid flush operations performed by the device (Since 2.5)

       invalid_unmap_operations: int
              The number of invalid unmap operations performed by the device (Since 4.2)

       account_invalid: boolean
              Whether invalid operations are included in the last access statistics (Since 2.5)

       account_failed: boolean
              Whether failed operations are included in the latency and  last  access  statistics
              (Since 2.5)

       timed_stats: array of BlockDeviceTimedStats
              Statistics specific to the set of previously defined intervals of time (Since 2.5)

       rd_latency_histogram: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo (optional)
              BlockLatencyHistogramInfo. (Since 4.0)

       wr_latency_histogram: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo (optional)
              BlockLatencyHistogramInfo. (Since 4.0)

       flush_latency_histogram: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo (optional)
              BlockLatencyHistogramInfo. (Since 4.0)

   Since
       0.14

   BlockStatsSpecificFile (Object)
       File driver statistics

   Members
       discard-nb-ok: int
              The number of successful discard operations performed by the driver.

       discard-nb-failed: int
              The number of failed discard operations performed by the driver.

       discard-bytes-ok: int
              The number of bytes discarded by the driver.

   Since
       4.2

   BlockStatsSpecificNvme (Object)
       NVMe driver statistics

   Members
       completion-errors: int
              The number of completion errors.

       aligned-accesses: int
              The number of aligned accesses performed by the driver.

       unaligned-accesses: int
              The number of unaligned accesses performed by the driver.

   Since
       5.2

   BlockStatsSpecific (Object)
       Block driver specific statistics

   Members
       driver: BlockdevDriver
              Not documented

       The members of BlockStatsSpecificFile when driver is "file"

       The    members    of    BlockStatsSpecificFile   when   driver   is   "host_device"   (If:
       HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE)

       The members of BlockStatsSpecificNvme when driver is "nvme"

   Since
       4.2

   BlockStats (Object)
       Statistics of a virtual block device or a block backing device.

   Members
       device: string (optional)
              If the stats are for a virtual block device, the name corresponding to the  virtual
              block device.

       node-name: string (optional)
              The node name of the device. (Since 2.3)

       qdev: string (optional)
              The qdev ID, or if no ID is assigned, the QOM path of the block device. (since 3.0)

       stats: BlockDeviceStats
              A BlockDeviceStats for the device.

       driver-specific: BlockStatsSpecific (optional)
              Optional driver-specific stats. (Since 4.2)

       parent: BlockStats (optional)
              This  describes  the  file  block  device  if it has one.  Contains recursively the
              statistics of the underlying protocol (e.g. the host file for a  qcow2  image).  If
              there is no underlying protocol, this field is omitted

       backing: BlockStats (optional)
              This describes the backing block device if it has one.  (Since 2.0)

   Since
       0.14

   query-blockstats (Command)
       Query the BlockStats for all virtual block devices.

   Arguments
       query-nodes: boolean (optional)
              If  true,  the  command  will query all the block nodes that have a node name, in a
              list which will include "parent" information,  but  not  "backing".   If  false  or
              omitted,  the  behavior  is  as before - query all the device backends, recursively
              including their "parent" and "backing". Filter nodes that were  created  implicitly
              are skipped over in this mode. (Since 2.3)

   Returns
       A list of BlockStats for each virtual block devices.

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-blockstats" }
          <- {
                "return":[
                   {
                      "device":"ide0-hd0",
                      "parent":{
                         "stats":{
                            "wr_highest_offset":3686448128,
                            "wr_bytes":9786368,
                            "wr_operations":751,
                            "rd_bytes":122567168,
                            "rd_operations":36772
                            "wr_total_times_ns":313253456
                            "rd_total_times_ns":3465673657
                            "flush_total_times_ns":49653
                            "flush_operations":61,
                            "rd_merged":0,
                            "wr_merged":0,
                            "idle_time_ns":2953431879,
                            "account_invalid":true,
                            "account_failed":false
                         }
                      },
                      "stats":{
                         "wr_highest_offset":2821110784,
                         "wr_bytes":9786368,
                         "wr_operations":692,
                         "rd_bytes":122739200,
                         "rd_operations":36604
                         "flush_operations":51,
                         "wr_total_times_ns":313253456
                         "rd_total_times_ns":3465673657
                         "flush_total_times_ns":49653,
                         "rd_merged":0,
                         "wr_merged":0,
                         "idle_time_ns":2953431879,
                         "account_invalid":true,
                         "account_failed":false
                      },
                      "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[23]"
                   },
                   {
                      "device":"ide1-cd0",
                      "stats":{
                         "wr_highest_offset":0,
                         "wr_bytes":0,
                         "wr_operations":0,
                         "rd_bytes":0,
                         "rd_operations":0
                         "flush_operations":0,
                         "wr_total_times_ns":0
                         "rd_total_times_ns":0
                         "flush_total_times_ns":0,
                         "rd_merged":0,
                         "wr_merged":0,
                         "account_invalid":false,
                         "account_failed":false
                      },
                      "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[24]"
                   },
                   {
                      "device":"floppy0",
                      "stats":{
                         "wr_highest_offset":0,
                         "wr_bytes":0,
                         "wr_operations":0,
                         "rd_bytes":0,
                         "rd_operations":0
                         "flush_operations":0,
                         "wr_total_times_ns":0
                         "rd_total_times_ns":0
                         "flush_total_times_ns":0,
                         "rd_merged":0,
                         "wr_merged":0,
                         "account_invalid":false,
                         "account_failed":false
                      },
                      "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[16]"
                   },
                   {
                      "device":"sd0",
                      "stats":{
                         "wr_highest_offset":0,
                         "wr_bytes":0,
                         "wr_operations":0,
                         "rd_bytes":0,
                         "rd_operations":0
                         "flush_operations":0,
                         "wr_total_times_ns":0
                         "rd_total_times_ns":0
                         "flush_total_times_ns":0,
                         "rd_merged":0,
                         "wr_merged":0,
                         "account_invalid":false,
                         "account_failed":false
                      }
                   }
                ]
             }

   BlockdevOnError (Enum)
       An  enumeration  of  possible  behaviors  for errors on I/O operations.  The exact meaning
       depends on whether the I/O was initiated by a guest or by a block job

   Values
       report for guest operations, report the error to the guest; for jobs, cancel the job

       ignore ignore the error, only report a QMP event (BLOCK_IO_ERROR or BLOCK_JOB_ERROR).  The
              backup,  mirror and commit block jobs retry the failing request later and may still
              complete successfully. The stream block job continues to stream and  will  complete
              with an error.

       enospc same as stop on ENOSPC, same as report otherwise.

       stop   for guest operations, stop the virtual machine; for jobs, pause the job

       auto   inherit the error handling policy of the backend (since: 2.7)

   Since
       1.3

   MirrorSyncMode (Enum)
       An  enumeration  of  possible  behaviors  for the initial synchronization phase of storage
       mirroring.

   Values
       top    copies data in the topmost image to the destination

       full   copies data from all images to the destination

       none   only copy data written from now on

       incremental
              only copy data described by the dirty bitmap. (since: 2.4)

       bitmap only copy data described by the dirty bitmap. (since: 4.2) Behavior  on  completion
              is determined by the BitmapSyncMode.

   Since
       1.3

   BitmapSyncMode (Enum)
       An  enumeration  of  possible  behaviors for the synchronization of a bitmap when used for
       data copy operations.

   Values
       on-success
              The bitmap is only synced when the operation is successful.  This is  the  behavior
              always used for 'INCREMENTAL' backups.

       never  The  bitmap  is  never  synchronized with the operation, and is treated solely as a
              read-only manifest of blocks to copy.

       always The bitmap is always synchronized with the operation, regardless of whether or  not
              the operation was successful.

   Since
       4.2

   MirrorCopyMode (Enum)
       An  enumeration  whose  values  tell  the  mirror  block job when to trigger writes to the
       target.

   Values
       background
              copy data in background only.

       write-blocking
              when data is written to the source, write it (synchronously) to the target as well.
              In addition, data is copied in background just like in background mode.

   Since
       3.0

   BlockJobInfo (Object)
       Information about a long-running block device operation.

   Members
       type: string
              the job type ('stream' for image streaming)

       device: string
              The  job  identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since
              QEMU 2.7

       len: int
              Estimated offset value at the completion of the job.  This  value  can  arbitrarily
              change while the job is running, in both directions.

       offset: int
              Progress  made until now. The unit is arbitrary and the value can only meaningfully
              be used for the ratio of offset to len. The value is monotonically increasing.

       busy: boolean
              false if the job is known to be in a quiescent state, with no pending  I/O.   Since
              1.3.

       paused: boolean
              whether  the  job  is  paused  or,  if  busy  is true, will pause itself as soon as
              possible.  Since 1.3.

       speed: int
              the rate limit, bytes per second

       io-status: BlockDeviceIoStatus
              the status of the job (since 1.3)

       ready: boolean
              true if the job may be completed (since 2.2)

       status: JobStatus
              Current job state/status (since 2.12)

       auto-finalize: boolean
              Job will finalize itself when PENDING, moving to the CONCLUDED state. (since 2.12)

       auto-dismiss: boolean
              Job will dismiss itself when CONCLUDED, moving to the NULL state  and  disappearing
              from the query list. (since 2.12)

       error: string (optional)
              Error  information  if  the  job did not complete successfully.  Not set if the job
              completed successfully. (since 2.12.1)

   Since
       1.1

   query-block-jobs (Command)
       Return information about long-running block device operations.

   Returns
       a list of BlockJobInfo for each active block job

   Since
       1.1

   block_resize (Command)
       Resize a block image while a guest is running.

       Either device or node-name must be set but not both.

   Arguments
       device: string (optional)
              the name of the device to get the image resized

       node-name: string (optional)
              graph node name to get the image resized (Since 2.0)

       size: int
              new image size in bytes

   Returns
       • nothing on success

       • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "block_resize",
               "arguments": { "device": "scratch", "size": 1073741824 } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   NewImageMode (Enum)
       An enumeration that tells QEMU how to set the backing file path in a new image file.

   Values
       existing
              QEMU should look for an existing image file.

       absolute-paths
              QEMU should create a new image with absolute paths for the backing file.  If  there
              is no backing file available, the new image will not be backed either.

   Since
       1.1

   BlockdevSnapshotSync (Object)
       Either device or node-name must be set but not both.

   Members
       device: string (optional)
              the name of the device to take a snapshot of.

       node-name: string (optional)
              graph node name to generate the snapshot from (Since 2.0)

       snapshot-file: string
              the  target of the new overlay image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, the
              overlay will be created in the existing file/device. Otherwise, a new file will  be
              created.

       snapshot-node-name: string (optional)
              the graph node name of the new image (Since 2.0)

       format: string (optional)
              the format of the overlay image, default is 'qcow2'.

       mode: NewImageMode (optional)
              whether and how QEMU should create a new image, default is 'absolute-paths'.

   BlockdevSnapshot (Object)
   Members
       node: string
              device or node name that will have a snapshot taken.

       overlay: string
              reference  to  the  existing  block device that will become the overlay of node, as
              part of taking the snapshot.  It must not have a current backing file (this can  be
              achieved by passing "backing": null to blockdev-add).

   Since
       2.5

   BackupPerf (Object)
       Optional  parameters  for  backup.  These  parameters  don't affect functionality, but may
       significantly affect performance.

   Members
       use-copy-range: boolean (optional)
              Use copy offloading. Default false.

       max-workers: int (optional)
              Maximum number of parallel requests for the sustained background  copying  process.
              Doesn't influence copy-before-write operations.  Default 64.

       max-chunk: int (optional)
              Maximum  request  length  for  the  sustained  background  copying process. Doesn't
              influence  copy-before-write  operations.   0  means  unlimited.  If  max-chunk  is
              non-zero  then  it  should not be less than job cluster size which is calculated as
              maximum of target image cluster size and 64k. Default 0.

   Since
       6.0

   BackupCommon (Object)
   Members
       job-id: string (optional)
              identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the  device  name  will  be
              used. (Since 2.7)

       device: string
              the device name or node-name of a root node which should be copied.

       sync: MirrorSyncMode
              what  parts  of  the  disk image should be copied to the destination (all the disk,
              only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, from a dirty bitmap, or  only  new
              I/O).

       speed: int (optional)
              the maximum speed, in bytes per second. The default is 0, for unlimited.

       bitmap: string (optional)
              The  name  of  a  dirty  bitmap  to  use.   Must  be present if sync is "bitmap" or
              "incremental".  Can be present if sync is "full" or "top".   Must  not  be  present
              otherwise.  (Since 2.4 (drive-backup), 3.1 (blockdev-backup))

       bitmap-mode: BitmapSyncMode (optional)
              Specifies the type of data the bitmap should contain after the operation concludes.
              Must be present if a bitmap was provided, Must NOT  be  present  otherwise.  (Since
              4.2)

       compress: boolean (optional)
              true  to  compress data, if the target format supports it.  (default: false) (since
              2.8)

       on-source-error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
              the action to take on an  error  on  the  source,  default  'report'.   'stop'  and
              'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io-status (see BlockInfo).

       on-target-error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
              the  action  to  take  on an error on the target, default 'report' (no limitations,
              since this applies to a different block device than device).

       auto-finalize: boolean (optional)
              When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished  its  work,
              waiting  for  block-job-finalize before making any block graph changes.  When true,
              this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions.  Defaults to true.
              (Since 2.12)

       auto-dismiss: boolean (optional)
              When  false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased
              all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss.  When true,  this  job  will  automatically
              disappear  from the query list without user intervention.  Defaults to true. (Since
              2.12)

       filter-node-name: string (optional)
              the node name that should be assigned to the filter  driver  that  the  backup  job
              inserts  into the graph above node specified by drive. If this option is not given,
              a node name is autogenerated. (Since: 4.2)

       x-perf: BackupPerf (optional)
              Performance options. (Since 6.0)

   Features
       unstable
              Member x-perf is experimental.

   Note
       on-source-error and on-target-error only affect background I/O.  If an error occurs during
       a guest write request, the device's rerror/werror actions will be used.

   Since
       4.2

   DriveBackup (Object)
   Members
       target: string
              the target of the new image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, the existing
              file/device will be used as the new destination.  If it does not exist, a new  file
              will be created.

       format: string (optional)
              the  format of the new destination, default is to probe if mode is 'existing', else
              the format of the source

       mode: NewImageMode (optional)
              whether and how QEMU should create a new image, default is 'absolute-paths'.

       The members of BackupCommon

   Since
       1.6

   BlockdevBackup (Object)
   Members
       target: string
              the device name or node-name of the backup target node.

       The members of BackupCommon

   Since
       2.3

   blockdev-snapshot-sync (Command)
       Takes a synchronous snapshot of a block device.

       For the arguments, see the documentation of BlockdevSnapshotSync.

   Returns
       • nothing on success

       • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot-sync",
               "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0",
                              "snapshot-file":
                              "/some/place/my-image",
                              "format": "qcow2" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   blockdev-snapshot (Command)
       Takes a snapshot of a block device.

       Take a snapshot, by installing 'node' as the backing image of 'overlay'. Additionally,  if
       'node'  is  associated with a block device, the block device changes to using 'overlay' as
       its new active image.

       For the arguments, see the documentation of BlockdevSnapshot.

   Features
       allow-write-only-overlay
              If present, the check whether this operation is safe was relaxed so that it can  be
              used to change backing file of a destination of a blockdev-mirror.  (since 5.0)

   Since
       2.5

   Example
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-add",
               "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2",
                              "node-name": "node1534",
                              "file": { "driver": "file",
                                        "filename": "hd1.qcow2" },
                              "backing": null } }

          <- { "return": {} }

          -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot",
               "arguments": { "node": "ide-hd0",
                              "overlay": "node1534" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   change-backing-file (Command)
       Change  the  backing  file in the image file metadata.  This does not cause QEMU to reopen
       the image file to reparse the backing filename (it  may,  however,  perform  a  reopen  to
       change  permissions  from  r/o  ->  r/w -> r/o, if needed). The new backing file string is
       written into the image file metadata, and the QEMU internal strings are updated.

   Arguments
       image-node-name: string
              The name of the block driver state node  of  the  image  to  modify.  The  "device"
              argument is used to verify "image-node-name" is in the chain described by "device".

       device: string
              The device name or node-name of the root node that owns image-node-name.

       backing-file: string
              The  string  to  write  as the backing file.  This string is not validated, so care
              should be taken when specifying the string or the image chain may not be able to be
              reopened again.

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If "device" does not exist or cannot be determined, DeviceNotFound

   Since
       2.1

   block-commit (Command)
       Live  commit  of  data  from  overlay  image  nodes into backing nodes - i.e., writes data
       between 'top' and 'base' into 'base'.

       If top == base, that is an error.  If top has no overlays on top of it, or if it is in use
       by  a writer, the job will not be completed by itself.  The user needs to complete the job
       with the block-job-complete command after getting the ready event. (Since 2.0)

       If the base image is smaller than top, then the base image will be resized to be the  same
       size  as  top.  If top is smaller than the base image, the base will not be truncated.  If
       you want the base image size to match the size of the smaller top, you can safely truncate
       it yourself once the commit operation successfully completes.

   Arguments
       job-id: string (optional)
              identifier  for  the  newly-created  block job. If omitted, the device name will be
              used. (Since 2.7)

       device: string
              the device name or node-name of a root node

       base-node: string (optional)
              The node name of the backing image to write data into.  If not specified,  this  is
              the deepest backing image.  (since: 3.1)

       base: string (optional)
              Same as base-node, except that it is a file name rather than a node name. This must
              be the exact filename string that was used to open the node; other strings, even if
              addressing the same file, are not accepted

       top-node: string (optional)
              The  node  name  of  the  backing  image  within the image chain which contains the
              topmost data to be committed down. If not specified,  this  is  the  active  layer.
              (since: 3.1)

       top: string (optional)
              Same  as top-node, except that it is a file name rather than a node name. This must
              be the exact filename string that was used to open the node; other strings, even if
              addressing the same file, are not accepted

       backing-file: string (optional)
              The  backing  file  string to write into the overlay image of 'top'.  If 'top' does
              not have an overlay image, or if 'top' is in use by a writer, specifying a  backing
              file string is an error.

              This  filename  is  not  validated.  If a pathname string is such that it cannot be
              resolved by QEMU,  that  means  that  subsequent  QMP  or  HMP  commands  must  use
              node-names for the image in question, as filename lookup methods will fail.

              If not specified, QEMU will automatically determine the backing file string to use,
              or error out if there is no obvious choice. Care should be  taken  when  specifying
              the string, to specify a valid filename or protocol.  (Since 2.1)

       speed: int (optional)
              the maximum speed, in bytes per second

       on-error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
              the  action to take on an error. 'ignore' means that the request should be retried.
              (default: report; Since: 5.0)

       filter-node-name: string (optional)
              the node name that should be assigned to the filter  driver  that  the  commit  job
              inserts  into  the  graph  above  top.  If this option is not given, a node name is
              autogenerated. (Since: 2.9)

       auto-finalize: boolean (optional)
              When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished  its  work,
              waiting  for  block-job-finalize before making any block graph changes.  When true,
              this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions.  Defaults to true.
              (Since 3.1)

       auto-dismiss: boolean (optional)
              When  false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased
              all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss.  When true,  this  job  will  automatically
              disappear  from the query list without user intervention.  Defaults to true. (Since
              3.1)

   Features
       deprecated
              Members base and top are deprecated.  Use base-node and top-node instead.

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If device does not exist, DeviceNotFound

       • Any other error returns a GenericError.

   Since
       1.3

   Example
          -> { "execute": "block-commit",
               "arguments": { "device": "virtio0",
                              "top": "/tmp/snap1.qcow2" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   drive-backup (Command)
       Start a point-in-time copy of a block device to a new destination.  The status of  ongoing
       drive-backup  operations  can be checked with query-block-jobs where the BlockJobInfo.type
       field has the value 'backup'.  The operation can be stopped before it has completed  using
       the block-job-cancel command.

   Arguments
       The members of DriveBackup

   Features
       deprecated
              This command is deprecated. Use blockdev-backup instead.

   Returns
       • nothing on success

       • If device is not a valid block device, GenericError

   Since
       1.6

   Example
          -> { "execute": "drive-backup",
               "arguments": { "device": "drive0",
                              "sync": "full",
                              "target": "backup.img" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   blockdev-backup (Command)
       Start  a point-in-time copy of a block device to a new destination.  The status of ongoing
       blockdev-backup   operations   can   be   checked   with   query-block-jobs   where    the
       BlockJobInfo.type  field  has  the value 'backup'.  The operation can be stopped before it
       has completed using the block-job-cancel command.

   Arguments
       The members of BlockdevBackup

   Returns
       • nothing on success

       • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

   Since
       2.3

   Example
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-backup",
               "arguments": { "device": "src-id",
                              "sync": "full",
                              "target": "tgt-id" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   query-named-block-nodes (Command)
       Get the named block driver list

   Arguments
       flat: boolean (optional)
              Omit the nested data about backing image ("backing-image" key) if true.  Default is
              false (Since 5.0)

   Returns
       the list of BlockDeviceInfo

   Since
       2.0

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-named-block-nodes" }
          <- { "return": [ { "ro":false,
                             "drv":"qcow2",
                             "encrypted":false,
                             "file":"disks/test.qcow2",
                             "node-name": "my-node",
                             "backing_file_depth":1,
                             "bps":1000000,
                             "bps_rd":0,
                             "bps_wr":0,
                             "iops":1000000,
                             "iops_rd":0,
                             "iops_wr":0,
                             "bps_max": 8000000,
                             "bps_rd_max": 0,
                             "bps_wr_max": 0,
                             "iops_max": 0,
                             "iops_rd_max": 0,
                             "iops_wr_max": 0,
                             "iops_size": 0,
                             "write_threshold": 0,
                             "image":{
                                "filename":"disks/test.qcow2",
                                "format":"qcow2",
                                "virtual-size":2048000,
                                "backing_file":"base.qcow2",
                                "full-backing-filename":"disks/base.qcow2",
                                "backing-filename-format":"qcow2",
                                "snapshots":[
                                   {
                                      "id": "1",
                                      "name": "snapshot1",
                                      "vm-state-size": 0,
                                      "date-sec": 10000200,
                                      "date-nsec": 12,
                                      "vm-clock-sec": 206,
                                      "vm-clock-nsec": 30
                                   }
                                ],
                                "backing-image":{
                                    "filename":"disks/base.qcow2",
                                    "format":"qcow2",
                                    "virtual-size":2048000
                                }
                             } } ] }

   XDbgBlockGraphNodeType (Enum)
   Values
       block-backend
              corresponds to BlockBackend

       block-job
              corresponds to BlockJob

       block-driver
              corresponds to BlockDriverState

   Since
       4.0

   XDbgBlockGraphNode (Object)
   Members
       id: int
              Block    graph    node    identifier.    This    id    is    generated   only   for
              x-debug-query-block-graph and does not relate to any other identifiers in Qemu.

       type: XDbgBlockGraphNodeType
              Type of graph node. Can be one of block-backend, block-job or block-driver-state.

       name: string
              Human readable name of the node. Corresponds to  node-name  for  block-driver-state
              nodes;  is  not  guaranteed  to  be  unique in the whole graph (with block-jobs and
              block-backends).

   Since
       4.0

   BlockPermission (Enum)
       Enum of base block permissions.

   Values
       consistent-read
              A user that has the "permission" of consistent reads is guaranteed that their  view
              of  the  contents of the block device is complete and self-consistent, representing
              the contents of a disk at a specific point.   For  most  block  devices  (including
              their  backing  files) this is true, but the property cannot be maintained in a few
              situations like for intermediate nodes of a commit block job.

       write  This permission is required to change the visible disk contents.

       write-unchanged
              This permission (which is weaker than BLK_PERM_WRITE) is both enough  and  required
              for writes to the block node when the caller promises that the visible disk content
              doesn't change.  As the BLK_PERM_WRITE permission is strictly stronger,  either  is
              sufficient to perform an unchanging write.

       resize This permission is required to change the size of a block node.

       graph-mod
              This permission is required to change the node that this BdrvChild points to.

   Since
       4.0

   XDbgBlockGraphEdge (Object)
       Block Graph edge description for x-debug-query-block-graph.

   Members
       parent: int
              parent id

       child: int
              child id

       name: string
              name of the relation (examples are 'file' and 'backing')

       perm: array of BlockPermission
              granted permissions for the parent operating on the child

       shared-perm: array of BlockPermission
              permissions that can still be granted to other users of the child while it is still
              attached to this parent

   Since
       4.0

   XDbgBlockGraph (Object)
       Block Graph - list of nodes and list of edges.

   Members
       nodes: array of XDbgBlockGraphNode
              Not documented

       edges: array of XDbgBlockGraphEdge
              Not documented

   Since
       4.0

   x-debug-query-block-graph (Command)
       Get the block graph.

   Features
       unstable
              This command is meant for debugging.

   Since
       4.0

   drive-mirror (Command)
       Start mirroring a block device's writes to a new destination. target specifies the  target
       of  the  new  image.  If the file exists, or if it is a device, it will be used as the new
       destination for writes. If it does not exist, a new file will be created. format specifies
       the format of the mirror image, default is to probe if mode='existing', else the format of
       the source.

   Arguments
       The members of DriveMirror

   Returns
       • nothing on success

       • If device is not a valid block device, GenericError

   Since
       1.3

   Example
          -> { "execute": "drive-mirror",
               "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0",
                              "target": "/some/place/my-image",
                              "sync": "full",
                              "format": "qcow2" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   DriveMirror (Object)
       A set of parameters describing drive mirror setup.

   Members
       job-id: string (optional)
              identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the  device  name  will  be
              used. (Since 2.7)

       device: string
              the device name or node-name of a root node whose writes should be mirrored.

       target: string
              the target of the new image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, the existing
              file/device will be used as the new destination.  If it does not exist, a new  file
              will be created.

       format: string (optional)
              the  format of the new destination, default is to probe if mode is 'existing', else
              the format of the source

       node-name: string (optional)
              the new block driver state node name in the graph (Since 2.1)

       replaces: string (optional)
              with sync=full graph node name to be replaced by the new image when a  whole  image
              copy  is  done. This can be used to repair broken Quorum files.  By default, device
              is replaced, although implicitly created filters on it are kept. (Since 2.1)

       mode: NewImageMode (optional)
              whether and how QEMU should create a new image, default is 'absolute-paths'.

       speed: int (optional)
              the maximum speed, in bytes per second

       sync: MirrorSyncMode
              what parts of the disk image should be copied to the  destination  (all  the  disk,
              only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, or only new I/O).

       granularity: int (optional)
              granularity  of  the  dirty bitmap, default is 64K if the image format doesn't have
              clusters, 4K if the clusters are smaller than that, else the cluster size.  Must be
              a power of 2 between 512 and 64M (since 1.4).

       buf-size: int (optional)
              maximum amount of data in flight from source to target (since 1.4).

       on-source-error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
              the  action  to  take  on  an  error  on  the source, default 'report'.  'stop' and
              'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io-status (see BlockInfo).

       on-target-error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
              the action to take on an error on the target,  default  'report'  (no  limitations,
              since this applies to a different block device than device).

       unmap: boolean (optional)
              Whether  to  try  to  unmap target sectors where source has only zero. If true, and
              target unallocated sectors  will  read  as  zero,  target  image  sectors  will  be
              unmapped;  otherwise,  zeroes  will  be  written.  Both  will  result  in identical
              contents.  Default is true. (Since 2.4)

       copy-mode: MirrorCopyMode (optional)
              when to copy data to the destination; defaults to 'background' (Since: 3.0)

       auto-finalize: boolean (optional)
              When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished  its  work,
              waiting  for  block-job-finalize before making any block graph changes.  When true,
              this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions.  Defaults to true.
              (Since 3.1)

       auto-dismiss: boolean (optional)
              When  false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased
              all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss.  When true,  this  job  will  automatically
              disappear  from the query list without user intervention.  Defaults to true. (Since
              3.1)

   Since
       1.3

   BlockDirtyBitmap (Object)
   Members
       node: string
              name of device/node which the bitmap is tracking

       name: string
              name of the dirty bitmap

   Since
       2.4

   BlockDirtyBitmapAdd (Object)
   Members
       node: string
              name of device/node which the bitmap is tracking

       name: string
              name of the dirty bitmap (must be less than 1024 bytes)

       granularity: int (optional)
              the bitmap granularity, default is 64k for block-dirty-bitmap-add

       persistent: boolean (optional)
              the bitmap is persistent, i.e. it will be saved to the corresponding  block  device
              image  file  on  its  close.  For  now only Qcow2 disks support persistent bitmaps.
              Default is false for block-dirty-bitmap-add. (Since: 2.10)

       disabled: boolean (optional)
              the bitmap is created in the disabled state, which means that  it  will  not  track
              drive changes. The bitmap may be enabled with block-dirty-bitmap-enable. Default is
              false. (Since: 4.0)

   Since
       2.4

   BlockDirtyBitmapMergeSource (Alternate)
   Members
       local: string
              name of the bitmap, attached to the same node as target bitmap.

       external: BlockDirtyBitmap
              bitmap with specified node

   Since
       4.1

   BlockDirtyBitmapMerge (Object)
   Members
       node: string
              name of device/node which the target bitmap is tracking

       target: string
              name of the destination dirty bitmap

       bitmaps: array of BlockDirtyBitmapMergeSource
              name(s)  of  the  source  dirty  bitmap(s)   at   node   and/or   fully   specified
              BlockDirtyBitmap elements. The latter are supported since 4.1.

   Since
       4.0

   block-dirty-bitmap-add (Command)
       Create a dirty bitmap with a name on the node, and start tracking the writes.

   Returns
       • nothing on success

       • If node is not a valid block device or node, DeviceNotFound

       • If name is already taken, GenericError with an explanation

   Since
       2.4

   Example
          -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-add",
               "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   block-dirty-bitmap-remove (Command)
       Stop   write   tracking   and   remove   the   dirty   bitmap   that   was   created  with
       block-dirty-bitmap-add. If the bitmap is persistent, remove it from its storage too.

   Returns
       • nothing on success

       • If node is not a valid block device or node, DeviceNotFound

       • If name is not found, GenericError with an explanation

       • if name is frozen by an operation, GenericError

   Since
       2.4

   Example
          -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-remove",
               "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   block-dirty-bitmap-clear (Command)
       Clear (reset) a dirty bitmap on the device, so that an incremental backup from this  point
       in time forward will only backup clusters modified after this clear operation.

   Returns
       • nothing on success

       • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

       • If name is not found, GenericError with an explanation

   Since
       2.4

   Example
          -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-clear",
               "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   block-dirty-bitmap-enable (Command)
       Enables a dirty bitmap so that it will begin tracking disk changes.

   Returns
       • nothing on success

       • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

       • If name is not found, GenericError with an explanation

   Since
       4.0

   Example
          -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-enable",
               "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   block-dirty-bitmap-disable (Command)
       Disables a dirty bitmap so that it will stop tracking disk changes.

   Returns
       • nothing on success

       • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

       • If name is not found, GenericError with an explanation

   Since
       4.0

   Example
          -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-disable",
               "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   block-dirty-bitmap-merge (Command)
       Merge  dirty  bitmaps  listed  in  bitmaps  to  the target dirty bitmap.  Dirty bitmaps in
       bitmaps will be unchanged, except if it also  appears  as  the  target  bitmap.  Any  bits
       already  set  in  target  will still be set after the merge, i.e., this operation does not
       clear the target.  On error, target is unchanged.

       The resulting bitmap will count as dirty any clusters that were dirty in any of the source
       bitmaps.  This  can  be  used to achieve backup checkpoints, or in simpler usages, to copy
       bitmaps.

   Returns
       • nothing on success

       • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

       • If any bitmap in bitmaps or target is not found, GenericError

       • If any of the bitmaps have different sizes or granularities, GenericError

   Since
       4.0

   Example
          -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-merge",
               "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "target": "bitmap0",
                              "bitmaps": ["bitmap1"] } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   BlockDirtyBitmapSha256 (Object)
       SHA256 hash of dirty bitmap data

   Members
       sha256: string
              ASCII representation of SHA256 bitmap hash

   Since
       2.10

   x-debug-block-dirty-bitmap-sha256 (Command)
       Get bitmap SHA256.

   Features
       unstable
              This command is meant for debugging.

   Returns
       • BlockDirtyBitmapSha256 on success

       • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

       • If name is not found or if hashing has failed, GenericError with an explanation

   Since
       2.10

   blockdev-mirror (Command)
       Start mirroring a block device's writes to a new destination.

   Arguments
       job-id: string (optional)
              identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the  device  name  will  be
              used. (Since 2.7)

       device: string
              The device name or node-name of a root node whose writes should be mirrored.

       target: string
              the  id  or node-name of the block device to mirror to. This mustn't be attached to
              guest.

       replaces: string (optional)
              with sync=full graph node name to be replaced by the new image when a  whole  image
              copy  is  done. This can be used to repair broken Quorum files.  By default, device
              is replaced, although implicitly created filters on it are kept.

       speed: int (optional)
              the maximum speed, in bytes per second

       sync: MirrorSyncMode
              what parts of the disk image should be copied to the  destination  (all  the  disk,
              only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, or only new I/O).

       granularity: int (optional)
              granularity  of  the  dirty bitmap, default is 64K if the image format doesn't have
              clusters, 4K if the clusters are smaller than that, else the cluster size.  Must be
              a power of 2 between 512 and 64M

       buf-size: int (optional)
              maximum amount of data in flight from source to target

       on-source-error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
              the  action  to  take  on  an  error  on  the source, default 'report'.  'stop' and
              'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io-status (see BlockInfo).

       on-target-error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
              the action to take on an error on the target,  default  'report'  (no  limitations,
              since this applies to a different block device than device).

       filter-node-name: string (optional)
              the  node  name  that  should  be assigned to the filter driver that the mirror job
              inserts into the graph above device. If this option is not given, a  node  name  is
              autogenerated. (Since: 2.9)

       copy-mode: MirrorCopyMode (optional)
              when to copy data to the destination; defaults to 'background' (Since: 3.0)

       auto-finalize: boolean (optional)
              When  false,  this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work,
              waiting for block-job-finalize before making any block graph changes.   When  true,
              this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions.  Defaults to true.
              (Since 3.1)

       auto-dismiss: boolean (optional)
              When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely  ceased
              all  work,  and  awaits  block-job-dismiss.  When true, this job will automatically
              disappear from the query list without user intervention.  Defaults to true.  (Since
              3.1)

   Returns
       nothing on success.

   Since
       2.6

   Example
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-mirror",
               "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0",
                              "target": "target0",
                              "sync": "full" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   BlockIOThrottle (Object)
       A set of parameters describing block throttling.

   Members
       device: string (optional)
              Block device name

       id: string (optional)
              The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)

       bps: int
              total throughput limit in bytes per second

       bps_rd: int
              read throughput limit in bytes per second

       bps_wr: int
              write throughput limit in bytes per second

       iops: int
              total I/O operations per second

       iops_rd: int
              read I/O operations per second

       iops_wr: int
              write I/O operations per second

       bps_max: int (optional)
              total throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)

       bps_rd_max: int (optional)
              read throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)

       bps_wr_max: int (optional)
              write throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)

       iops_max: int (optional)
              total I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)

       iops_rd_max: int (optional)
              read I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)

       iops_wr_max: int (optional)
              write I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)

       bps_max_length: int (optional)
              maximum  length  of  the  bps_max  burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if
              bps_max is set as well.  Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6)

       bps_rd_max_length: int (optional)
              maximum length of the bps_rd_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be  set  if
              bps_rd_max is set as well.  Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6)

       bps_wr_max_length: int (optional)
              maximum  length  of the bps_wr_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if
              bps_wr_max is set as well.  Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6)

       iops_max_length: int (optional)
              maximum length of the iops burst period,  in  seconds.  It  must  only  be  set  if
              iops_max is set as well.  Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6)

       iops_rd_max_length: int (optional)
              maximum  length of the iops_rd_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if
              iops_rd_max is set as well.  Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6)

       iops_wr_max_length: int (optional)
              maximum length of the iops_wr_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set  if
              iops_wr_max is set as well.  Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6)

       iops_size: int (optional)
              an I/O size in bytes (Since 1.7)

       group: string (optional)
              throttle group name (Since 2.4)

   Features
       deprecated
              Member device is deprecated.  Use id instead.

   Since
       1.1

   ThrottleLimits (Object)
       Limit parameters for throttling.  Since some limit combinations are illegal, limits should
       always be set in one transaction. All fields are optional. When setting limits, if a field
       is missing the current value is not changed.

   Members
       iops-total: int (optional)
              limit total I/O operations per second

       iops-total-max: int (optional)
              I/O operations burst

       iops-total-max-length: int (optional)
              length  of  the  iops-total-max  burst  period,  in  seconds It must only be set if
              iops-total-max is set as well.

       iops-read: int (optional)
              limit read operations per second

       iops-read-max: int (optional)
              I/O operations read burst

       iops-read-max-length: int (optional)
              length of the iops-read-max burst period,  in  seconds  It  must  only  be  set  if
              iops-read-max is set as well.

       iops-write: int (optional)
              limit write operations per second

       iops-write-max: int (optional)
              I/O operations write burst

       iops-write-max-length: int (optional)
              length  of  the  iops-write-max  burst  period,  in  seconds It must only be set if
              iops-write-max is set as well.

       bps-total: int (optional)
              limit total bytes per second

       bps-total-max: int (optional)
              total bytes burst

       bps-total-max-length: int (optional)
              length of the bps-total-max burst period, in seconds.   It  must  only  be  set  if
              bps-total-max is set as well.

       bps-read: int (optional)
              limit read bytes per second

       bps-read-max: int (optional)
              total bytes read burst

       bps-read-max-length: int (optional)
              length  of  the  bps-read-max  burst  period,  in  seconds  It  must only be set if
              bps-read-max is set as well.

       bps-write: int (optional)
              limit write bytes per second

       bps-write-max: int (optional)
              total bytes write burst

       bps-write-max-length: int (optional)
              length of the bps-write-max burst period,  in  seconds  It  must  only  be  set  if
              bps-write-max is set as well.

       iops-size: int (optional)
              when limiting by iops max size of an I/O in bytes

   Since
       2.11

   ThrottleGroupProperties (Object)
       Properties for throttle-group objects.

   Members
       limits: ThrottleLimits (optional)
              limits to apply for this throttle group

       x-iops-total: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-iops-total-max: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-iops-total-max-length: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-iops-read: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-iops-read-max: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-iops-read-max-length: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-iops-write: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-iops-write-max: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-iops-write-max-length: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-bps-total: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-bps-total-max: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-bps-total-max-length: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-bps-read: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-bps-read-max: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-bps-read-max-length: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-bps-write: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-bps-write-max: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-bps-write-max-length: int (optional)
              Not documented

       x-iops-size: int (optional)
              Not documented

   Features
       unstable
              All  members starting with x- are aliases for the same key without x- in the limits
              object.  This is not a stable interface and may be removed or changed  incompatibly
              in the future.  Use limits for a supported stable interface.

   Since
       2.11

   block-stream (Command)
       Copy data from a backing file into a block device.

       The block streaming operation is performed in the background until the entire backing file
       has been copied.  This command returns immediately once streaming has started.  The status
       of ongoing block streaming operations can be checked with query-block-jobs.  The operation
       can be stopped before it has completed using the block-job-cancel command.

       The node that receives the data is called the top image, can be located in any part of the
       chain  (but  always above the base image; see below) and can be specified using its device
       or node name. Earlier qemu versions only allowed 'device' to  name  the  top  level  node;
       presence of the 'base-node' parameter during introspection can be used as a witness of the
       enhanced semantics of 'device'.

       If a base file is specified then sectors are not  copied  from  that  base  file  and  its
       backing  chain.   This can be used to stream a subset of the backing file chain instead of
       flattening the entire image.  When streaming completes the image file will have  the  base
       file as its backing file, unless that node was changed while the job was running.  In that
       case, base's parent's backing (or filtered, whichever exists) child  (i.e.,  base  at  the
       beginning of the job) will be the new backing file.

       On  successful  completion  the  image  file  is  updated to drop the backing file and the
       BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED event is emitted.

       In case device is a filter node, block-stream modifies the first non-filter  overlay  node
       below it to point to the new backing node instead of modifying device itself.

   Arguments
       job-id: string (optional)
              identifier  for  the  newly-created  block job. If omitted, the device name will be
              used. (Since 2.7)

       device: string
              the device or node name of the top image

       base: string (optional)
              the common backing file name.  It cannot be set if base-node or bottom is also set.

       base-node: string (optional)
              the node name of the backing file.  It cannot be set if base or bottom is also set.
              (Since 2.8)

       bottom: string (optional)
              the  last  node  in the chain that should be streamed into top. It cannot be set if
              base or base-node is also set.  It cannot be filter node. (Since 6.0)

       backing-file: string (optional)
              The backing file string  to  write  into  the  top  image.  This  filename  is  not
              validated.

              If  a  pathname  string is such that it cannot be resolved by QEMU, that means that
              subsequent QMP or HMP commands must use node-names for the image  in  question,  as
              filename lookup methods will fail.

              If not specified, QEMU will automatically determine the backing file string to use,
              or error out if there is no obvious choice.  Care should be taken  when  specifying
              the string, to specify a valid filename or protocol.  (Since 2.1)

       speed: int (optional)
              the maximum speed, in bytes per second

       on-error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
              the  action  to take on an error (default report).  'stop' and 'enospc' can only be
              used if the block device supports io-status (see BlockInfo).  Since 1.3.

       filter-node-name: string (optional)
              the node name that should be assigned to the filter  driver  that  the  stream  job
              inserts  into  the  graph above device. If this option is not given, a node name is
              autogenerated. (Since: 6.0)

       auto-finalize: boolean (optional)
              When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished  its  work,
              waiting  for  block-job-finalize before making any block graph changes.  When true,
              this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions.  Defaults to true.
              (Since 3.1)

       auto-dismiss: boolean (optional)
              When  false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased
              all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss.  When true,  this  job  will  automatically
              disappear  from the query list without user intervention.  Defaults to true. (Since
              3.1)

   Returns
       • Nothing on success.

       • If device does not exist, DeviceNotFound.

   Since
       1.1

   Example
          -> { "execute": "block-stream",
               "arguments": { "device": "virtio0",
                              "base": "/tmp/master.qcow2" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   block-job-set-speed (Command)
       Set maximum speed for a background block operation.

       This command can only be issued when there is an active block job.

       Throttling can be disabled by setting the speed to 0.

   Arguments
       device: string
              The job identifier. This  used  to  be  a  device  name  (hence  the  name  of  the
              parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.

       speed: int
              the maximum speed, in bytes per second, or 0 for unlimited.  Defaults to 0.

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive

   Since
       1.1

   block-job-cancel (Command)
       Stop an active background block operation.

       This  command  returns immediately after marking the active background block operation for
       cancellation.  It is an error to call this command if no operation is in progress.

       The operation will cancel as soon as possible and then emit the BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED event.
       Before that happens the job is still visible when enumerated using query-block-jobs.

       Note  that  if  you  issue  'block-job-cancel' after 'drive-mirror' has indicated (via the
       event BLOCK_JOB_READY) that the source and destination are synchronized,  then  the  event
       triggered  by  this command changes to BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED, to indicate that the mirroring
       has ended and the destination now has a  point-in-time  copy  tied  to  the  time  of  the
       cancellation.

       For  streaming,  the  image  file  retains its backing file unless the streaming operation
       happens to complete just as it is being cancelled.   A  new  streaming  operation  can  be
       started at a later time to finish copying all data from the backing file.

   Arguments
       device: string
              The  job  identifier.  This  used  to  be  a  device  name  (hence  the name of the
              parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.

       force: boolean (optional)
              If true, and the job has already emitted the event BLOCK_JOB_READY, abandon the job
              immediately  (even  if  it  is  paused)  instead  of waiting for the destination to
              complete its final synchronization (since 1.3)

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive

   Since
       1.1

   block-job-pause (Command)
       Pause an active background block operation.

       This command returns immediately after marking the active background block  operation  for
       pausing.  It is an error to call this command if no operation is in progress or if the job
       is already paused.

       The operation will pause as soon as possible.  No event is emitted when the  operation  is
       actually paused.  Cancelling a paused job automatically resumes it.

   Arguments
       device: string
              The  job  identifier.  This  used  to  be  a  device  name  (hence  the name of the
              parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive

   Since
       1.3

   block-job-resume (Command)
       Resume an active background block operation.

       This command returns immediately after resuming a paused background block  operation.   It
       is  an  error  to  call  this  command if no operation is in progress or if the job is not
       paused.

       This command also clears the error status of the job.

   Arguments
       device: string
              The job identifier. This  used  to  be  a  device  name  (hence  the  name  of  the
              parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive

   Since
       1.3

   block-job-complete (Command)
       Manually  trigger  completion  of an active background block operation.  This is supported
       for drive mirroring, where it also switches the device to write to the target  path  only.
       The ability to complete is signaled with a BLOCK_JOB_READY event.

       This  command  completes an active background block operation synchronously.  The ordering
       of this command's return with the BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED event is not defined.  Note that  if
       an  I/O  error  occurs  during  the processing of this command: 1) the command itself will
       fail; 2) the error will be processed according to the rerror/werror  arguments  that  were
       specified when starting the operation.

       A cancelled or paused job cannot be completed.

   Arguments
       device: string
              The  job  identifier.  This  used  to  be  a  device  name  (hence  the name of the
              parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive

   Since
       1.3

   block-job-dismiss (Command)
       For jobs that have already concluded, remove them  from  the  block-job-query  list.  This
       command  only  needs  to  be  run for jobs which were started with QEMU 2.12+ job lifetime
       management semantics.

       This command will refuse to operate on any job that  has  not  yet  reached  its  terminal
       state,  JOB_STATUS_CONCLUDED.  For  jobs  that  make  use  of  the  BLOCK_JOB_READY event,
       block-job-cancel or block-job-complete will still need to be used as appropriate.

   Arguments
       id: string
              The job identifier.

   Returns
       Nothing on success

   Since
       2.12

   block-job-finalize (Command)
       Once a job that has manual=true reaches  the  pending  state,  it  can  be  instructed  to
       finalize  any  graph changes and do any necessary cleanup via this command.  For jobs in a
       transaction, instructing one job to finalize will force ALL jobs  in  the  transaction  to
       finalize, so it is only necessary to instruct a single member job to finalize.

   Arguments
       id: string
              The job identifier.

   Returns
       Nothing on success

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevDiscardOptions (Enum)
       Determines how to handle discard requests.

   Values
       ignore Ignore the request

       unmap  Forward as an unmap request

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions (Enum)
       Describes  the  operation mode for the automatic conversion of plain zero writes by the OS
       to driver specific optimized zero write commands.

   Values
       off    Disabled (default)

       on     Enabled

       unmap  Enabled and even  try  to  unmap  blocks  if  possible.  This  requires  also  that
              BlockdevDiscardOptions is set to unmap for this device.

   Since
       2.1

   BlockdevAioOptions (Enum)
       Selects the AIO backend to handle I/O requests

   Values
       threads
              Use qemu's thread pool

       native Use native AIO backend (only Linux and Windows)

       io_uring (If: CONFIG_LINUX_IO_URING)
              Use linux io_uring (since 5.0)

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevCacheOptions (Object)
       Includes cache-related options for block devices

   Members
       direct: boolean (optional)
              enables use of O_DIRECT (bypass the host page cache; default: false)

       no-flush: boolean (optional)
              ignore any flush requests for the device (default: false)

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevDriver (Enum)
       Drivers that are supported in block device operations.

   Values
       throttle
              Since 2.11

       nvme   Since 2.12

       copy-on-read
              Since 3.0

       blklogwrites
              Since 3.0

       blkreplay
              Since 4.2

       compress
              Since 5.0

       copy-before-write
              Since 6.2

       blkdebug
              Not documented

       blkverify
              Not documented

       bochs  Not documented

       cloop  Not documented

       dmg    Not documented

       file   Not documented

       ftp    Not documented

       ftps   Not documented

       gluster
              Not documented

       host_cdrom (If: HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE)
              Not documented

       host_device (If: HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE)
              Not documented

       http   Not documented

       https  Not documented

       iscsi  Not documented

       luks   Not documented

       nbd    Not documented

       nfs    Not documented

       null-aio
              Not documented

       null-co
              Not documented

       parallels
              Not documented

       preallocate
              Not documented

       qcow   Not documented

       qcow2  Not documented

       qed    Not documented

       quorum Not documented

       raw    Not documented

       rbd    Not documented

       replication (If: CONFIG_REPLICATION)
              Not documented

       ssh    Not documented

       vdi    Not documented

       vhdx   Not documented

       vmdk   Not documented

       vpc    Not documented

       vvfat  Not documented

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsFile (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for the file backend.

   Members
       filename: string
              path to the image file

       pr-manager: string (optional)
              the  id  for  the  object  that will handle persistent reservations for this device
              (default: none, forward the commands via SG_IO; since 2.11)

       aio: BlockdevAioOptions (optional)
              AIO backend (default: threads) (since: 2.8)

       aio-max-batch: int (optional)
              maximum number of requests to batch together into a single submission  in  the  AIO
              backend.  The  smallest  value  between  this  and  the  aio-max-batch value of the
              IOThread  object  is  chosen.   0  means  that  the  AIO  backend  will  handle  it
              automatically.  (default: 0, since 6.2)

       locking: OnOffAuto (optional)
              whether  to  enable  file  locking.  If  set  to 'auto', only enable when Open File
              Descriptor (OFD) locking API is available (default: auto, since 2.10)

       drop-cache: boolean (optional) (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
              invalidate page cache during live migration.   This  prevents  stale  data  on  the
              migration  destination  with  cache.direct=off.   Currently only supported on Linux
              hosts.  (default: on, since: 4.0)

       x-check-cache-dropped: boolean (optional)
              whether to check that  page  cache  was  dropped  on  live  migration.   May  cause
              noticeable  delays if the image file is large, do not use in production.  (default:
              off) (since: 3.0)

   Features
       dynamic-auto-read-only
              If present, enabled auto-read-only means  that  the  driver  will  open  the  image
              read-only  at  first,  dynamically  reopen the image file read-write when the first
              writer is attached to the node  and  reopen  read-only  when  the  last  writer  is
              detached.  This  allows  giving  QEMU  write  permissions  only  on  demand when an
              operation actually needs write access.

       unstable
              Member x-check-cache-dropped is meant for debugging.

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsNull (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for the null backend.

   Members
       size: int (optional)
              size of the device in bytes.

       latency-ns: int (optional)
              emulated latency (in nanoseconds) in processing requests.  Default  to  zero  which
              completes requests immediately.  (Since 2.4)

       read-zeroes: boolean (optional)
              if  true,  reads  from  the  device  produce  zeroes;  if false, the buffer is left
              unchanged. (default: false; since: 4.1)

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsNVMe (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for the NVMe backend.

   Members
       device: string
              PCI   controller   address   of   the   NVMe   device   in   format    hhhh:bb:ss.f
              (host:bus:slot.function)

       namespace: int
              namespace number of the device, starting from 1.
       Note  that  the  PCI  device  must  have  been  unbound from any host kernel driver before
       instructing QEMU to add the blockdev.

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevOptionsVVFAT (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for the vvfat protocol.

   Members
       dir: string
              directory to be exported as FAT image

       fat-type: int (optional)
              FAT type: 12, 16 or 32

       floppy: boolean (optional)
              whether to export a floppy image (true) or partitioned hard disk (false; default)

       label: string (optional)
              set the volume label, limited to 11 bytes. FAT16 and FAT32 traditionally have  some
              restrictions  on  labels,  which are ignored by most operating systems. Defaults to
              "QEMU VVFAT".  (since 2.4)

       rw: boolean (optional)
              whether to allow write operations (default: false)

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for image format that have no  option  besides  their
       data source.

   Members
       file: BlockdevRef
              reference to or definition of the data source block device

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsLUKS (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for LUKS.

   Members
       key-secret: string (optional)
              the  ID  of  a  QCryptoSecret  object  providing  the  decryption  key (since 2.6).
              Mandatory except when doing a metadata-only probe of the image.

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for image format that have no  option  besides  their
       data source and an optional backing file.

   Members
       backing: BlockdevRefOrNull (optional)
              reference  to  or  definition  of  the backing file block device, null disables the
              backing file entirely.  Defaults to the backing file stored the image file.

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat

   Since
       2.9

   Qcow2OverlapCheckMode (Enum)
       General overlap check modes.

   Values
       none   Do not perform any checks

       constant
              Perform only checks which can be done in constant time and without reading anything
              from disk

       cached Perform only checks which can be done without reading anything from disk

       all    Perform all available overlap checks

   Since
       2.9

   Qcow2OverlapCheckFlags (Object)
       Structure of flags for each metadata structure. Setting a field to 'true' makes qemu guard
       that structure against unintended overwriting. The default value is  chosen  according  to
       the template given.

   Members
       template: Qcow2OverlapCheckMode (optional)
              Specifies  a template mode which can be adjusted using the other flags, defaults to
              'cached'

       bitmap-directory: boolean (optional)
              since 3.0

       main-header: boolean (optional)
              Not documented

       active-l1: boolean (optional)
              Not documented

       active-l2: boolean (optional)
              Not documented

       refcount-table: boolean (optional)
              Not documented

       refcount-block: boolean (optional)
              Not documented

       snapshot-table: boolean (optional)
              Not documented

       inactive-l1: boolean (optional)
              Not documented

       inactive-l2: boolean (optional)
              Not documented

   Since
       2.9

   Qcow2OverlapChecks (Alternate)
       Specifies which metadata structures should be guarded against unintended overwriting.

   Members
       flags: Qcow2OverlapCheckFlags
              set of flags for separate specification of each metadata structure type

       mode: Qcow2OverlapCheckMode
              named mode which chooses a specific set of flags

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevQcowEncryptionFormat (Enum)
   Values
       aes    AES-CBC with plain64 initialization vectors

   Since
       2.10

   BlockdevQcowEncryption (Object)
   Members
       format: BlockdevQcowEncryptionFormat
              Not documented

       The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow when format is "aes"

   Since
       2.10

   BlockdevOptionsQcow (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for qcow.

   Members
       encrypt: BlockdevQcowEncryption (optional)
              Image decryption options. Mandatory for  encrypted  images,  except  when  doing  a
              metadata-only probe of the image.

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat

   Since
       2.10

   BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat (Enum)
   Values
       aes    AES-CBC with plain64 initialization vectors

       luks   Not documented

   Since
       2.10

   BlockdevQcow2Encryption (Object)
   Members
       format: BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat
              Not documented

       The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow when format is "aes"

       The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS when format is "luks"

   Since
       2.10

   BlockdevOptionsPreallocate (Object)
       Filter   driver  intended  to  be  inserted  between  format  and  protocol  node  and  do
       preallocation in protocol node on write.

   Members
       prealloc-align: int (optional)
              on preallocation, align file length to this number, default 1048576 (1M)

       prealloc-size: int (optional)
              how much to preallocate, default 134217728 (128M)

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat

   Since
       6.0

   BlockdevOptionsQcow2 (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for qcow2.

   Members
       lazy-refcounts: boolean (optional)
              whether to enable the lazy refcounts feature (default is taken from the image file)

       pass-discard-request: boolean (optional)
              whether discard requests to the qcow2 device should be forwarded to the data source

       pass-discard-snapshot: boolean (optional)
              whether discard requests for the data source  should  be  issued  when  a  snapshot
              operation (e.g.  deleting a snapshot) frees clusters in the qcow2 file

       pass-discard-other: boolean (optional)
              whether  discard  requests  for the data source should be issued on other occasions
              where a cluster gets freed

       overlap-check: Qcow2OverlapChecks (optional)
              which overlap checks to perform for writes  to  the  image,  defaults  to  'cached'
              (since 2.2)

       cache-size: int (optional)
              the  maximum  total  size of the L2 table and refcount block caches in bytes (since
              2.2)

       l2-cache-size: int (optional)
              the maximum size of the L2 table cache in bytes (since 2.2)

       l2-cache-entry-size: int (optional)
              the size of each entry in the L2 cache in bytes. It must be a power of two  between
              512 and the cluster size. The default value is the cluster size (since 2.12)

       refcount-cache-size: int (optional)
              the maximum size of the refcount block cache in bytes (since 2.2)

       cache-clean-interval: int (optional)
              clean unused entries in the L2 and refcount caches. The interval is in seconds. The
              default value is 600 on supporting platforms, and 0 on other platforms. 0  disables
              this feature. (since 2.5)

       encrypt: BlockdevQcow2Encryption (optional)
              Image  decryption  options.  Mandatory  for  encrypted  images, except when doing a
              metadata-only probe of the image. (since 2.10)

       data-file: BlockdevRef (optional)
              reference to or definition of the external data file.  This may only  be  specified
              for  images  that require an external data file. If it is not specified for such an
              image, the data file name is loaded from the image file. (since 4.0)

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat

   Since
       2.9

   SshHostKeyCheckMode (Enum)
   Values
       none   Don't check the host key at all

       hash   Compare the host key with a given hash

       known_hosts
              Check the host key against the known_hosts file

   Since
       2.12

   SshHostKeyCheckHashType (Enum)
   Values
       md5    The given hash is an md5 hash

       sha1   The given hash is an sha1 hash

       sha256 The given hash is an sha256 hash

   Since
       2.12

   SshHostKeyHash (Object)
   Members
       type: SshHostKeyCheckHashType
              The hash algorithm used for the hash

       hash: string
              The expected hash value

   Since
       2.12

   SshHostKeyCheck (Object)
   Members
       mode: SshHostKeyCheckMode
              Not documented

       The members of SshHostKeyHash when mode is "hash"

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevOptionsSsh (Object)
   Members
       server: InetSocketAddress
              host address

       path: string
              path to the image on the host

       user: string (optional)
              user as which to connect, defaults to current local user name

       host-key-check: SshHostKeyCheck (optional)
              Defines how and what to check the host key against (default: known_hosts)

   Since
       2.9

   BlkdebugEvent (Enum)
       Trigger events supported by blkdebug.

   Values
       l1_shrink_write_table
              write zeros to the l1 table to shrink image.  (since 2.11)

       l1_shrink_free_l2_clusters
              discard the l2 tables. (since 2.11)

       cor_write
              a write due to copy-on-read (since 2.11)

       cluster_alloc_space
              an allocation of file space for a cluster (since 4.1)

       none   triggers once at creation of the blkdebug node (since 4.1)

       l1_update
              Not documented

       l1_grow_alloc_table
              Not documented

       l1_grow_write_table
              Not documented

       l1_grow_activate_table
              Not documented

       l2_load
              Not documented

       l2_update
              Not documented

       l2_update_compressed
              Not documented

       l2_alloc_cow_read
              Not documented

       l2_alloc_write
              Not documented

       read_aio
              Not documented

       read_backing_aio
              Not documented

       read_compressed
              Not documented

       write_aio
              Not documented

       write_compressed
              Not documented

       vmstate_load
              Not documented

       vmstate_save
              Not documented

       cow_read
              Not documented

       cow_write
              Not documented

       reftable_load
              Not documented

       reftable_grow
              Not documented

       reftable_update
              Not documented

       refblock_load
              Not documented

       refblock_update
              Not documented

       refblock_update_part
              Not documented

       refblock_alloc
              Not documented

       refblock_alloc_hookup
              Not documented

       refblock_alloc_write
              Not documented

       refblock_alloc_write_blocks
              Not documented

       refblock_alloc_write_table
              Not documented

       refblock_alloc_switch_table
              Not documented

       cluster_alloc
              Not documented

       cluster_alloc_bytes
              Not documented

       cluster_free
              Not documented

       flush_to_os
              Not documented

       flush_to_disk
              Not documented

       pwritev_rmw_head
              Not documented

       pwritev_rmw_after_head
              Not documented

       pwritev_rmw_tail
              Not documented

       pwritev_rmw_after_tail
              Not documented

       pwritev
              Not documented

       pwritev_zero
              Not documented

       pwritev_done
              Not documented

       empty_image_prepare
              Not documented

   Since
       2.9

   BlkdebugIOType (Enum)
       Kinds of I/O that blkdebug can inject errors in.

   Values
       read   .bdrv_co_preadv()

       write  .bdrv_co_pwritev()

       write-zeroes
              .bdrv_co_pwrite_zeroes()

       discard
              .bdrv_co_pdiscard()

       flush  .bdrv_co_flush_to_disk()

       block-status
              .bdrv_co_block_status()

   Since
       4.1

   BlkdebugInjectErrorOptions (Object)
       Describes a single error injection for blkdebug.

   Members
       event: BlkdebugEvent
              trigger event

       state: int (optional)
              the state identifier blkdebug needs  to  be  in  to  actually  trigger  the  event;
              defaults to "any"

       iotype: BlkdebugIOType (optional)
              the type of I/O operations on which this error should be injected; defaults to "all
              read, write, write-zeroes, discard, and flush operations" (since: 4.1)

       errno: int (optional)
              error identifier (errno) to be returned; defaults to EIO

       sector: int (optional)
              specifies the sector index which has to be affected in order  to  actually  trigger
              the event; defaults to "any sector"

       once: boolean (optional)
              disables further events after this one has been triggered; defaults to false

       immediately: boolean (optional)
              fail immediately; defaults to false

   Since
       2.9

   BlkdebugSetStateOptions (Object)
       Describes a single state-change event for blkdebug.

   Members
       event: BlkdebugEvent
              trigger event

       state: int (optional)
              the current state identifier blkdebug needs to be in; defaults to "any"

       new_state: int
              the state identifier blkdebug is supposed to assume if this event is triggered

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsBlkdebug (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for blkdebug.

   Members
       image: BlockdevRef
              underlying raw block device (or image file)

       config: string (optional)
              filename of the configuration file

       align: int (optional)
              required  alignment  for  requests  in bytes, must be positive power of 2, or 0 for
              default

       max-transfer: int (optional)
              maximum size for I/O transfers in bytes, must be positive multiple of align and  of
              the  underlying  file's  request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for
              default (since 2.10)

       opt-write-zero: int (optional)
              preferred alignment for write zero requests in bytes, must be positive multiple  of
              align  and  of  the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of
              2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)

       max-write-zero: int (optional)
              maximum size for write zero requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of  align,
              of  opt-write-zero, and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be
              a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)

       opt-discard: int (optional)
              preferred alignment for discard requests in bytes, must  be  positive  multiple  of
              align  and  of  the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of
              2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)

       max-discard: int (optional)
              maximum size for discard requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of align,  of
              opt-discard,  and  of  the  underlying  file's request alignment (but need not be a
              power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)

       inject-error: array of BlkdebugInjectErrorOptions (optional)
              array of error injection descriptions

       set-state: array of BlkdebugSetStateOptions (optional)
              array of state-change descriptions

       take-child-perms: array of BlockPermission (optional)
              Permissions to take on image in addition to what is necessary anyway (which depends
              on how the blkdebug node is used).  Defaults to none.  (since 5.0)

       unshare-child-perms: array of BlockPermission (optional)
              Permissions  not  to  share  on  image  in addition to what cannot be shared anyway
              (which depends on how the blkdebug node is used).  Defaults to none.  (since 5.0)

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsBlklogwrites (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for blklogwrites.

   Members
       file: BlockdevRef
              block device

       log: BlockdevRef
              block device used to log writes to file

       log-sector-size: int (optional)
              sector size used in logging writes to file, determines granularity of  offsets  and
              sizes of writes (default: 512)

       log-append: boolean (optional)
              append to an existing log (default: false)

       log-super-update-interval: int (optional)
              interval  of  write  requests  after  which  the log super block is updated to disk
              (default: 4096)

   Since
       3.0

   BlockdevOptionsBlkverify (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for blkverify.

   Members
       test: BlockdevRef
              block device to be tested

       raw: BlockdevRef
              raw image used for verification

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsBlkreplay (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for blkreplay.

   Members
       image: BlockdevRef
              disk image which should be controlled with blkreplay

   Since
       4.2

   QuorumReadPattern (Enum)
       An enumeration of quorum read patterns.

   Values
       quorum read all the children and do a quorum vote on reads

       fifo   read only from the first child that has not failed

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsQuorum (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for Quorum

   Members
       blkverify: boolean (optional)

              true if the driver must print content mismatch
                     set to false by default

       children: array of BlockdevRef
              the children block devices to use

       vote-threshold: int
              the vote limit under which a read will fail

       rewrite-corrupted: boolean (optional)
              rewrite corrupted data when quorum is reached (Since 2.1)

       read-pattern: QuorumReadPattern (optional)
              choose read pattern and set to quorum by default (Since 2.2)

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsGluster (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for Gluster

   Members
       volume: string
              name of gluster volume where VM image resides

       path: string
              absolute path to image file in gluster volume

       server: array of SocketAddress
              gluster servers description

       debug: int (optional)
              libgfapi log level (default '4' which is Error) (Since 2.8)

       logfile: string (optional)
              libgfapi log file (default /dev/stderr) (Since 2.8)

   Since
       2.9

   IscsiTransport (Enum)
       An enumeration of libiscsi transport types

   Values
       tcp    Not documented

       iser   Not documented

   Since
       2.9

   IscsiHeaderDigest (Enum)
       An enumeration of header digests supported by libiscsi

   Values
       crc32c Not documented

       none   Not documented

       crc32c-none
              Not documented

       none-crc32c
              Not documented

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsIscsi (Object)
   Members
       transport: IscsiTransport
              The iscsi transport type

       portal: string
              The address of the iscsi portal

       target: string
              The target iqn name

       lun: int (optional)
              LUN to connect to. Defaults to 0.

       user: string (optional)
              User name to log in with. If omitted, no CHAP authentication is performed.

       password-secret: string (optional)
              The ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the password for the login. This  option
              is required if user is specified.

       initiator-name: string (optional)
              The iqn name we want to identify to the target as. If this option is not specified,
              an initiator name is generated automatically.

       header-digest: IscsiHeaderDigest (optional)
              The desired header digest. Defaults to none-crc32c.

       timeout: int (optional)
              Timeout in seconds after which a request will timeout. 0 means no  timeout  and  is
              the default.
       Driver specific block device options for iscsi

   Since
       2.9

   RbdAuthMode (Enum)
   Values
       cephx  Not documented

       none   Not documented

   Since
       3.0

   RbdImageEncryptionFormat (Enum)
   Values
       luks   Not documented

       luks2  Not documented

   Since
       6.1

   RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase (Object)
   Members
       key-secret: string
              ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a passphrase for unlocking the encryption

   Since
       6.1

   RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKSBase (Object)
   Members
       cipher-alg: QCryptoCipherAlgorithm (optional)
              The encryption algorithm

       The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase

   Since
       6.1

   RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS (Object)
   Members
       The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase

   Since
       6.1

   RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS2 (Object)
   Members
       The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase

   Since
       6.1

   RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS (Object)
   Members
       The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKSBase

   Since
       6.1

   RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS2 (Object)
   Members
       The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKSBase

   Since
       6.1

   RbdEncryptionOptions (Object)
   Members
       format: RbdImageEncryptionFormat
              Not documented

       The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS when format is "luks"

       The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS2 when format is "luks2"

   Since
       6.1

   RbdEncryptionCreateOptions (Object)
   Members
       format: RbdImageEncryptionFormat
              Not documented

       The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS when format is "luks"

       The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS2 when format is "luks2"

   Since
       6.1

   BlockdevOptionsRbd (Object)
   Members
       pool: string
              Ceph pool name.

       namespace: string (optional)
              Rados namespace name in the Ceph pool. (Since 5.0)

       image: string
              Image name in the Ceph pool.

       conf: string (optional)
              path  to  Ceph  configuration  file.   Values  in  the  configuration  file will be
              overridden by options specified via QAPI.

       snapshot: string (optional)
              Ceph snapshot name.

       encrypt: RbdEncryptionOptions (optional)
              Image encryption options. (Since 6.1)

       user: string (optional)
              Ceph id name.

       auth-client-required: array of RbdAuthMode (optional)
              Acceptable  authentication  modes.   This  maps  to   Ceph   configuration   option
              "auth_client_required".  (Since 3.0)

       key-secret: string (optional)
              ID  of  a QCryptoSecret object providing a key for cephx authentication.  This maps
              to Ceph configuration option "key".  (Since 3.0)

       server: array of InetSocketAddressBase (optional)
              Monitor host address and port.  This maps to the "mon_host" Ceph option.

   Since
       2.9

   ReplicationMode (Enum)
       An enumeration of replication modes.

   Values
       primary
              Primary mode, the vm's state will be sent to secondary QEMU.

       secondary
              Secondary mode, receive the vm's state from primary QEMU.

   Since
       2.9

   If
       CONFIG_REPLICATION

   BlockdevOptionsReplication (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for replication

   Members
       mode: ReplicationMode
              the replication mode

       top-id: string (optional)
              In secondary mode, node name or device ID of the root node who owns the replication
              node chain. Must not be given in primary mode.

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat

   Since
       2.9

   If
       CONFIG_REPLICATION

   NFSTransport (Enum)
       An enumeration of NFS transport types

   Values
       inet   TCP transport

   Since
       2.9

   NFSServer (Object)
       Captures the address of the socket

   Members
       type: NFSTransport
              transport type used for NFS (only TCP supported)

       host: string
              host address for NFS server

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsNfs (Object)
       Driver specific block device option for NFS

   Members
       server: NFSServer
              host address

       path: string
              path of the image on the host

       user: int (optional)
              UID  value  to  use  when  talking  to the server (defaults to 65534 on Windows and
              getuid() on unix)

       group: int (optional)
              GID value to use when talking to the server  (defaults  to  65534  on  Windows  and
              getgid() in unix)

       tcp-syn-count: int (optional)
              number of SYNs during the session establishment (defaults to libnfs default)

       readahead-size: int (optional)
              set the readahead size in bytes (defaults to libnfs default)

       page-cache-size: int (optional)
              set the pagecache size in bytes (defaults to libnfs default)

       debug: int (optional)
              set the NFS debug level (max 2) (defaults to libnfs default)

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsCurlBase (Object)
       Driver  specific  block  device  options  shared  by  all  protocols supported by the curl
       backend.

   Members
       url: string
              URL of the image file

       readahead: int (optional)
              Size of the read-ahead cache; must be a multiple of 512 (defaults to 256 kB)

       timeout: int (optional)
              Timeout for connections, in seconds (defaults to 5)

       username: string (optional)
              Username for authentication (defaults to none)

       password-secret: string (optional)
              ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a password for authentication  (defaults  to
              no password)

       proxy-username: string (optional)
              Username for proxy authentication (defaults to none)

       proxy-password-secret: string (optional)
              ID  of  a  QCryptoSecret  object  providing  a  password  for  proxy authentication
              (defaults to no password)

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsCurlHttp (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for HTTP connections over  the  curl  backend.   URLs
       must start with "http://".

   Members
       cookie: string (optional)
              List of cookies to set; format is "name1=content1; name2=content2;" as explained by
              CURLOPT_COOKIE(3). Defaults to no cookies.

       cookie-secret: string (optional)
              ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the cookie data in a secure way. See  cookie
              for the format. (since 2.10)

       The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsCurlHttps (Object)
       Driver  specific  block  device options for HTTPS connections over the curl backend.  URLs
       must start with "https://".

   Members
       cookie: string (optional)
              List of cookies to set; format is "name1=content1; name2=content2;" as explained by
              CURLOPT_COOKIE(3). Defaults to no cookies.

       sslverify: boolean (optional)
              Whether to verify the SSL certificate's validity (defaults to true)

       cookie-secret: string (optional)
              ID  of a QCryptoSecret object providing the cookie data in a secure way. See cookie
              for the format. (since 2.10)

       The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsCurlFtp (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for FTP connections over the curl backend.  URLs must
       start with "ftp://".

   Members
       The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsCurlFtps (Object)
       Driver  specific  block  device  options for FTPS connections over the curl backend.  URLs
       must start with "ftps://".

   Members
       sslverify: boolean (optional)
              Whether to verify the SSL certificate's validity (defaults to true)

       The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsNbd (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for NBD.

   Members
       server: SocketAddress
              NBD server address

       export: string (optional)
              export name

       tls-creds: string (optional)
              TLS credentials ID

       x-dirty-bitmap: string (optional)
              A metadata context name such as "qemu:dirty-bitmap:NAME" or "qemu:allocation-depth"
              to   query  in  place  of  the  traditional  "base:allocation"  block  status  (see
              NBD_OPT_LIST_META_CONTEXT  in  the  NBD  protocol;  and  yes,  naming  this  option
              x-context would have made more sense) (since 3.0)

       reconnect-delay: int (optional)
              On an unexpected disconnect, the nbd client tries to connect again until succeeding
              or encountering a serious error.  During the  first  reconnect-delay  seconds,  all
              requests  are  paused and will be rerun on a successful reconnect. After that time,
              any delayed requests and all future requests before  a  successful  reconnect  will
              immediately fail. Default 0 (Since 4.2)

   Features
       unstable
              Member x-dirty-bitmap is experimental.

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsRaw (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for the raw driver.

   Members
       offset: int (optional)
              position where the block device starts

       size: int (optional)
              the assumed size of the device

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevOptionsThrottle (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for the throttle driver

   Members
       throttle-group: string
              the name of the throttle-group object to use. It must already exist.

       file: BlockdevRef
              reference to or definition of the data source block device

   Since
       2.11

   BlockdevOptionsCor (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for the copy-on-read driver.

   Members
       bottom: string (optional)
              The  name  of  a  non-filter  node  (allocation-bearing  layer) that limits the COR
              operations in the backing chain (inclusive), so that no data below this  node  will
              be  copied  by this filter.  If option is absent, the limit is not applied, so that
              data from all backing layers may be copied.

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat

   Since
       6.0

   BlockdevOptionsCbw (Object)
       Driver specific block device options for  the  copy-before-write  driver,  which  does  so
       called  copy-before-write operations: when data is written to the filter, the filter first
       reads corresponding blocks from its file child and copies  them  to  target  child.  After
       successfully copying, the write request is propagated to file child. If copying fails, the
       original write request is failed too and no data is written to file child.

   Members
       target: BlockdevRef
              The target for copy-before-write operations.

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat

   Since
       6.2

   BlockdevOptions (Object)
       Options for creating a block device.  Many options are available for  all  block  devices,
       independent of the block driver:

   Members
       driver: BlockdevDriver
              block driver name

       node-name: string (optional)
              the  node  name  of  the  new node (Since 2.0).  This option is required on the top
              level of blockdev-add.  Valid node names start with an alphabetic character and may
              contain  only alphanumeric characters, '-', '.' and '_'. Their maximum length is 31
              characters.

       discard: BlockdevDiscardOptions (optional)
              discard-related options (default: ignore)

       cache: BlockdevCacheOptions (optional)
              cache-related options

       read-only: boolean (optional)
              whether the block device should be read-only  (default:  false).   Note  that  some
              block  drivers  support  only  read-only  access,  either  generally  or in certain
              configurations. In this case, the default value does not work and the  option  must
              be specified explicitly.

       auto-read-only: boolean (optional)
              if true and read-only is false, QEMU may automatically decide not to open the image
              read-write as requested, but fall back to read-only instead (and switch between the
              modes  later),  e.g.  depending  on whether the image file is writable or whether a
              writing user is attached to the node (default: false, since 3.1)

       detect-zeroes: BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions (optional)
              detect and optimize zero writes (Since 2.1) (default: off)

       force-share: boolean (optional)
              force share all permission on added nodes.  Requires read-only=true. (Since 2.10)

       The members of BlockdevOptionsBlkdebug when driver is "blkdebug"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsBlklogwrites when driver is "blklogwrites"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsBlkverify when driver is "blkverify"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsBlkreplay when driver is "blkreplay"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "bochs"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "cloop"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "compress"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsCbw when driver is "copy-before-write"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsCor when driver is "copy-on-read"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "dmg"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsFile when driver is "file"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlFtp when driver is "ftp"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlFtps when driver is "ftps"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGluster when driver is "gluster"

       The   members    of    BlockdevOptionsFile    when    driver    is    "host_cdrom"    (If:
       HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE)

       The    members    of    BlockdevOptionsFile    when    driver    is   "host_device"   (If:
       HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE)

       The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlHttp when driver is "http"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlHttps when driver is "https"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsIscsi when driver is "iscsi"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsLUKS when driver is "luks"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsNbd when driver is "nbd"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsNfs when driver is "nfs"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsNull when driver is "null-aio"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsNull when driver is "null-co"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsNVMe when driver is "nvme"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "parallels"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsPreallocate when driver is "preallocate"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsQcow2 when driver is "qcow2"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsQcow when driver is "qcow"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat when driver is "qed"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsQuorum when driver is "quorum"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsRaw when driver is "raw"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsRbd when driver is "rbd"

       The  members   of   BlockdevOptionsReplication   when   driver   is   "replication"   (If:
       CONFIG_REPLICATION)

       The members of BlockdevOptionsSsh when driver is "ssh"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsThrottle when driver is "throttle"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "vdi"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "vhdx"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat when driver is "vmdk"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "vpc"

       The members of BlockdevOptionsVVFAT when driver is "vvfat"
       Remaining options are determined by the block driver.

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevRef (Alternate)
       Reference to a block device.

   Members
       definition: BlockdevOptions
              defines a new block device inline

       reference: string
              references the ID of an existing block device

   Since
       2.9

   BlockdevRefOrNull (Alternate)
       Reference to a block device.

   Members
       definition: BlockdevOptions
              defines a new block device inline

       reference: string
              references the ID of an existing block device.  An empty string means that no block
              device should be referenced.  Deprecated; use null instead.

       null: null
              No block device should be referenced (since 2.10)

   Since
       2.9

   blockdev-add (Command)
       Creates a new block device.

   Arguments
       The members of BlockdevOptions

   Since
       2.9

   Example
          1.
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-add",
               "arguments": {
                    "driver": "qcow2",
                    "node-name": "test1",
                    "file": {
                        "driver": "file",
                        "filename": "test.qcow2"
                     }
                }
              }
          <- { "return": {} }

          2.
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-add",
               "arguments": {
                    "driver": "qcow2",
                    "node-name": "node0",
                    "discard": "unmap",
                    "cache": {
                       "direct": true
                     },
                     "file": {
                       "driver": "file",
                       "filename": "/tmp/test.qcow2"
                     },
                     "backing": {
                        "driver": "raw",
                        "file": {
                           "driver": "file",
                           "filename": "/dev/fdset/4"
                         }
                     }
                 }
               }

          <- { "return": {} }

   blockdev-reopen (Command)
       Reopens one or more block devices  using  the  given  set  of  options.   Any  option  not
       specified  will  be  reset  to  its default value regardless of its previous status. If an
       option cannot be changed or a particular  driver  does  not  support  reopening  then  the
       command  will return an error. All devices in the list are reopened in one transaction, so
       if one of them fails then the whole transaction is cancelled.

       The command receives a list of block  devices  to  reopen.  For  each  one  of  them,  the
       top-level  node-name option (from BlockdevOptions) must be specified and is used to select
       the block device to be reopened.  Other node-name options must be either omitted or set to
       the  current name of the appropriate node. This command won't change any node name and any
       attempt to do it will result in an error.

       In the case of options that refer to child nodes, the behavior of this command depends  on
       the value:

          1. A  set of options (BlockdevOptions): the child is reopened with the specified set of
             options.

          2. A reference to the current child: the child is reopened using its  existing  set  of
             options.

          3. A  reference  to  a different node: the current child is replaced with the specified
             one.

          4. NULL: the current child (if any) is detached.

       Options (1) and (2) are supported in all cases. Option  (3)  is  supported  for  file  and
       backing, and option (4) for backing only.

       Unlike  with blockdev-add, the backing option must always be present unless the node being
       reopened does not have a backing file and its image does not have a default  backing  file
       name as part of its metadata.

   Arguments
       options: array of BlockdevOptions
              Not documented

   Since
       6.1

   blockdev-del (Command)
       Deletes  a  block device that has been added using blockdev-add.  The command will fail if
       the node is attached to a device or is otherwise being used.

   Arguments
       node-name: string
              Name of the graph node to delete.

   Since
       2.9

   Example
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-add",
               "arguments": {
                    "driver": "qcow2",
                    "node-name": "node0",
                    "file": {
                        "driver": "file",
                        "filename": "test.qcow2"
                    }
               }
             }
          <- { "return": {} }

          -> { "execute": "blockdev-del",
               "arguments": { "node-name": "node0" }
             }
          <- { "return": {} }

   BlockdevCreateOptionsFile (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for file.

   Members
       filename: string
              Filename for the new image file

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       preallocation: PreallocMode (optional)
              Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, falloc (if
              CONFIG_POSIX_FALLOCATE), full (if CONFIG_POSIX))

       nocow: boolean (optional)
              Turn off copy-on-write (valid only on btrfs; default: off)

       extent-size-hint: int (optional)
              Extent  size  hint  to  add to the image file; 0 for not adding an extent size hint
              (default: 1 MB, since 5.1)

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevCreateOptionsGluster (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for gluster.

   Members
       location: BlockdevOptionsGluster
              Where to store the new image file

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       preallocation: PreallocMode (optional)
              Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, falloc (if
              CONFIG_GLUSTERFS_FALLOCATE), full (if CONFIG_GLUSTERFS_ZEROFILL))

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevCreateOptionsLUKS (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for LUKS.

   Members
       file: BlockdevRef
              Node to create the image format on

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       preallocation: PreallocMode (optional)
              Preallocation  mode  for  the new image (since: 4.2) (default: off; allowed values:
              off, metadata, falloc, full)

       The members of QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevCreateOptionsNfs (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for NFS.

   Members
       location: BlockdevOptionsNfs
              Where to store the new image file

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevCreateOptionsParallels (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for parallels.

   Members
       file: BlockdevRef
              Node to create the image format on

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       cluster-size: int (optional)
              Cluster size in bytes (default: 1 MB)

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for qcow.

   Members
       file: BlockdevRef
              Node to create the image format on

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       backing-file: string (optional)
              File name of the backing file if a backing file should be used

       encrypt: QCryptoBlockCreateOptions (optional)
              Encryption options if the image should be encrypted

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevQcow2Version (Enum)
   Values
       v2     The original QCOW2 format as introduced in qemu 0.10 (version 2)

       v3     The extended QCOW2 format as introduced in qemu 1.1 (version 3)

   Since
       2.12

   Qcow2CompressionType (Enum)
       Compression type used in qcow2 image file

   Values
       zlib   zlib compression, see <http://zlib.net/>

       zstd (If: CONFIG_ZSTD)
              zstd compression, see <http://github.com/facebook/zstd>

   Since
       5.1

   BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow2 (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for qcow2.

   Members
       file: BlockdevRef
              Node to create the image format on

       data-file: BlockdevRef (optional)
              Node to use as an external data file in which all guest data is stored so that only
              metadata remains in the qcow2 file (since: 4.0)

       data-file-raw: boolean (optional)
              True  if  the  external  data  file must stay valid as a standalone (read-only) raw
              image without looking at qcow2 metadata (default: false; since: 4.0)

       extended-l2: boolean (optional)
              True to make the image have extended L2 entries (default: false; since 5.2)

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       version: BlockdevQcow2Version (optional)
              Compatibility level (default: v3)

       backing-file: string (optional)
              File name of the backing file if a backing file should be used

       backing-fmt: BlockdevDriver (optional)
              Name of the block driver to use for the backing file

       encrypt: QCryptoBlockCreateOptions (optional)
              Encryption options if the image should be encrypted

       cluster-size: int (optional)
              qcow2 cluster size in bytes (default: 65536)

       preallocation: PreallocMode (optional)
              Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed  values:  off,  falloc,
              full, metadata)

       lazy-refcounts: boolean (optional)
              True if refcounts may be updated lazily (default: off)

       refcount-bits: int (optional)
              Width of reference counts in bits (default: 16)

       compression-type: Qcow2CompressionType (optional)
              The image cluster compression method (default: zlib, since 5.1)

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevCreateOptionsQed (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for qed.

   Members
       file: BlockdevRef
              Node to create the image format on

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       backing-file: string (optional)
              File name of the backing file if a backing file should be used

       backing-fmt: BlockdevDriver (optional)
              Name of the block driver to use for the backing file

       cluster-size: int (optional)
              Cluster size in bytes (default: 65536)

       table-size: int (optional)
              L1/L2 table size (in clusters)

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevCreateOptionsRbd (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for rbd/Ceph.

   Members
       location: BlockdevOptionsRbd
              Where to store the new image file. This location cannot point to a snapshot.

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       cluster-size: int (optional)
              RBD object size

       encrypt: RbdEncryptionCreateOptions (optional)
              Image encryption options. (Since 6.1)

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevVmdkSubformat (Enum)
       Subformat options for VMDK images

   Values
       monolithicSparse
              Single file image with sparse cluster allocation

       monolithicFlat
              Single flat data image and a descriptor file

       twoGbMaxExtentSparse
              Data  is  split  into  2GB  (per virtual LBA) sparse extent files, in addition to a
              descriptor file

       twoGbMaxExtentFlat
              Data is split into 2GB (per virtual LBA)  flat  extent  files,  in  addition  to  a
              descriptor file

       streamOptimized
              Single file image sparse cluster allocation, optimized for streaming over network.

   Since
       4.0

   BlockdevVmdkAdapterType (Enum)
       Adapter type info for VMDK images

   Values
       ide    Not documented

       buslogic
              Not documented

       lsilogic
              Not documented

       legacyESX
              Not documented

   Since
       4.0

   BlockdevCreateOptionsVmdk (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for VMDK.

   Members
       file: BlockdevRef
              Where   to   store  the  new  image  file.  This  refers  to  the  image  file  for
              monolithcSparse and streamOptimized  format,  or  the  descriptor  file  for  other
              formats.

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       extents: array of BlockdevRef (optional)
              Where  to  store the data extents. Required for monolithcFlat, twoGbMaxExtentSparse
              and twoGbMaxExtentFlat formats. For monolithicFlat, only one entry is required; for
              twoGbMaxExtent*   formats,   the  number  of  entries  required  is  calculated  as
              extent_number = virtual_size / 2GB. Providing more extents than will be used is  an
              error.

       subformat: BlockdevVmdkSubformat (optional)
              The subformat of the VMDK image. Default: "monolithicSparse".

       backing-file: string (optional)
              The path of backing file. Default: no backing file is used.

       adapter-type: BlockdevVmdkAdapterType (optional)
              The adapter type used to fill in the descriptor. Default: ide.

       hwversion: string (optional)
              Hardware version. The meaningful options are "4" or "6".  Default: "4".

       toolsversion: string (optional)
              VMware guest tools version.  Default: "2147483647" (Since 6.2)

       zeroed-grain: boolean (optional)
              Whether to enable zeroed-grain feature for sparse subformats.  Default: false.

   Since
       4.0

   BlockdevCreateOptionsSsh (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for SSH.

   Members
       location: BlockdevOptionsSsh
              Where to store the new image file

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevCreateOptionsVdi (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for VDI.

   Members
       file: BlockdevRef
              Node to create the image format on

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       preallocation: PreallocMode (optional)
              Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, metadata)

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevVhdxSubformat (Enum)
   Values
       dynamic
              Growing image file

       fixed  Preallocated fixed-size image file

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevCreateOptionsVhdx (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for vhdx.

   Members
       file: BlockdevRef
              Node to create the image format on

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       log-size: int (optional)
              Log size in bytes, must be a multiple of 1 MB (default: 1 MB)

       block-size: int (optional)
              Block  size  in  bytes,  must  be  a  multiple  of  1 MB and not larger than 256 MB
              (default: automatically choose a block size depending on the image size)

       subformat: BlockdevVhdxSubformat (optional)
              vhdx subformat (default: dynamic)

       block-state-zero: boolean (optional)
              Force use of payload blocks of type 'ZERO'. Non-standard, but default.  Do not  set
              to 'off' when using 'qemu-img convert' with subformat=dynamic.

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevVpcSubformat (Enum)
   Values
       dynamic
              Growing image file

       fixed  Preallocated fixed-size image file

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevCreateOptionsVpc (Object)
       Driver specific image creation options for vpc (VHD).

   Members
       file: BlockdevRef
              Node to create the image format on

       size: int
              Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       subformat: BlockdevVpcSubformat (optional)
              vhdx subformat (default: dynamic)

       force-size: boolean (optional)
              Force  use  of the exact byte size instead of rounding to the next size that can be
              represented in CHS geometry (default: false)

   Since
       2.12

   BlockdevCreateOptions (Object)
       Options for creating an image format on a given node.

   Members
       driver: BlockdevDriver
              block driver to create the image format

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsFile when driver is "file"

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsGluster when driver is "gluster"

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsLUKS when driver is "luks"

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsNfs when driver is "nfs"

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsParallels when driver is "parallels"

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow when driver is "qcow"

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow2 when driver is "qcow2"

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsQed when driver is "qed"

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsRbd when driver is "rbd"

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsSsh when driver is "ssh"

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVdi when driver is "vdi"

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVhdx when driver is "vhdx"

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVmdk when driver is "vmdk"

       The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVpc when driver is "vpc"

   Since
       2.12

   blockdev-create (Command)
       Starts a job to create an  image  format  on  a  given  node.  The  job  is  automatically
       finalized, but a manual job-dismiss is required.

   Arguments
       job-id: string
              Identifier for the newly created job.

       options: BlockdevCreateOptions
              Options for the image creation.

   Since
       3.0

   BlockdevAmendOptionsLUKS (Object)
       Driver specific image amend options for LUKS.

   Members
       The members of QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS

   Since
       5.1

   BlockdevAmendOptionsQcow2 (Object)
       Driver  specific  image  amend options for qcow2.  For now, only encryption options can be
       amended

       encrypt          Encryption options to be amended

   Members
       encrypt: QCryptoBlockAmendOptions (optional)
              Not documented

   Since
       5.1

   BlockdevAmendOptions (Object)
       Options for amending an image format

   Members
       driver: BlockdevDriver
              Block driver of the node to amend.

       The members of BlockdevAmendOptionsLUKS when driver is "luks"

       The members of BlockdevAmendOptionsQcow2 when driver is "qcow2"

   Since
       5.1

   x-blockdev-amend (Command)
       Starts a job to amend format specific options of an existing open block device The job  is
       automatically finalized, but a manual job-dismiss is required.

   Arguments
       job-id: string
              Identifier for the newly created job.

       node-name: string
              Name of the block node to work on

       options: BlockdevAmendOptions
              Options (driver specific)

       force: boolean (optional)
              Allow  unsafe  operations,  format  specific For luks that allows erase of the last
              active keyslot (permanent loss of data),  and  replacement  of  an  active  keyslot
              (possible loss of data if IO error happens)

   Features
       unstable
              This command is experimental.

   Since
       5.1

   BlockErrorAction (Enum)
       An enumeration of action that has been taken when a DISK I/O occurs

   Values
       ignore error has been ignored

       report error has been reported to the device

       stop   error caused VM to be stopped

   Since
       2.1

   BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED (Event)
       Emitted  when  a  disk  image  is being marked corrupt. The image can be identified by its
       device or node name. The 'device' field is always present for compatibility  reasons,  but
       it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated.

   Arguments
       device: string
              device  name. This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty
              ("") if the image does not have a device name associated.

       node-name: string (optional)
              node name (Since: 2.4)

       msg: string
              informative message for human consumption, such as the  kind  of  corruption  being
              detected. It should not be parsed by machine as it is not guaranteed to be stable

       offset: int (optional)
              if  the  corruption resulted from an image access, this is the host's access offset
              into the image

       size: int (optional)
              if the corruption resulted from an image access, this is the access size

       fatal: boolean
              if set, the image is marked corrupt and therefore unusable  after  this  event  and
              must be repaired (Since 2.2; before, every BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED event was fatal)

   Note
       If action is "stop", a STOP event will eventually follow the BLOCK_IO_ERROR event.

   Example
          <- { "event": "BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED",
               "data": { "device": "ide0-hd0", "node-name": "node0",
                         "msg": "Prevented active L1 table overwrite", "offset": 196608,
                         "size": 65536 },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1378126126, "microseconds": 966463 } }

   Since
       1.7

   BLOCK_IO_ERROR (Event)
       Emitted when a disk I/O error occurs

   Arguments
       device: string
              device  name. This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty
              ("") if the image does not have a device name associated.

       node-name: string (optional)
              node name. Note that errors may be reported for the  root  node  that  is  directly
              attached  to  a guest device rather than for the node where the error occurred. The
              node name is not present if the drive is empty. (Since: 2.8)

       operation: IoOperationType
              I/O operation

       action: BlockErrorAction
              action that has been taken

       nospace: boolean (optional)
              true if I/O error was caused due to a no-space condition. This key is only  present
              if  query-block's  io-status  is  present, please see query-block documentation for
              more information (since: 2.2)

       reason: string
              human readable string describing the error cause.  (This field is a  debugging  aid
              for humans, it should not be parsed by applications) (since: 2.2)

   Note
       If action is "stop", a STOP event will eventually follow the BLOCK_IO_ERROR event

   Since
       0.13

   Example
          <- { "event": "BLOCK_IO_ERROR",
               "data": { "device": "ide0-hd1",
                         "node-name": "#block212",
                         "operation": "write",
                         "action": "stop" },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

   BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED (Event)
       Emitted when a block job has completed

   Arguments
       type: JobType
              job type

       device: string
              The  job  identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since
              QEMU 2.7

       len: int
              maximum progress value

       offset: int
              current progress value. On success this is equal to len.  On failure this  is  less
              than len

       speed: int
              rate limit, bytes per second

       error: string (optional)
              error  message. Only present on failure. This field contains a human-readable error
              message. There are no semantics other than that streaming has  failed  and  clients
              should not try to interpret the error string

   Since
       1.1

   Example
          <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED",
               "data": { "type": "stream", "device": "virtio-disk0",
                         "len": 10737418240, "offset": 10737418240,
                         "speed": 0 },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } }

   BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED (Event)
       Emitted when a block job has been cancelled

   Arguments
       type: JobType
              job type

       device: string
              The  job  identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since
              QEMU 2.7

       len: int
              maximum progress value

       offset: int
              current progress value. On success this is equal to len.  On failure this  is  less
              than len

       speed: int
              rate limit, bytes per second

   Since
       1.1

   Example
          <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED",
               "data": { "type": "stream", "device": "virtio-disk0",
                         "len": 10737418240, "offset": 134217728,
                         "speed": 0 },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } }

   BLOCK_JOB_ERROR (Event)
       Emitted when a block job encounters an error

   Arguments
       device: string
              The  job  identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since
              QEMU 2.7

       operation: IoOperationType
              I/O operation

       action: BlockErrorAction
              action that has been taken

   Since
       1.3

   Example
          <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_ERROR",
               "data": { "device": "ide0-hd1",
                         "operation": "write",
                         "action": "stop" },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

   BLOCK_JOB_READY (Event)
       Emitted when a block job is ready to complete

   Arguments
       type: JobType
              job type

       device: string
              The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are  allowed  since
              QEMU 2.7

       len: int
              maximum progress value

       offset: int
              current  progress  value. On success this is equal to len.  On failure this is less
              than len

       speed: int
              rate limit, bytes per second

   Note
       The "ready to complete" status is always reset by a BLOCK_JOB_ERROR event

   Since
       1.3

   Example
          <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_READY",
               "data": { "device": "drive0", "type": "mirror", "speed": 0,
                         "len": 2097152, "offset": 2097152 }
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

   BLOCK_JOB_PENDING (Event)
       Emitted when a block job is awaiting explicit authorization to finalize graph changes  via
       block-job-finalize.  If  this  job  is  part of a transaction, it will not emit this event
       until the transaction has converged first.

   Arguments
       type: JobType
              job type

       id: string
              The job identifier.

   Since
       2.12

   Example
          <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_WAITING",
               "data": { "device": "drive0", "type": "mirror" },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

   PreallocMode (Enum)
       Preallocation mode of QEMU image file

   Values
       off    no preallocation

       metadata
              preallocate only for metadata

       falloc like full preallocation but allocate disk space by  posix_fallocate()  rather  than
              writing data.

       full   preallocate  all  data  by  writing it to the device to ensure disk space is really
              available. This data may or may not be zero, depending  on  the  image  format  and
              storage.  full preallocation also sets up metadata correctly.

   Since
       2.2

   BLOCK_WRITE_THRESHOLD (Event)
       Emitted when writes on block device reaches or exceeds the configured write threshold. For
       thin-provisioned devices, this means the device should be extended to  avoid  pausing  for
       disk exhaustion.  The event is one shot. Once triggered, it needs to be re-registered with
       another block-set-write-threshold command.

   Arguments
       node-name: string
              graph node name on which the threshold was exceeded.

       amount-exceeded: int
              amount of data which exceeded the threshold, in bytes.

       write-threshold: int
              last configured threshold, in bytes.

   Since
       2.3

   block-set-write-threshold (Command)
       Change the write threshold for a block drive. An event will be delivered  if  a  write  to
       this  block drive crosses the configured threshold.  The threshold is an offset, thus must
       be non-negative. Default is no write threshold. Setting the threshold to zero disables it.

       This is useful to transparently  resize  thin-provisioned  drives  without  the  guest  OS
       noticing.

   Arguments
       node-name: string
              graph node name on which the threshold must be set.

       write-threshold: int
              configured threshold for the block device, bytes.  Use 0 to disable the threshold.

   Since
       2.3

   Example
          -> { "execute": "block-set-write-threshold",
               "arguments": { "node-name": "mydev",
                              "write-threshold": 17179869184 } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   x-blockdev-change (Command)
       Dynamically  reconfigure  the  block  driver  state  graph. It can be used to add, remove,
       insert or replace a graph node. Currently only the Quorum driver implements  this  feature
       to add or remove its child. This is useful to fix a broken quorum child.

       If node is specified, it will be inserted under parent. child may not be specified in this
       case. If both parent and child are specified but node is not, child will be detached  from
       parent.

   Arguments
       parent: string
              the id or name of the parent node.

       child: string (optional)
              the name of a child under the given parent node.

       node: string (optional)
              the name of the node that will be added.

   Features
       unstable
              This  command  is experimental, and its API is not stable.  It does not support all
              kinds of operations, all kinds of children, nor all block drivers.

              FIXME Removing children from a quorum node means  introducing  gaps  in  the  child
              indices.    This    cannot    be    represented   in   the   'children'   list   of
              BlockdevOptionsQuorum, as returned by .bdrv_refresh_filename().

              Warning: The data in a new quorum child MUST be consistent with that of the rest of
              the array.

   Since
       2.7

   Example
          1. Add a new node to a quorum
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-add",
               "arguments": {
                   "driver": "raw",
                   "node-name": "new_node",
                   "file": { "driver": "file",
                             "filename": "test.raw" } } }
          <- { "return": {} }
          -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-change",
               "arguments": { "parent": "disk1",
                              "node": "new_node" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

          2. Delete a quorum's node
          -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-change",
               "arguments": { "parent": "disk1",
                              "child": "children.1" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   x-blockdev-set-iothread (Command)
       Move  node and its children into the iothread.  If iothread is null then move node and its
       children into the main loop.

       The node must not be attached to a BlockBackend.

   Arguments
       node-name: string
              the name of the block driver node

       iothread: StrOrNull
              the name of the IOThread object or null for the main loop

       force: boolean (optional)
              true if the node and its children should be moved when a  BlockBackend  is  already
              attached

   Features
       unstable
              This  command  is  experimental  and intended for test cases that need control over
              IOThreads only.

   Since
       2.12

   Example
          1. Move a node into an IOThread
          -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-set-iothread",
               "arguments": { "node-name": "disk1",
                              "iothread": "iothread0" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

          2. Move a node into the main loop
          -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-set-iothread",
               "arguments": { "node-name": "disk1",
                              "iothread": null } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   QuorumOpType (Enum)
       An enumeration of the quorum operation types

   Values
       read   read operation

       write  write operation

       flush  flush operation

   Since
       2.6

   QUORUM_FAILURE (Event)
       Emitted by the Quorum block driver if it fails to establish a quorum

   Arguments
       reference: string
              device name if defined else node name

       sector-num: int
              number of the first sector of the failed read operation

       sectors-count: int
              failed read operation sector count

   Note
       This event is rate-limited.

   Since
       2.0

   Example
          <- { "event": "QUORUM_FAILURE",
               "data": { "reference": "usr1", "sector-num": 345435, "sectors-count": 5 },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } }

   QUORUM_REPORT_BAD (Event)
       Emitted to report a corruption of a Quorum file

   Arguments
       type: QuorumOpType
              quorum operation type (Since 2.6)

       error: string (optional)
              error message. Only present on failure. This field contains a human-readable  error
              message.  There  are no semantics other than that the block layer reported an error
              and clients should not try to interpret the error string.

       node-name: string
              the graph node name of the block driver state

       sector-num: int
              number of the first sector of the failed read operation

       sectors-count: int
              failed read operation sector count

   Note
       This event is rate-limited.

   Since
       2.0

   Example
          1. Read operation

          { "event": "QUORUM_REPORT_BAD",
               "data": { "node-name": "node0", "sector-num": 345435, "sectors-count": 5,
                         "type": "read" },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } }

          2. Flush operation

          { "event": "QUORUM_REPORT_BAD",
               "data": { "node-name": "node0", "sector-num": 0, "sectors-count": 2097120,
                         "type": "flush", "error": "Broken pipe" },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1456406829, "microseconds": 291763 } }

   BlockdevSnapshotInternal (Object)
   Members
       device: string
              the device name or node-name of a root node to generate the snapshot from

       name: string
              the name of the internal snapshot to be created

   Notes
       In transaction, if name is empty, or any snapshot matching name exists, the operation will
       fail. Only some image formats support it, for example, qcow2, and rbd.

   Since
       1.7

   blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync (Command)
       Synchronously  take  an  internal snapshot of a block device, when the format of the image
       used supports it. If the name is an empty string, or a snapshot with name already  exists,
       the operation will fail.

       For the arguments, see the documentation of BlockdevSnapshotInternal.

   Returns
       • nothing on success

       • If device is not a valid block device, GenericError

       • If any snapshot matching name exists, or name is empty, GenericError

       • If the format of the image used does not support it, BlockFormatFeatureNotSupported

   Since
       1.7

   Example
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync",
               "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0",
                              "name": "snapshot0" }
             }
          <- { "return": {} }

   blockdev-snapshot-delete-internal-sync (Command)
       Synchronously  delete an internal snapshot of a block device, when the format of the image
       used support it. The snapshot is identified by name or id or both. One of the name  or  id
       is required. Return SnapshotInfo for the successfully deleted snapshot.

   Arguments
       device: string
              the device name or node-name of a root node to delete the snapshot from

       id: string (optional)
              optional the snapshot's ID to be deleted

       name: string (optional)
              optional the snapshot's name to be deleted

   Returns
       • SnapshotInfo on success

       • If device is not a valid block device, GenericError

       • If snapshot not found, GenericError

       • If the format of the image used does not support it, BlockFormatFeatureNotSupported

       • If id and name are both not specified, GenericError

   Since
       1.7

   Example
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot-delete-internal-sync",
               "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0",
                              "name": "snapshot0" }
             }
          <- { "return": {
                             "id": "1",
                             "name": "snapshot0",
                             "vm-state-size": 0,
                             "date-sec": 1000012,
                             "date-nsec": 10,
                             "vm-clock-sec": 100,
                             "vm-clock-nsec": 20,
                             "icount": 220414
               }
             }

   Additional block stuff (VM related)
   BiosAtaTranslation (Enum)
       Policy  that BIOS should use to interpret cylinder/head/sector addresses.  Note that Bochs
       BIOS and SeaBIOS will not actually translate logical CHS to physical; instead,  they  will
       use logical block addressing.

   Values
       auto   If  cylinder/heads/sizes  are  passed, choose between none and LBA depending on the
              size of the disk.  If they are not passed, choose none if QEMU can guess  that  the
              disk  had  16  or  fewer heads, large if QEMU can guess that the disk had 131072 or
              fewer tracks across all heads (i.e. cylinders*heads<131072), otherwise LBA.

       none   The physical disk geometry is equal to the logical geometry.

       lba    Assume 63 sectors per track and one of 16, 32, 64, 128 or 255 heads (if fewer  than
              255  are  enough  to cover the whole disk with 1024 cylinders/head).  The number of
              cylinders/head is then computed based on the number of sectors and heads.

       large  The number of cylinders per head is scaled down to 1024 by correspondingly  scaling
              up the number of heads.

       rechs  Same  as  large, but first convert a 16-head geometry to 15-head, by proportionally
              scaling up the number of cylinders/head.

   Since
       2.0

   FloppyDriveType (Enum)
       Type of Floppy drive to be emulated by the Floppy Disk Controller.

   Values
       144    1.44MB 3.5" drive

       288    2.88MB 3.5" drive

       120    1.2MB 5.25" drive

       none   No drive connected

       auto   Automatically determined by inserted media at boot

   Since
       2.6

   PRManagerInfo (Object)
       Information about a persistent reservation manager

   Members
       id: string
              the identifier of the persistent reservation manager

       connected: boolean
              true if the persistent reservation manager is connected to the  underlying  storage
              or helper

   Since
       3.0

   query-pr-managers (Command)
       Returns a list of information about each persistent reservation manager.

   Returns
       a list of PRManagerInfo for each persistent reservation manager

   Since
       3.0

   eject (Command)
       Ejects the medium from a removable drive.

   Arguments
       device: string (optional)
              Block device name

       id: string (optional)
              The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)

       force: boolean (optional)
              If  true,  eject  regardless of whether the drive is locked.  If not specified, the
              default value is false.

   Features
       deprecated
              Member device is deprecated.  Use id instead.

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

   Notes
       Ejecting a device with no media results in success

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "eject", "arguments": { "id": "ide1-0-1" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   blockdev-open-tray (Command)
       Opens a block device's tray. If there is a block driver state tree inserted as  a  medium,
       it  will  become  inaccessible  to  the  guest (but it will remain associated to the block
       device, so closing the tray will make it accessible again).

       If the tray was already open before, this will be a no-op.

       Once the tray opens, a DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED event is emitted. There are  cases  in  which  no
       such event will be generated, these include:

       • if  the  guest has locked the tray, force is false and the guest does not respond to the
         eject request

       • if the BlockBackend denoted by device does not have a guest device attached to it

       • if the guest device does not have an actual tray

   Arguments
       device: string (optional)
              Block device name

       id: string (optional)
              The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)

       force: boolean (optional)
              if false (the default), an eject request will be sent to the guest if it has locked
              the  tray  (and the tray will not be opened immediately); if true, the tray will be
              opened regardless of whether it is locked

   Features
       deprecated
              Member device is deprecated.  Use id instead.

   Since
       2.5

   Example
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-open-tray",
               "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } }

          <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751016,
                              "microseconds": 716996 },
               "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED",
               "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0",
                         "id": "ide0-1-0",
                         "tray-open": true } }

          <- { "return": {} }

   blockdev-close-tray (Command)
       Closes a block device's tray. If there is a block driver state tree  associated  with  the
       block device (which is currently ejected), that tree will be loaded as the medium.

       If the tray was already closed before, this will be a no-op.

   Arguments
       device: string (optional)
              Block device name

       id: string (optional)
              The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)

   Features
       deprecated
              Member device is deprecated.  Use id instead.

   Since
       2.5

   Example
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-close-tray",
               "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } }

          <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751345,
                              "microseconds": 272147 },
               "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED",
               "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0",
                         "id": "ide0-1-0",
                         "tray-open": false } }

          <- { "return": {} }

   blockdev-remove-medium (Command)
       Removes a medium (a block driver state tree) from a block device. That block device's tray
       must currently be open (unless there is no attached guest device).

       If the tray is open and there is no medium inserted, this will be a no-op.

   Arguments
       id: string
              The name or QOM path of the guest device

   Since
       2.12

   Example
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-remove-medium",
               "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } }

          <- { "error": { "class": "GenericError",
                          "desc": "Tray of device 'ide0-1-0' is not open" } }

          -> { "execute": "blockdev-open-tray",
               "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } }

          <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751627,
                              "microseconds": 549958 },
               "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED",
               "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0",
                         "id": "ide0-1-0",
                         "tray-open": true } }

          <- { "return": {} }

          -> { "execute": "blockdev-remove-medium",
               "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } }

          <- { "return": {} }

   blockdev-insert-medium (Command)
       Inserts a medium (a block driver state tree) into a block device. That block device's tray
       must  currently  be  open  (unless there is no attached guest device) and there must be no
       medium inserted already.

   Arguments
       id: string
              The name or QOM path of the guest device

       node-name: string
              name of a node in the block driver state graph

   Since
       2.12

   Example
          -> { "execute": "blockdev-add",
               "arguments": {
                   "node-name": "node0",
                   "driver": "raw",
                   "file": { "driver": "file",
                             "filename": "fedora.iso" } } }
          <- { "return": {} }

          -> { "execute": "blockdev-insert-medium",
               "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0",
                              "node-name": "node0" } }

          <- { "return": {} }

   BlockdevChangeReadOnlyMode (Enum)
       Specifies the new read-only mode of a block device subject to  the  blockdev-change-medium
       command.

   Values
       retain Retains the current read-only mode

       read-only
              Makes the device read-only

       read-write
              Makes the device writable

   Since
       2.3

   blockdev-change-medium (Command)
       Changes the medium inserted into a block device by ejecting the current medium and loading
       a  new  image  file  which  is  inserted  as  the  new  medium  (this   command   combines
       blockdev-open-tray,        blockdev-remove-medium,        blockdev-insert-medium       and
       blockdev-close-tray).

   Arguments
       device: string (optional)
              Block device name

       id: string (optional)
              The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)

       filename: string
              filename of the new image to be loaded

       format: string (optional)
              format to open the new image with (defaults to the probed format)

       read-only-mode: BlockdevChangeReadOnlyMode (optional)
              change the read-only mode of the device; defaults to 'retain'

   Features
       deprecated
              Member device is deprecated.  Use id instead.

   Since
       2.5

   Examples
          1. Change a removable medium

          -> { "execute": "blockdev-change-medium",
               "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0",
                              "filename": "/srv/images/Fedora-12-x86_64-DVD.iso",
                              "format": "raw" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

          2. Load a read-only medium into a writable drive

          -> { "execute": "blockdev-change-medium",
               "arguments": { "id": "floppyA",
                              "filename": "/srv/images/ro.img",
                              "format": "raw",
                              "read-only-mode": "retain" } }

          <- { "error":
               { "class": "GenericError",
                 "desc": "Could not open '/srv/images/ro.img': Permission denied" } }

          -> { "execute": "blockdev-change-medium",
               "arguments": { "id": "floppyA",
                              "filename": "/srv/images/ro.img",
                              "format": "raw",
                              "read-only-mode": "read-only" } }

          <- { "return": {} }

   DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED (Event)
       Emitted whenever the tray of a removable device is  moved  by  the  guest  or  by  HMP/QMP
       commands

   Arguments
       device: string
              Block  device name. This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be
              empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated.

       id: string
              The name or QOM path of the guest device (since 2.8)

       tray-open: boolean
              true if the tray has been opened or false if it has been closed

   Since
       1.1

   Example
          <- { "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED",
               "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0",
                         "id": "/machine/unattached/device[22]",
                         "tray-open": true
               },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

   PR_MANAGER_STATUS_CHANGED (Event)
       Emitted whenever the connected status of a persistent reservation manager changes.

   Arguments
       id: string
              The id of the PR manager object

       connected: boolean
              true if the PR manager is connected to a backend

   Since
       3.0

   Example
          <- { "event": "PR_MANAGER_STATUS_CHANGED",
               "data": { "id": "pr-helper0",
                         "connected": true
               },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1519840375, "microseconds": 450486 } }

   block_set_io_throttle (Command)
       Change I/O throttle limits for a block drive.

       Since QEMU 2.4, each device with I/O limits is member of a throttle group.

       If two or more devices are members of the  same  group,  the  limits  will  apply  to  the
       combined  I/O  of  the  whole  group  in a round-robin fashion. Therefore, setting new I/O
       limits to a device will affect the whole group.

       The name of the group can be specified using the 'group' parameter.  If the  parameter  is
       unset, it is assumed to be the current group of that device. If it's not in any group yet,
       the name of the device will be used as the name for its group.

       The 'group' parameter can also be used to move a device to a different group. In this case
       the limits specified in the parameters will be applied to the new group only.

       I/O  limits  can  be disabled by setting all of them to 0. In this case the device will be
       removed from its group and the rest of its members  will  not  be  affected.  The  'group'
       parameter is ignored.

   Arguments
       The members of BlockIOThrottle

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

   Since
       1.1

   Example
          -> { "execute": "block_set_io_throttle",
               "arguments": { "id": "virtio-blk-pci0/virtio-backend",
                              "bps": 0,
                              "bps_rd": 0,
                              "bps_wr": 0,
                              "iops": 512,
                              "iops_rd": 0,
                              "iops_wr": 0,
                              "bps_max": 0,
                              "bps_rd_max": 0,
                              "bps_wr_max": 0,
                              "iops_max": 0,
                              "iops_rd_max": 0,
                              "iops_wr_max": 0,
                              "bps_max_length": 0,
                              "iops_size": 0 } }
          <- { "return": {} }

          -> { "execute": "block_set_io_throttle",
               "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0",
                              "bps": 1000000,
                              "bps_rd": 0,
                              "bps_wr": 0,
                              "iops": 0,
                              "iops_rd": 0,
                              "iops_wr": 0,
                              "bps_max": 8000000,
                              "bps_rd_max": 0,
                              "bps_wr_max": 0,
                              "iops_max": 0,
                              "iops_rd_max": 0,
                              "iops_wr_max": 0,
                              "bps_max_length": 60,
                              "iops_size": 0 } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   block-latency-histogram-set (Command)
       Manage read, write and flush latency histograms for the device.

       If  only  id parameter is specified, remove all present latency histograms for the device.
       Otherwise, add/reset some of (or all) latency histograms.

   Arguments
       id: string
              The name or QOM path of the guest device.

       boundaries: array of int (optional)
              list of interval boundary  values  (see  description  in  BlockLatencyHistogramInfo
              definition).  If  specified,  all  latency  histograms  are removed, and empty ones
              created for all io types with intervals corresponding to boundaries (except for  io
              types, for which specific boundaries are set through the following parameters).

       boundaries-read: array of int (optional)
              list of interval boundary values for read latency histogram. If specified, old read
              latency histogram is removed, and empty one created with intervals corresponding to
              boundaries-read. The parameter has higher priority then boundaries.

       boundaries-write: array of int (optional)
              list of interval boundary values for write latency histogram.

       boundaries-flush: array of int (optional)
              list of interval boundary values for flush latency histogram.

   Returns
       error if device is not found or any boundary arrays are invalid.

   Since
       4.0

   Example
          set new histograms for all io types with intervals
          [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf):

          -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set",
               "arguments": { "id": "drive0",
                              "boundaries": [10, 50, 100] } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   Example
          set new histogram only for write, other histograms will remain
          not changed (or not created):

          -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set",
               "arguments": { "id": "drive0",
                              "boundaries-write": [10, 50, 100] } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   Example
          set new histograms with the following intervals:
            read, flush: [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf)
            write: [0, 1000), [1000, 5000), [5000, +inf)

          -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set",
               "arguments": { "id": "drive0",
                              "boundaries": [10, 50, 100],
                              "boundaries-write": [1000, 5000] } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   Example
          remove all latency histograms:

          -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set",
               "arguments": { "id": "drive0" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   Block device exports
   NbdServerOptions (Object)
       Keep  this  type  consistent  with  the  nbd-server-start  arguments.  The  only  intended
       difference is using SocketAddress instead of SocketAddressLegacy.

   Members
       addr: SocketAddress
              Address on which to listen.

       tls-creds: string (optional)
              ID of the TLS credentials object (since 2.6).

       tls-authz: string (optional)
              ID  of  the  QAuthZ  authorization  object  used  to  validate  the  client's  x509
              distinguished  name.  This  object  is  is  only resolved at time of use, so can be
              deleted and recreated on the fly while the NBD server is active.   If  missing,  it
              will default to denying access (since 4.0).

       max-connections: int (optional)
              The  maximum  number  of  connections  to  allow at the same time, 0 for unlimited.
              (since 5.2; default: 0)

   Since
       4.2

   nbd-server-start (Command)
       Start an NBD server listening on the given host and  port.   Block  devices  can  then  be
       exported  using  nbd-server-add.   The  NBD server will present them as named exports; for
       example, another QEMU instance could refer to them as "nbd:HOST:PORT:exportname=NAME".

       Keep this type consistent with the NbdServerOptions type. The only intended difference  is
       using SocketAddressLegacy instead of SocketAddress.

   Arguments
       addr: SocketAddressLegacy
              Address on which to listen.

       tls-creds: string (optional)
              ID of the TLS credentials object (since 2.6).

       tls-authz: string (optional)
              ID  of  the  QAuthZ  authorization  object  used  to  validate  the  client's  x509
              distinguished name. This object is is only resolved at  time  of  use,  so  can  be
              deleted  and  recreated  on the fly while the NBD server is active.  If missing, it
              will default to denying access (since 4.0).

       max-connections: int (optional)
              The maximum number of connections to allow at  the  same  time,  0  for  unlimited.
              (since 5.2; default: 0)

   Returns
       error if the server is already running.

   Since
       1.3

   BlockExportOptionsNbdBase (Object)
       An  NBD  block  export (common options shared between nbd-server-add and the NBD branch of
       block-export-add).

   Members
       name: string (optional)
              Export name. If unspecified, the device parameter  is  used  as  the  export  name.
              (Since 2.12)

       description: string (optional)
              Free-form description of the export, up to 4096 bytes.  (Since 5.0)

   Since
       5.0

   BlockExportOptionsNbd (Object)
       An NBD block export (distinct options used in the NBD branch of block-export-add).

   Members
       bitmaps: array of string (optional)
              Also  export  each  of  the  named  dirty bitmaps reachable from device, so the NBD
              client  can  use  NBD_OPT_SET_META_CONTEXT   with   the   metadata   context   name
              "qemu:dirty-bitmap:BITMAP" to inspect each bitmap.

       allocation-depth: boolean (optional)
              Also  export  the  allocation  depth  map  for  device,  so  the NBD client can use
              NBD_OPT_SET_META_CONTEXT with the metadata context name "qemu:allocation-depth"  to
              inspect allocation details. (since 5.2)

       The members of BlockExportOptionsNbdBase

   Since
       5.2

   BlockExportOptionsVhostUserBlk (Object)
       A vhost-user-blk block export.

   Members
       addr: SocketAddress
              The  vhost-user socket on which to listen. Both 'unix' and 'fd' SocketAddress types
              are supported. Passed fds must be UNIX domain sockets.

       logical-block-size: int (optional)
              Logical block size in bytes. Defaults to 512 bytes.

       num-queues: int (optional)
              Number of request virtqueues. Must be greater than 0. Defaults to 1.

   Since
       5.2

   FuseExportAllowOther (Enum)
       Possible allow_other modes for FUSE exports.

   Values
       off    Do not pass allow_other as a mount option.

       on     Pass allow_other as a mount option.

       auto   Try mounting with allow_other first, and if that fails, retry without allow_other.

   Since
       6.1

   BlockExportOptionsFuse (Object)
       Options for exporting a block graph node on some (file) mountpoint as a raw image.

   Members
       mountpoint: string
              Path on which to export the block device via FUSE.  This must point to an  existing
              regular file.

       growable: boolean (optional)
              Whether  writes  beyond  the  EOF should grow the block node accordingly. (default:
              false)

       allow-other: FuseExportAllowOther (optional)
              If this is off, only qemu's user is allowed access to this export.  That cannot  be
              changed  even  with  chmod  or  chown.  Enabling this option will allow other users
              access to the export with the FUSE mount option  "allow_other".   Note  that  using
              allow_other  as  a  non-root  user  requires  user_allow_other to be enabled in the
              global fuse.conf configuration file.  In auto mode (the default), the  FUSE  export
              driver  will first attempt to mount the export with allow_other, and if that fails,
              try again without.  (since 6.1; default: auto)

   Since
       6.0

   If
       CONFIG_FUSE

   NbdServerAddOptions (Object)
       An NBD block export, per legacy nbd-server-add command.

   Members
       device: string
              The device name or node name of the node to be exported

       writable: boolean (optional)
              Whether clients should be able to write  to  the  device  via  the  NBD  connection
              (default false).

       bitmap: string (optional)
              Also  export a single dirty bitmap reachable from device, so the NBD client can use
              NBD_OPT_SET_META_CONTEXT with the metadata context name  "qemu:dirty-bitmap:BITMAP"
              to inspect the bitmap (since 4.0).

       The members of BlockExportOptionsNbdBase

   Since
       5.0

   nbd-server-add (Command)
       Export a block node to QEMU's embedded NBD server.

       The export name will be used as the id for the resulting block export.

   Arguments
       The members of NbdServerAddOptions

   Features
       deprecated
              This command is deprecated. Use block-export-add instead.

   Returns
       error if the server is not running, or export with the same name already exists.

   Since
       1.3

   BlockExportRemoveMode (Enum)
       Mode for removing a block export.

   Values
       safe   Remove export if there are no existing connections, fail otherwise.

       hard   Drop all connections immediately and remove export.
       Potential additional modes to be added in the future:

       hide:  Just hide export from new clients, leave existing connections as is.  Remove export
       after all clients are disconnected.

       soft: Hide export from new clients, answer with ESHUTDOWN for all  further  requests  from
       existing clients.

   Since
       2.12

   nbd-server-remove (Command)
       Remove NBD export by name.

   Arguments
       name: string
              Block export id.

       mode: BlockExportRemoveMode (optional)
              Mode  of  command  operation.  See  BlockExportRemoveMode  description.  Default is
              'safe'.

   Features
       deprecated
              This command is deprecated. Use block-export-del instead.

   Returns
       error if

              • the server is not running

              • export is not found

              • mode is 'safe' and there are existing connections

   Since
       2.12

   nbd-server-stop (Command)
       Stop QEMU's  embedded  NBD  server,  and  unregister  all  devices  previously  added  via
       nbd-server-add.

   Since
       1.3

   BlockExportType (Enum)
       An enumeration of block export types

   Values
       nbd    NBD export

       vhost-user-blk
              vhost-user-blk export (since 5.2)

       fuse (If: CONFIG_FUSE)
              FUSE export (since: 6.0)

   Since
       4.2

   BlockExportOptions (Object)
       Describes  a  block  export,  i.e.  how  single  node  should  be  exported on an external
       interface.

   Members
       id: string
              A unique identifier for the block export (across all export types)

       node-name: string
              The node name of the block node to be exported (since: 5.2)

       writable: boolean (optional)
              True if clients should be able to write to the export (default false)

       writethrough: boolean (optional)
              If true, caches are  flushed  after  every  write  request  to  the  export  before
              completion is signalled. (since: 5.2; default: false)

       iothread: string (optional)
              The  name  of  the iothread object where the export will run. The default is to use
              the thread currently associated with the block node. (since: 5.2)

       fixed-iothread: boolean (optional)
              True prevents the block node from being moved to another thread while the export is
              active.  If  true  and  iothread  is given, export creation fails if the block node
              cannot be moved to the iothread. The default is false. (since: 5.2)

       type: BlockExportType
              Not documented

       The members of BlockExportOptionsNbd when type is "nbd"

       The members of BlockExportOptionsVhostUserBlk when type is "vhost-user-blk"

       The members of BlockExportOptionsFuse when type is "fuse" (If: CONFIG_FUSE)

   Since
       4.2

   block-export-add (Command)
       Creates a new block export.

   Arguments
       The members of BlockExportOptions

   Since
       5.2

   block-export-del (Command)
       Request to remove a block export. This drops the user's reference to the export,  but  the
       export  may  still stay around after this command returns until the shutdown of the export
       has completed.

   Arguments
       id: string
              Block export id.

       mode: BlockExportRemoveMode (optional)
              Mode of command  operation.  See  BlockExportRemoveMode  description.   Default  is
              'safe'.

   Returns
       Error if the export is not found or mode is 'safe' and the export is still in use (e.g. by
       existing client connections)

   Since
       5.2

   BLOCK_EXPORT_DELETED (Event)
       Emitted when a block export is removed and its id can be reused.

   Arguments
       id: string
              Block export id.

   Since
       5.2

   BlockExportInfo (Object)
       Information about a single block export.

   Members
       id: string
              The unique identifier for the block export

       type: BlockExportType
              The block export type

       node-name: string
              The node name of the block node that is exported

       shutting-down: boolean
              True if the export is shutting down (e.g. after  a  block-export-del  command,  but
              before the shutdown has completed)

   Since
       5.2

   query-block-exports (Command)
   Returns
       A list of BlockExportInfo describing all block exports

   Since
       5.2

CHARACTER DEVICES

   ChardevInfo (Object)
       Information about a character device.

   Members
       label: string
              the label of the character device

       filename: string
              the filename of the character device

       frontend-open: boolean
              shows  whether  the  frontend  device  attached  to  this  backend  (eg.  with  the
              chardev=... option) is in open or closed state (since 2.1)

   Notes
       filename is encoded using the QEMU command line character device encoding.  See  the  QEMU
       man page for details.

   Since
       0.14

   query-chardev (Command)
       Returns information about current character devices.

   Returns
       a list of ChardevInfo

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-chardev" }
          <- {
                "return": [
                   {
                      "label": "charchannel0",
                      "filename": "unix:/var/lib/libvirt/qemu/seabios.rhel6.agent,server=on",
                      "frontend-open": false
                   },
                   {
                      "label": "charmonitor",
                      "filename": "unix:/var/lib/libvirt/qemu/seabios.rhel6.monitor,server=on",
                      "frontend-open": true
                   },
                   {
                      "label": "charserial0",
                      "filename": "pty:/dev/pts/2",
                      "frontend-open": true
                   }
                ]
             }

   ChardevBackendInfo (Object)
       Information about a character device backend

   Members
       name: string
              The backend name

   Since
       2.0

   query-chardev-backends (Command)
       Returns information about character device backends.

   Returns
       a list of ChardevBackendInfo

   Since
       2.0

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-chardev-backends" }
          <- {
                "return":[
                   {
                      "name":"udp"
                   },
                   {
                      "name":"tcp"
                   },
                   {
                      "name":"unix"
                   },
                   {
                      "name":"spiceport"
                   }
                ]
             }

   DataFormat (Enum)
       An enumeration of data format.

   Values
       utf8   Data is a UTF-8 string (RFC 3629)

       base64 Data is Base64 encoded binary (RFC 3548)

   Since
       1.4

   ringbuf-write (Command)
       Write to a ring buffer character device.

   Arguments
       device: string
              the ring buffer character device name

       data: string
              data to write

       format: DataFormat (optional)
              data encoding (default 'utf8').

              • base64: data must be base64 encoded text.  Its binary decoding gets written.

              • utf8: data's UTF-8 encoding is written

              • data itself is always Unicode regardless of format, like any other string.

   Returns
       Nothing on success

   Since
       1.4

   Example
          -> { "execute": "ringbuf-write",
               "arguments": { "device": "foo",
                              "data": "abcdefgh",
                              "format": "utf8" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   ringbuf-read (Command)
       Read from a ring buffer character device.

   Arguments
       device: string
              the ring buffer character device name

       size: int
              how many bytes to read at most

       format: DataFormat (optional)
              data encoding (default 'utf8').

              • base64: the data read is returned in base64 encoding.

              • utf8:  the  data read is interpreted as UTF-8.  Bug: can screw up when the buffer
                contains invalid UTF-8 sequences, NUL characters,  after  the  ring  buffer  lost
                data, and when reading stops because the size limit is reached.

              • The return value is always Unicode regardless of format, like any other string.

   Returns
       data read from the device

   Since
       1.4

   Example
          -> { "execute": "ringbuf-read",
               "arguments": { "device": "foo",
                              "size": 1000,
                              "format": "utf8" } }
          <- { "return": "abcdefgh" }

   ChardevCommon (Object)
       Configuration shared across all chardev backends

   Members
       logfile: string (optional)
              The name of a logfile to save output

       logappend: boolean (optional)
              true to append instead of truncate (default to false to truncate)

   Since
       2.6

   ChardevFile (Object)
       Configuration info for file chardevs.

   Members
       in: string (optional)
              The name of the input file

       out: string
              The name of the output file

       append: boolean (optional)
              Open the file in append mode (default false to truncate) (Since 2.6)

       The members of ChardevCommon

   Since
       1.4

   ChardevHostdev (Object)
       Configuration info for device and pipe chardevs.

   Members
       device: string
              The  name  of  the special file for the device, i.e. /dev/ttyS0 on Unix or COM1: on
              Windows

       The members of ChardevCommon

   Since
       1.4

   ChardevSocket (Object)
       Configuration info for (stream) socket chardevs.

   Members
       addr: SocketAddressLegacy
              socket address to listen on (server=true) or connect to (server=false)

       tls-creds: string (optional)
              the ID of the TLS credentials object (since 2.6)

       tls-authz: string (optional)
              the ID  of  the  QAuthZ  authorization  object  against  which  the  client's  x509
              distinguished  name will be validated. This object is only resolved at time of use,
              so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the chardev server is active.   If
              missing, it will default to denying access (since 4.0)

       server: boolean (optional)
              create server socket (default: true)

       wait: boolean (optional)
              wait  for incoming connection on server sockets (default: false).  Silently ignored
              with server: false.  This use is deprecated.

       nodelay: boolean (optional)
              set TCP_NODELAY socket option (default: false)

       telnet: boolean (optional)
              enable telnet protocol on server sockets (default: false)

       tn3270: boolean (optional)
              enable tn3270 protocol on server sockets (default: false) (Since: 2.10)

       websocket: boolean (optional)
              enable websocket protocol on server sockets (default: false) (Since: 3.1)

       reconnect: int (optional)
              For a client socket, if a socket is disconnected, then attempt  a  reconnect  after
              the  given  number  of  seconds.   Setting  this  to  zero  disables this function.
              (default: 0) (Since: 2.2)

       The members of ChardevCommon

   Since
       1.4

   ChardevUdp (Object)
       Configuration info for datagram socket chardevs.

   Members
       remote: SocketAddressLegacy
              remote address

       local: SocketAddressLegacy (optional)
              local address

       The members of ChardevCommon

   Since
       1.5

   ChardevMux (Object)
       Configuration info for mux chardevs.

   Members
       chardev: string
              name of the base chardev.

       The members of ChardevCommon

   Since
       1.5

   ChardevStdio (Object)
       Configuration info for stdio chardevs.

   Members
       signal: boolean (optional)
              Allow signals (such as SIGINT triggered by ^C)  be  delivered  to  qemu.   Default:
              true.

       The members of ChardevCommon

   Since
       1.5

   ChardevSpiceChannel (Object)
       Configuration info for spice vm channel chardevs.

   Members
       type: string
              kind of channel (for example vdagent).

       The members of ChardevCommon

   Since
       1.5

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   ChardevSpicePort (Object)
       Configuration info for spice port chardevs.

   Members
       fqdn: string
              name of the channel (see docs/spice-port-fqdn.txt)

       The members of ChardevCommon

   Since
       1.5

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   ChardevVC (Object)
       Configuration info for virtual console chardevs.

   Members
       width: int (optional)
              console width,  in pixels

       height: int (optional)
              console height, in pixels

       cols: int (optional)
              console width,  in chars

       rows: int (optional)
              console height, in chars

       The members of ChardevCommon

   Since
       1.5

   ChardevRingbuf (Object)
       Configuration info for ring buffer chardevs.

   Members
       size: int (optional)
              ring buffer size, must be power of two, default is 65536

       The members of ChardevCommon

   Since
       1.5

   ChardevQemuVDAgent (Object)
       Configuration info for qemu vdagent implementation.

   Members
       mouse: boolean (optional)
              enable/disable mouse, default is enabled.

       clipboard: boolean (optional)
              enable/disable clipboard, default is disabled.

       The members of ChardevCommon

   Since
       6.1

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL

   ChardevBackendKind (Enum)
   Values
       pipe   Since 1.5

       udp    Since 1.5

       mux    Since 1.5

       msmouse
              Since 1.5

       wctablet
              Since 2.9

       braille
              Since 1.5

       testdev
              Since 2.2

       stdio  Since 1.5

       console
              Since 1.5

       spicevmc (If: CONFIG_SPICE)
              Since 1.5

       spiceport (If: CONFIG_SPICE)
              Since 1.5

       qemu-vdagent (If: CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL)
              Since 6.1

       vc     v1.5

       ringbuf
              Since 1.6

       memory Since 1.5

       file   Not documented

       serial Not documented

       parallel
              Not documented

       socket Not documented

       pty    Not documented

       null   Not documented

   Since
       1.4

   ChardevFileWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ChardevFile
              Not documented

   Since
       1.4

   ChardevHostdevWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ChardevHostdev
              Not documented

   Since
       1.4

   ChardevSocketWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ChardevSocket
              Not documented

   Since
       1.4

   ChardevUdpWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ChardevUdp
              Not documented

   Since
       1.5

   ChardevCommonWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ChardevCommon
              Not documented

   Since
       2.6

   ChardevMuxWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ChardevMux
              Not documented

   Since
       1.5

   ChardevStdioWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ChardevStdio
              Not documented

   Since
       1.5

   ChardevSpiceChannelWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ChardevSpiceChannel
              Not documented

   Since
       1.5

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   ChardevSpicePortWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ChardevSpicePort
              Not documented

   Since
       1.5

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   ChardevQemuVDAgentWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ChardevQemuVDAgent
              Not documented

   Since
       6.1

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL

   ChardevVCWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ChardevVC
              Not documented

   Since
       1.5

   ChardevRingbufWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: ChardevRingbuf
              Not documented

   Since
       1.5

   ChardevBackend (Object)
       Configuration info for the new chardev backend.

   Members
       type: ChardevBackendKind
              Not documented

       The members of ChardevFileWrapper when type is "file"

       The members of ChardevHostdevWrapper when type is "serial"

       The members of ChardevHostdevWrapper when type is "parallel"

       The members of ChardevHostdevWrapper when type is "pipe"

       The members of ChardevSocketWrapper when type is "socket"

       The members of ChardevUdpWrapper when type is "udp"

       The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "pty"

       The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "null"

       The members of ChardevMuxWrapper when type is "mux"

       The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "msmouse"

       The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "wctablet"

       The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "braille"

       The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "testdev"

       The members of ChardevStdioWrapper when type is "stdio"

       The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "console"

       The members of ChardevSpiceChannelWrapper when type is "spicevmc" (If: CONFIG_SPICE)

       The members of ChardevSpicePortWrapper when type is "spiceport" (If: CONFIG_SPICE)

       The    members   of   ChardevQemuVDAgentWrapper   when   type   is   "qemu-vdagent"   (If:
       CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL)

       The members of ChardevVCWrapper when type is "vc"

       The members of ChardevRingbufWrapper when type is "ringbuf"

       The members of ChardevRingbufWrapper when type is "memory"

   Since
       1.4

   ChardevReturn (Object)
       Return info about the chardev backend just created.

   Members
       pty: string (optional)
              name of the slave pseudoterminal device, present if and only if a chardev  of  type
              'pty' was created

   Since
       1.4

   chardev-add (Command)
       Add a character device backend

   Arguments
       id: string
              the chardev's ID, must be unique

       backend: ChardevBackend
              backend type and parameters

   Returns
       ChardevReturn.

   Since
       1.4

   Example
          -> { "execute" : "chardev-add",
               "arguments" : { "id" : "foo",
                               "backend" : { "type" : "null", "data" : {} } } }
          <- { "return": {} }

          -> { "execute" : "chardev-add",
               "arguments" : { "id" : "bar",
                               "backend" : { "type" : "file",
                                             "data" : { "out" : "/tmp/bar.log" } } } }
          <- { "return": {} }

          -> { "execute" : "chardev-add",
               "arguments" : { "id" : "baz",
                               "backend" : { "type" : "pty", "data" : {} } } }
          <- { "return": { "pty" : "/dev/pty/42" } }

   chardev-change (Command)
       Change a character device backend

   Arguments
       id: string
              the chardev's ID, must exist

       backend: ChardevBackend
              new backend type and parameters

   Returns
       ChardevReturn.

   Since
       2.10

   Example
          -> { "execute" : "chardev-change",
               "arguments" : { "id" : "baz",
                               "backend" : { "type" : "pty", "data" : {} } } }
          <- { "return": { "pty" : "/dev/pty/42" } }

          -> {"execute" : "chardev-change",
              "arguments" : {
                  "id" : "charchannel2",
                  "backend" : {
                      "type" : "socket",
                      "data" : {
                          "addr" : {
                              "type" : "unix" ,
                              "data" : {
                                  "path" : "/tmp/charchannel2.socket"
                              }
                           },
                           "server" : true,
                           "wait" : false }}}}
          <- {"return": {}}

   chardev-remove (Command)
       Remove a character device backend

   Arguments
       id: string
              the chardev's ID, must exist and not be in use

   Returns
       Nothing on success

   Since
       1.4

   Example
          -> { "execute": "chardev-remove", "arguments": { "id" : "foo" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   chardev-send-break (Command)
       Send a break to a character device

   Arguments
       id: string
              the chardev's ID, must exist

   Returns
       Nothing on success

   Since
       2.10

   Example
          -> { "execute": "chardev-send-break", "arguments": { "id" : "foo" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   VSERPORT_CHANGE (Event)
       Emitted when the guest opens or closes a virtio-serial port.

   Arguments
       id: string
              device identifier of the virtio-serial port

       open: boolean
              true if the guest has opened the virtio-serial port

   Note
       This event is rate-limited.

   Since
       2.1

   Example
          <- { "event": "VSERPORT_CHANGE",
               "data": { "id": "channel0", "open": true },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1401385907, "microseconds": 422329 } }

DUMP GUEST MEMORY

   DumpGuestMemoryFormat (Enum)
       An enumeration of guest-memory-dump's format.

   Values
       elf    elf format

       kdump-zlib
              kdump-compressed format with zlib-compressed

       kdump-lzo
              kdump-compressed format with lzo-compressed

       kdump-snappy
              kdump-compressed format with snappy-compressed

       win-dmp
              Windows full crashdump format, can be used instead of ELF converting (since 2.13)

   Since
       2.0

   dump-guest-memory (Command)
       Dump  guest's  memory  to  vmcore.  It  is a synchronous operation that can take very long
       depending on the amount of guest memory.

   Arguments
       paging: boolean
              if true, do paging to get guest's memory mapping. This allows using gdb to  process
              the core file.

              IMPORTANT:  this  option  can make QEMU allocate several gigabytes of RAM. This can
              happen for a large guest, or a malicious guest pretending to be large.

              Also, paging=true has the following limitations:

                 1. The guest may be in a catastrophic state or can have corrupted memory,  which
                    cannot be trusted

                 2. The  guest  can  be  in real-mode even if paging is enabled. For example, the
                    guest uses ACPI to sleep, and ACPI sleep state goes in real-mode

                 3. Currently only supported on i386 and x86_64.

       protocol: string
              the filename or file descriptor of the vmcore. The supported protocols are:

              1. file: the protocol starts with "file:", and the following string is  the  file's
                 path.

              2. fd: the protocol starts with "fd:", and the following string is the fd's name.

       detach: boolean (optional)
              if  true,  QMP  will return immediately rather than waiting for the dump to finish.
              The user can track progress using "query-dump". (since 2.6).

       begin: int (optional)
              if specified, the starting physical address.

       length: int (optional)
              if specified, the memory size, in bytes. If you don't  want  to  dump  all  guest's
              memory, please specify the start begin and length

       format: DumpGuestMemoryFormat (optional)
              if  specified, the format of guest memory dump. But non-elf format is conflict with
              paging and filter, ie. paging, begin and length is not allowed to be specified with
              non-elf format at the same time (since 2.0)

   Note
       All boolean arguments default to false

   Returns
       nothing on success

   Since
       1.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "dump-guest-memory",
               "arguments": { "protocol": "fd:dump" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   DumpStatus (Enum)
       Describe the status of a long-running background guest memory dump.

   Values
       none   no dump-guest-memory has started yet.

       active there is one dump running in background.

       completed
              the last dump has finished successfully.

       failed the last dump has failed.

   Since
       2.6

   DumpQueryResult (Object)
       The result format for 'query-dump'.

   Members
       status: DumpStatus
              enum of DumpStatus, which shows current dump status

       completed: int
              bytes written in latest dump (uncompressed)

       total: int
              total bytes to be written in latest dump (uncompressed)

   Since
       2.6

   query-dump (Command)
       Query latest dump status.

   Returns
       A DumpStatus object showing the dump status.

   Since
       2.6

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-dump" }
          <- { "return": { "status": "active", "completed": 1024000,
                           "total": 2048000 } }

   DUMP_COMPLETED (Event)
       Emitted when background dump has completed

   Arguments
       result: DumpQueryResult
              final dump status

       error: string (optional)
              human-readable error string that provides hint on why dump failed. Only presents on
              failure. The user should not try to interpret the error string.

   Since
       2.6

   Example
          { "event": "DUMP_COMPLETED",
            "data": {"result": {"total": 1090650112, "status": "completed",
                                "completed": 1090650112} } }

   DumpGuestMemoryCapability (Object)
       A list of the available formats for dump-guest-memory

   Members
       formats: array of DumpGuestMemoryFormat
              Not documented

   Since
       2.0

   query-dump-guest-memory-capability (Command)
       Returns the available formats for dump-guest-memory

   Returns
       A DumpGuestMemoryCapability object listing available formats for dump-guest-memory

   Since
       2.0

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-dump-guest-memory-capability" }
          <- { "return": { "formats":
                           ["elf", "kdump-zlib", "kdump-lzo", "kdump-snappy"] }

NET DEVICES

   set_link (Command)
       Sets the link status of a virtual network adapter.

   Arguments
       name: string
              the device name of the virtual network adapter

       up: boolean
              true to set the link status to be up

   Returns
       Nothing on success If name is not a valid network device, DeviceNotFound

   Since
       0.14

   Notes
       Not all network adapters support setting link status.  This command will succeed  even  if
       the network adapter does not support link status notification.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "set_link",
               "arguments": { "name": "e1000.0", "up": false } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   netdev_add (Command)
       Add a network backend.

       Additional arguments depend on the type.

   Arguments
       The members of Netdev

   Since
       0.14

   Returns
       Nothing on success If type is not a valid network backend, DeviceNotFound

   Example
          -> { "execute": "netdev_add",
               "arguments": { "type": "user", "id": "netdev1",
                              "dnssearch": "example.org" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   netdev_del (Command)
       Remove a network backend.

   Arguments
       id: string
              the name of the network backend to remove

   Returns
       Nothing on success If id is not a valid network backend, DeviceNotFound

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "netdev_del", "arguments": { "id": "netdev1" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   NetLegacyNicOptions (Object)
       Create a new Network Interface Card.

   Members
       netdev: string (optional)
              id of -netdev to connect to

       macaddr: string (optional)
              MAC address

       model: string (optional)
              device model (e1000, rtl8139, virtio etc.)

       addr: string (optional)
              PCI device address

       vectors: int (optional)
              number of MSI-x vectors, 0 to disable MSI-X

   Since
       1.2

   NetdevUserOptions (Object)
       Use the user mode network stack which requires no administrator privilege to run.

   Members
       hostname: string (optional)
              client hostname reported by the builtin DHCP server

       restrict: boolean (optional)
              isolate the guest from the host

       ipv4: boolean (optional)
              whether to support IPv4, default true for enabled (since 2.6)

       ipv6: boolean (optional)
              whether to support IPv6, default true for enabled (since 2.6)

       ip: string (optional)
              legacy parameter, use net= instead

       net: string (optional)
              IP  network address that the guest will see, in the form addr[/netmask] The netmask
              is optional, and can be either in the form a.b.c.d or as a number of valid top-most
              bits. Default is 10.0.2.0/24.

       host: string (optional)
              guest-visible address of the host

       tftp: string (optional)
              root directory of the built-in TFTP server

       bootfile: string (optional)
              BOOTP filename, for use with tftp=

       dhcpstart: string (optional)
              the first of the 16 IPs the built-in DHCP server can assign

       dns: string (optional)
              guest-visible address of the virtual nameserver

       dnssearch: array of String (optional)
              list of DNS suffixes to search, passed as DHCP option to the guest

       domainname: string (optional)
              guest-visible domain name of the virtual nameserver (since 3.0)

       ipv6-prefix: string (optional)
              IPv6 network prefix (default is fec0::) (since 2.6). The network prefix is given in
              the usual hexadecimal IPv6 address notation.

       ipv6-prefixlen: int (optional)
              IPv6 network prefix length (default is 64) (since 2.6)

       ipv6-host: string (optional)
              guest-visible IPv6 address of the host (since 2.6)

       ipv6-dns: string (optional)
              guest-visible IPv6 address of the virtual nameserver (since 2.6)

       smb: string (optional)
              root directory of the built-in SMB server

       smbserver: string (optional)
              IP address of the built-in SMB server

       hostfwd: array of String (optional)
              redirect incoming TCP or UDP host connections to guest endpoints

       guestfwd: array of String (optional)
              forward guest TCP connections

       tftp-server-name: string (optional)
              RFC2132 "TFTP server name" string (Since 3.1)

   Since
       1.2

   NetdevTapOptions (Object)
       Used to configure a host TAP network interface backend.

   Members
       ifname: string (optional)
              interface name

       fd: string (optional)
              file descriptor of an already opened tap

       fds: string (optional)
              multiple file descriptors of already opened multiqueue capable tap

       script: string (optional)
              script to initialize the interface

       downscript: string (optional)
              script to shut down the interface

       br: string (optional)
              bridge name (since 2.8)

       helper: string (optional)
              command to execute to configure bridge

       sndbuf: int (optional)
              send buffer limit. Understands [TGMKkb] suffixes.

       vnet_hdr: boolean (optional)
              enable the IFF_VNET_HDR flag on the tap interface

       vhost: boolean (optional)
              enable vhost-net network accelerator

       vhostfd: string (optional)
              file descriptor of an already opened vhost net device

       vhostfds: string (optional)
              file descriptors of multiple already opened vhost net devices

       vhostforce: boolean (optional)
              vhost on for non-MSIX virtio guests

       queues: int (optional)
              number of queues to be created for multiqueue capable tap

       poll-us: int (optional)
              maximum number of microseconds that could be spent on busy polling for  tap  (since
              2.7)

   Since
       1.2

   NetdevSocketOptions (Object)
       Socket  netdevs are used to establish a network connection to another QEMU virtual machine
       via a TCP socket.

   Members
       fd: string (optional)
              file descriptor of an already opened socket

       listen: string (optional)
              port number, and optional hostname, to listen on

       connect: string (optional)
              port number, and optional hostname, to connect to

       mcast: string (optional)
              UDP multicast address and port number

       localaddr: string (optional)
              source address and port for multicast and udp packets

       udp: string (optional)
              UDP unicast address and port number

   Since
       1.2

   NetdevL2TPv3Options (Object)
       Configure an Ethernet over L2TPv3 tunnel.

   Members
       src: string
              source address

       dst: string
              destination address

       srcport: string (optional)
              source port - mandatory for udp, optional for ip

       dstport: string (optional)
              destination port - mandatory for udp, optional for ip

       ipv6: boolean (optional)
              force the use of ipv6

       udp: boolean (optional)
              use the udp version of l2tpv3 encapsulation

       cookie64: boolean (optional)
              use 64 bit coookies

       counter: boolean (optional)
              have sequence counter

       pincounter: boolean (optional)
              pin sequence counter to zero - workaround for  buggy  implementations  or  networks
              with packet reorder

       txcookie: int (optional)
              32 or 64 bit transmit cookie

       rxcookie: int (optional)
              32 or 64 bit receive cookie

       txsession: int
              32 bit transmit session

       rxsession: int (optional)
              32 bit receive session - if not specified set to the same value as transmit

       offset: int (optional)
              additional  offset  -  allows the insertion of additional application-specific data
              before the packet payload

   Since
       2.1

   NetdevVdeOptions (Object)
       Connect to a vde switch running on the host.

   Members
       sock: string (optional)
              socket path

       port: int (optional)
              port number

       group: string (optional)
              group owner of socket

       mode: int (optional)
              permissions for socket

   Since
       1.2

   NetdevBridgeOptions (Object)
       Connect a host TAP network interface to a host bridge device.

   Members
       br: string (optional)
              bridge name

       helper: string (optional)
              command to execute to configure bridge

   Since
       1.2

   NetdevHubPortOptions (Object)
       Connect two or more net clients through a software hub.

   Members
       hubid: int
              hub identifier number

       netdev: string (optional)
              used to connect hub to a netdev instead of a device (since 2.12)

   Since
       1.2

   NetdevNetmapOptions (Object)
       Connect a client to a netmap-enabled NIC or to a VALE switch port

   Members
       ifname: string
              Either the name of an existing network interface supported by netmap, or  the  name
              of  a  VALE  port  (created  on  the  fly).   A  VALE  port  name  is  in  the form
              'valeXXX:YYY', where XXX and YYY are non-negative integers. XXX identifies a switch
              and  YYY  identifies  a  port  of  the  switch.  VALE ports having the same XXX are
              therefore connected to the same switch.

       devname: string (optional)
              path of the netmap device (default: '/dev/netmap').

   Since
       2.0

   NetdevVhostUserOptions (Object)
       Vhost-user network backend

   Members
       chardev: string
              name of a unix socket chardev

       vhostforce: boolean (optional)
              vhost on for non-MSIX virtio guests (default: false).

       queues: int (optional)
              number of queues to be created for multiqueue vhost-user (default: 1) (Since 2.5)

   Since
       2.1

   NetdevVhostVDPAOptions (Object)
       Vhost-vdpa network backend

       vDPA device is a device that uses a datapath which complies with the virtio specifications
       with a vendor specific control path.

   Members
       vhostdev: string (optional)
              path of vhost-vdpa device (default:'/dev/vhost-vdpa-0')

       queues: int (optional)
              number of queues to be created for multiqueue vhost-vdpa (default: 1)

   Since
       5.1

   NetClientDriver (Enum)
       Available netdev drivers.

   Values
       none   Not documented

       nic    Not documented

       user   Not documented

       tap    Not documented

       l2tpv3 Not documented

       socket Not documented

       vde    Not documented

       bridge Not documented

       hubport
              Not documented

       netmap Not documented

       vhost-user
              Not documented

       vhost-vdpa
              Not documented

   Since
       2.7

       vhost-vdpa since 5.1

   Netdev (Object)
       Captures the configuration of a network device.

   Members
       id: string
              identifier for monitor commands.

       type: NetClientDriver
              Specify the driver used for interpreting remaining arguments.

       The members of NetLegacyNicOptions when type is "nic"

       The members of NetdevUserOptions when type is "user"

       The members of NetdevTapOptions when type is "tap"

       The members of NetdevL2TPv3Options when type is "l2tpv3"

       The members of NetdevSocketOptions when type is "socket"

       The members of NetdevVdeOptions when type is "vde"

       The members of NetdevBridgeOptions when type is "bridge"

       The members of NetdevHubPortOptions when type is "hubport"

       The members of NetdevNetmapOptions when type is "netmap"

       The members of NetdevVhostUserOptions when type is "vhost-user"

       The members of NetdevVhostVDPAOptions when type is "vhost-vdpa"

   Since
       1.2

       'l2tpv3' - since 2.1

   RxState (Enum)
       Packets receiving state

   Values
       normal filter assigned packets according to the mac-table

       none   don't receive any assigned packet

       all    receive all assigned packets

   Since
       1.6

   RxFilterInfo (Object)
       Rx-filter information for a NIC.

   Members
       name: string
              net client name

       promiscuous: boolean
              whether promiscuous mode is enabled

       multicast: RxState
              multicast receive state

       unicast: RxState
              unicast receive state

       vlan: RxState
              vlan receive state (Since 2.0)

       broadcast-allowed: boolean
              whether to receive broadcast

       multicast-overflow: boolean
              multicast table is overflowed or not

       unicast-overflow: boolean
              unicast table is overflowed or not

       main-mac: string
              the main macaddr string

       vlan-table: array of int
              a list of active vlan id

       unicast-table: array of string
              a list of unicast macaddr string

       multicast-table: array of string
              a list of multicast macaddr string

   Since
       1.6

   query-rx-filter (Command)
       Return rx-filter information for all NICs (or for the given NIC).

   Arguments
       name: string (optional)
              net client name

   Returns
       list  of  RxFilterInfo for all NICs (or for the given NIC).  Returns an error if the given
       name doesn't exist, or given NIC doesn't support rx-filter querying, or given  net  client
       isn't a NIC.

   Since
       1.6

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-rx-filter", "arguments": { "name": "vnet0" } }
          <- { "return": [
                  {
                      "promiscuous": true,
                      "name": "vnet0",
                      "main-mac": "52:54:00:12:34:56",
                      "unicast": "normal",
                      "vlan": "normal",
                      "vlan-table": [
                          4,
                          0
                      ],
                      "unicast-table": [
                      ],
                      "multicast": "normal",
                      "multicast-overflow": false,
                      "unicast-overflow": false,
                      "multicast-table": [
                          "01:00:5e:00:00:01",
                          "33:33:00:00:00:01",
                          "33:33:ff:12:34:56"
                      ],
                      "broadcast-allowed": false
                  }
                ]
             }

   NIC_RX_FILTER_CHANGED (Event)
       Emitted  once until the 'query-rx-filter' command is executed, the first event will always
       be emitted

   Arguments
       name: string (optional)
              net client name

       path: string
              device path

   Since
       1.6

   Example
          <- { "event": "NIC_RX_FILTER_CHANGED",
               "data": { "name": "vnet0",
                         "path": "/machine/peripheral/vnet0/virtio-backend" },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1368697518, "microseconds": 326866 } }
             }

   AnnounceParameters (Object)
       Parameters for self-announce timers

   Members
       initial: int
              Initial delay (in ms) before sending the first GARP/RARP announcement

       max: int
              Maximum delay (in ms) between GARP/RARP announcement packets

       rounds: int
              Number of self-announcement attempts

       step: int
              Delay increase (in ms) after each self-announcement attempt

       interfaces: array of string (optional)
              An optional list of interface names, which restricts the announcement to the listed
              interfaces. (Since 4.1)

       id: string (optional)
              A  name  to  be  used to identify an instance of announce-timers and to allow it to
              modified later.  Not for use as part of the migration parameters. (Since 4.1)

   Since
       4.0

   announce-self (Command)
       Trigger generation of broadcast RARP frames to  update  network  switches.   This  can  be
       useful when network bonds fail-over the active slave.

   Arguments
       The members of AnnounceParameters

   Example
          -> { "execute": "announce-self",
               "arguments": {
                   "initial": 50, "max": 550, "rounds": 10, "step": 50,
                   "interfaces": ["vn2", "vn3"], "id": "bob" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   Since
       4.0

   FAILOVER_NEGOTIATED (Event)
       Emitted  when  VIRTIO_NET_F_STANDBY  was  enabled  during  feature  negotiation.  Failover
       primary devices which were hidden (not hotplugged  when  requested)  before  will  now  be
       hotplugged by the virtio-net standby device.

       device-id: QEMU device id of the unplugged device

   Arguments
       device-id: string
              Not documented

   Since
       4.2

   Example
          <- { "event": "FAILOVER_NEGOTIATED",
               "data": "net1" }

RDMA DEVICE

   RDMA_GID_STATUS_CHANGED (Event)
       Emitted when guest driver adds/deletes GID to/from device

   Arguments
       netdev: string
              RoCE Network Device name

       gid-status: boolean
              Add or delete indication

       subnet-prefix: int
              Subnet Prefix

       interface-id: int
              Not documented
       interface-id : Interface ID

   Since
       4.0

   Example
          <- {"timestamp": {"seconds": 1541579657, "microseconds": 986760},
              "event": "RDMA_GID_STATUS_CHANGED",
              "data":
                  {"netdev": "bridge0",
                  "interface-id": 15880512517475447892,
                  "gid-status": true,
                  "subnet-prefix": 33022}}

ROCKER SWITCH DEVICE

   RockerSwitch (Object)
       Rocker switch information.

   Members
       name: string
              switch name

       id: int
              switch ID

       ports: int
              number of front-panel ports

   Since
       2.4

   query-rocker (Command)
       Return rocker switch information.

   Arguments
       name: string
              Not documented

   Returns
       Rocker information

   Since
       2.4

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-rocker", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } }
          <- { "return": {"name": "sw1", "ports": 2, "id": 1327446905938}}

   RockerPortDuplex (Enum)
       An eumeration of port duplex states.

   Values
       half   half duplex

       full   full duplex

   Since
       2.4

   RockerPortAutoneg (Enum)
       An eumeration of port autoneg states.

   Values
       off    autoneg is off

       on     autoneg is on

   Since
       2.4

   RockerPort (Object)
       Rocker switch port information.

   Members
       name: string
              port name

       enabled: boolean
              port is enabled for I/O

       link-up: boolean
              physical link is UP on port

       speed: int
              port link speed in Mbps

       duplex: RockerPortDuplex
              port link duplex

       autoneg: RockerPortAutoneg
              port link autoneg

   Since
       2.4

   query-rocker-ports (Command)
       Return rocker switch port information.

   Arguments
       name: string
              Not documented

   Returns
       a list of RockerPort information

   Since
       2.4

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-rocker-ports", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } }
          <- { "return": [ {"duplex": "full", "enabled": true, "name": "sw1.1",
                            "autoneg": "off", "link-up": true, "speed": 10000},
                           {"duplex": "full", "enabled": true, "name": "sw1.2",
                            "autoneg": "off", "link-up": true, "speed": 10000}
             ]}

   RockerOfDpaFlowKey (Object)
       Rocker switch OF-DPA flow key

   Members
       priority: int
              key priority, 0 being lowest priority

       tbl-id: int
              flow table ID

       in-pport: int (optional)
              physical input port

       tunnel-id: int (optional)
              tunnel ID

       vlan-id: int (optional)
              VLAN ID

       eth-type: int (optional)
              Ethernet header type

       eth-src: string (optional)
              Ethernet header source MAC address

       eth-dst: string (optional)
              Ethernet header destination MAC address

       ip-proto: int (optional)
              IP Header protocol field

       ip-tos: int (optional)
              IP header TOS field

       ip-dst: string (optional)
              IP header destination address

   Note
       optional  members  may  or may not appear in the flow key depending if they're relevant to
       the flow key.

   Since
       2.4

   RockerOfDpaFlowMask (Object)
       Rocker switch OF-DPA flow mask

   Members
       in-pport: int (optional)
              physical input port

       tunnel-id: int (optional)
              tunnel ID

       vlan-id: int (optional)
              VLAN ID

       eth-src: string (optional)
              Ethernet header source MAC address

       eth-dst: string (optional)
              Ethernet header destination MAC address

       ip-proto: int (optional)
              IP Header protocol field

       ip-tos: int (optional)
              IP header TOS field

   Note
       optional members may or may not appear in the flow mask depending if they're  relevant  to
       the flow mask.

   Since
       2.4

   RockerOfDpaFlowAction (Object)
       Rocker switch OF-DPA flow action

   Members
       goto-tbl: int (optional)
              next table ID

       group-id: int (optional)
              group ID

       tunnel-lport: int (optional)
              tunnel logical port ID

       vlan-id: int (optional)
              VLAN ID

       new-vlan-id: int (optional)
              new VLAN ID

       out-pport: int (optional)
              physical output port

   Note
       optional members may or may not appear in the flow action depending if they're relevant to
       the flow action.

   Since
       2.4

   RockerOfDpaFlow (Object)
       Rocker switch OF-DPA flow

   Members
       cookie: int
              flow unique cookie ID

       hits: int
              count of matches (hits) on flow

       key: RockerOfDpaFlowKey
              flow key

       mask: RockerOfDpaFlowMask
              flow mask

       action: RockerOfDpaFlowAction
              flow action

   Since
       2.4

   query-rocker-of-dpa-flows (Command)
       Return rocker OF-DPA flow information.

   Arguments
       name: string
              switch name

       tbl-id: int (optional)
              flow table ID.  If tbl-id is  not  specified,  returns  flow  information  for  all
              tables.

   Returns
       rocker OF-DPA flow information

   Since
       2.4

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-rocker-of-dpa-flows",
               "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } }
          <- { "return": [ {"key": {"in-pport": 0, "priority": 1, "tbl-id": 0},
                            "hits": 138,
                            "cookie": 0,
                            "action": {"goto-tbl": 10},
                            "mask": {"in-pport": 4294901760}
                           },
                           {...more...},
             ]}

   RockerOfDpaGroup (Object)
       Rocker switch OF-DPA group

   Members
       id: int
              group unique ID

       type: int
              group type

       vlan-id: int (optional)
              VLAN ID

       pport: int (optional)
              physical port number

       index: int (optional)
              group index, unique with group type

       out-pport: int (optional)
              output physical port number

       group-id: int (optional)
              next group ID

       set-vlan-id: int (optional)
              VLAN ID to set

       pop-vlan: int (optional)
              pop VLAN headr from packet

       group-ids: array of int (optional)
              list of next group IDs

       set-eth-src: string (optional)
              set source MAC address in Ethernet header

       set-eth-dst: string (optional)
              set destination MAC address in Ethernet header

       ttl-check: int (optional)
              perform TTL check

   Note
       optional  members  may or may not appear in the group depending if they're relevant to the
       group type.

   Since
       2.4

   query-rocker-of-dpa-groups (Command)
       Return rocker OF-DPA group information.

   Arguments
       name: string
              switch name

       type: int (optional)
              group type.  If type is not specified, returns  group  information  for  all  group
              types.

   Returns
       rocker OF-DPA group information

   Since
       2.4

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-rocker-of-dpa-groups",
               "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } }
          <- { "return": [ {"type": 0, "out-pport": 2,
                            "pport": 2, "vlan-id": 3841,
                            "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251723778},
                           {"type": 0, "out-pport": 0,
                            "pport": 0, "vlan-id": 3841,
                            "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251723776},
                           {"type": 0, "out-pport": 1,
                            "pport": 1, "vlan-id": 3840,
                            "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251658241},
                           {"type": 0, "out-pport": 0,
                            "pport": 0, "vlan-id": 3840,
                            "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251658240}
             ]}

TPM (TRUSTED PLATFORM MODULE) DEVICES

   TpmModel (Enum)
       An enumeration of TPM models

   Values
       tpm-tis
              TPM TIS model

       tpm-crb
              TPM CRB model (since 2.12)

       tpm-spapr
              TPM SPAPR model (since 5.0)

   Since
       1.5

   If
       CONFIG_TPM

   query-tpm-models (Command)
       Return a list of supported TPM models

   Returns
       a list of TpmModel

   Since
       1.5

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-tpm-models" }
          <- { "return": [ "tpm-tis", "tpm-crb", "tpm-spapr" ] }

   If
       CONFIG_TPM

   TpmType (Enum)
       An enumeration of TPM types

   Values
       passthrough
              TPM passthrough type

       emulator
              Software Emulator TPM type Since: 2.11

   Since
       1.5

   If
       CONFIG_TPM

   query-tpm-types (Command)
       Return a list of supported TPM types

   Returns
       a list of TpmType

   Since
       1.5

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-tpm-types" }
          <- { "return": [ "passthrough", "emulator" ] }

   If
       CONFIG_TPM

   TPMPassthroughOptions (Object)
       Information about the TPM passthrough type

   Members
       path: string (optional)
              string describing the path used for accessing the TPM device

       cancel-path: string (optional)
              string  showing  the TPM's sysfs cancel file for cancellation of TPM commands while
              they are executing

   Since
       1.5

   If
       CONFIG_TPM

   TPMEmulatorOptions (Object)
       Information about the TPM emulator type

   Members
       chardev: string
              Name of a unix socket chardev

   Since
       2.11

   If
       CONFIG_TPM

   TPMPassthroughOptionsWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: TPMPassthroughOptions
              Not documented

   Since
       1.5

   If
       CONFIG_TPM

   TPMEmulatorOptionsWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: TPMEmulatorOptions
              Not documented

   Since
       2.11

   If
       CONFIG_TPM

   TpmTypeOptions (Object)
       A union referencing different TPM backend types' configuration options

   Members
       type: TpmType

              • 'passthrough' The configuration options for the TPM passthrough type

              • 'emulator' The configuration options for TPM emulator backend type

       The members of TPMPassthroughOptionsWrapper when type is "passthrough"

       The members of TPMEmulatorOptionsWrapper when type is "emulator"

   Since
       1.5

   If
       CONFIG_TPM

   TPMInfo (Object)
       Information about the TPM

   Members
       id: string
              The Id of the TPM

       model: TpmModel
              The TPM frontend model

       options: TpmTypeOptions
              The TPM (backend) type configuration options

   Since
       1.5

   If
       CONFIG_TPM

   query-tpm (Command)
       Return information about the TPM device

   Returns
       TPMInfo on success

   Since
       1.5

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-tpm" }
          <- { "return":
               [
                 { "model": "tpm-tis",
                   "options":
                     { "type": "passthrough",
                       "data":
                         { "cancel-path": "/sys/class/misc/tpm0/device/cancel",
                           "path": "/dev/tpm0"
                         }
                     },
                   "id": "tpm0"
                 }
               ]
             }

   If
       CONFIG_TPM

REMOTE DESKTOP

   set_password (Command)
       Sets the password of a remote display session.

   Arguments
       protocol: string

              • 'vnc' to modify the VNC server password

              • 'spice' to modify the Spice server password

       password: string
              the new password

       connected: string (optional)
              how to  handle  existing  clients  when  changing  the  password.   If  nothing  is
              specified,  defaults  to 'keep' 'fail' to fail the command if clients are connected
              'disconnect' to disconnect existing clients 'keep' to maintain existing clients

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If Spice is not enabled, DeviceNotFound

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "set_password", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc",
                                                         "password": "secret" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   expire_password (Command)
       Expire the password of a remote display server.

   Arguments
       protocol: string
              the name of the remote display protocol 'vnc' or 'spice'

       time: string
              when to expire the password.

              • 'now' to expire the password immediately

              • 'never' to cancel password expiration

              • '+INT' where INT is the number of seconds from now (integer)

              • 'INT' where INT is the absolute time in seconds

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If protocol is 'spice' and Spice is not active, DeviceNotFound

   Since
       0.14

   Notes
       Time is relative to the server and currently there is no way  to  coordinate  server  time
       with  client  time.   It  is  not recommended to use the absolute time version of the time
       parameter unless you're sure you are on the same machine as the QEMU instance.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "expire_password", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc",
                                                            "time": "+60" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   screendump (Command)
       Write a PPM of the VGA screen to a file.

   Arguments
       filename: string
              the path of a new PPM file to store the image

       device: string (optional)
              ID of the display device that should be dumped. If this parameter is  missing,  the
              primary display will be used. (Since 2.12)

       head: int (optional)
              head  to  use  in  case  the  device  supports multiple heads. If this parameter is
              missing, head #0 will be used. Also note that the head can  only  be  specified  in
              conjunction with the device ID. (Since 2.12)

   Returns
       Nothing on success

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "screendump",
               "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/image" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   Spice
   SpiceBasicInfo (Object)
       The basic information for SPICE network connection

   Members
       host: string
              IP address

       port: string
              port number

       family: NetworkAddressFamily
              address family

   Since
       2.1

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   SpiceServerInfo (Object)
       Information about a SPICE server

   Members
       auth: string (optional)
              authentication method

       The members of SpiceBasicInfo

   Since
       2.1

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   SpiceChannel (Object)
       Information about a SPICE client channel.

   Members
       connection-id: int
              SPICE connection id number.  All channels with the same id belong to the same SPICE
              session.

       channel-type: int
              SPICE channel type number.  "1" is the main control channel, filter for this one if
              you want to track spice sessions only

       channel-id: int
              SPICE channel ID number.  Usually "0", might be different when multiple channels of
              the same type exist, such as multiple display channels in a multihead setup

       tls: boolean
              true if the channel is encrypted, false otherwise.

       The members of SpiceBasicInfo

   Since
       0.14

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   SpiceQueryMouseMode (Enum)
       An enumeration of Spice mouse states.

   Values
       client Mouse cursor position is determined by the client.

       server Mouse cursor position is determined by the server.

       unknown
              No information is available about mouse mode used by the spice server.

   Note
       spice/enums.h has a SpiceMouseMode already, hence the name.

   Since
       1.1

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   SpiceInfo (Object)
       Information about the SPICE session.

   Members
       enabled: boolean
              true if the SPICE server is enabled, false otherwise

       migrated: boolean
              true if the last guest migration completed and spice  migration  had  completed  as
              well. false otherwise. (since 1.4)

       host: string (optional)
              The  hostname the SPICE server is bound to.  This depends on the name resolution on
              the host and may be an IP address.

       port: int (optional)
              The SPICE server's port number.

       compiled-version: string (optional)
              SPICE server version.

       tls-port: int (optional)
              The SPICE server's TLS port number.

       auth: string (optional)
              the current authentication type used by the server

              • 'none'  if no authentication is being used

              • 'spice' uses SASL or direct TLS authentication, depending on command line options

       mouse-mode: SpiceQueryMouseMode
              The mode in which the mouse cursor is displayed currently. Can be determined by the
              client  or the server, or unknown if spice server doesn't provide this information.
              (since: 1.1)

       channels: array of SpiceChannel (optional)
              a list of SpiceChannel for each active spice channel

   Since
       0.14

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   query-spice (Command)
       Returns information about the current SPICE server

   Returns
       SpiceInfo

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-spice" }
          <- { "return": {
                   "enabled": true,
                   "auth": "spice",
                   "port": 5920,
                   "tls-port": 5921,
                   "host": "0.0.0.0",
                   "channels": [
                      {
                         "port": "54924",
                         "family": "ipv4",
                         "channel-type": 1,
                         "connection-id": 1804289383,
                         "host": "127.0.0.1",
                         "channel-id": 0,
                         "tls": true
                      },
                      {
                         "port": "36710",
                         "family": "ipv4",
                         "channel-type": 4,
                         "connection-id": 1804289383,
                         "host": "127.0.0.1",
                         "channel-id": 0,
                         "tls": false
                      },
                      [ ... more channels follow ... ]
                   ]
                }
             }

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   SPICE_CONNECTED (Event)
       Emitted when a SPICE client establishes a connection

   Arguments
       server: SpiceBasicInfo
              server information

       client: SpiceBasicInfo
              client information

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 388707},
               "event": "SPICE_CONNECTED",
               "data": {
                 "server": { "port": "5920", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"},
                 "client": {"port": "52873", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"}
             }}

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   SPICE_INITIALIZED (Event)
       Emitted after initial handshake and authentication takes place  (if  any)  and  the  SPICE
       channel is up and running

   Arguments
       server: SpiceServerInfo
              server information

       client: SpiceChannel
              client information

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 417172},
               "event": "SPICE_INITIALIZED",
               "data": {"server": {"auth": "spice", "port": "5921",
                                   "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"},
                        "client": {"port": "49004", "family": "ipv4", "channel-type": 3,
                                   "connection-id": 1804289383, "host": "127.0.0.1",
                                   "channel-id": 0, "tls": true}
             }}

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   SPICE_DISCONNECTED (Event)
       Emitted when the SPICE connection is closed

   Arguments
       server: SpiceBasicInfo
              server information

       client: SpiceBasicInfo
              client information

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 388707},
               "event": "SPICE_DISCONNECTED",
               "data": {
                 "server": { "port": "5920", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"},
                 "client": {"port": "52873", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"}
             }}

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   SPICE_MIGRATE_COMPLETED (Event)
       Emitted when SPICE migration has completed

   Since
       1.3

   Example
          <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 417172},
               "event": "SPICE_MIGRATE_COMPLETED" }

   If
       CONFIG_SPICE

   VNC
   VncBasicInfo (Object)
       The basic information for vnc network connection

   Members
       host: string
              IP address

       service: string
              The  service  name  of  the  vnc port. This may depend on the host system's service
              database so symbolic names should not be relied on.

       family: NetworkAddressFamily
              address family

       websocket: boolean
              true in case the socket is a websocket (since 2.3).

   Since
       2.1

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

   VncServerInfo (Object)
       The network connection information for server

   Members
       auth: string (optional)
              authentication method used for the plain (non-websocket) VNC server

       The members of VncBasicInfo

   Since
       2.1

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

   VncClientInfo (Object)
       Information about a connected VNC client.

   Members
       x509_dname: string (optional)
              If x509 authentication is in use, the Distinguished Name of the client.

       sasl_username: string (optional)
              If SASL authentication is in use, the SASL username used for authentication.

       The members of VncBasicInfo

   Since
       0.14

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

   VncInfo (Object)
       Information about the VNC session.

   Members
       enabled: boolean
              true if the VNC server is enabled, false otherwise

       host: string (optional)
              The hostname the VNC server is bound to.  This depends on the  name  resolution  on
              the host and may be an IP address.

       family: NetworkAddressFamily (optional)

              • 'ipv6' if the host is listening for IPv6 connections

              • 'ipv4' if the host is listening for IPv4 connections

              • 'unix' if the host is listening on a unix domain socket

              • 'unknown' otherwise

       service: string (optional)
              The  service  name  of  the  server's  port.  This may depends on the host system's
              service database so symbolic names should not be relied on.

       auth: string (optional)
              the current authentication type used by the server

              • 'none' if no authentication is being used

              • 'vnc' if VNC authentication is being used

              • 'vencrypt+plain' if VEncrypt is used with plain text authentication

              • 'vencrypt+tls+none' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and no authentication

              • 'vencrypt+tls+vnc' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and VNC authentication

              • 'vencrypt+tls+plain' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and plain text auth

              • 'vencrypt+x509+none' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and no auth

              • 'vencrypt+x509+vnc' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and VNC auth

              • 'vencrypt+x509+plain' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and plain text auth

              • 'vencrypt+tls+sasl' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and SASL auth

              • 'vencrypt+x509+sasl' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and SASL auth

       clients: array of VncClientInfo (optional)
              a list of VncClientInfo of all currently connected clients

   Since
       0.14

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

   VncPrimaryAuth (Enum)
       vnc primary authentication method.

   Values
       none   Not documented

       vnc    Not documented

       ra2    Not documented

       ra2ne  Not documented

       tight  Not documented

       ultra  Not documented

       tls    Not documented

       vencrypt
              Not documented

       sasl   Not documented

   Since
       2.3

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

   VncVencryptSubAuth (Enum)
       vnc sub authentication method with vencrypt.

   Values
       plain  Not documented

       tls-none
              Not documented

       x509-none
              Not documented

       tls-vnc
              Not documented

       x509-vnc
              Not documented

       tls-plain
              Not documented

       x509-plain
              Not documented

       tls-sasl
              Not documented

       x509-sasl
              Not documented

   Since
       2.3

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

   VncServerInfo2 (Object)
       The network connection information for server

   Members
       auth: VncPrimaryAuth
              The current authentication type used by the servers

       vencrypt: VncVencryptSubAuth (optional)
              The vencrypt sub authentication type used by the servers, only  specified  in  case
              auth == vencrypt.

       The members of VncBasicInfo

   Since
       2.9

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

   VncInfo2 (Object)
       Information about a vnc server

   Members
       id: string
              vnc server name.

       server: array of VncServerInfo2
              A  list  of  VncBasincInfo describing all listening sockets.  The list can be empty
              (in case the vnc server is disabled).  It also may have multiple entries: normal  +
              websocket, possibly also ipv4 + ipv6 in the future.

       clients: array of VncClientInfo
              A list of VncClientInfo of all currently connected clients.  The list can be empty,
              for obvious reasons.

       auth: VncPrimaryAuth
              The current authentication type used by the non-websockets servers

       vencrypt: VncVencryptSubAuth (optional)
              The vencrypt authentication type used by the servers, only specified in  case  auth
              == vencrypt.

       display: string (optional)
              The display device the vnc server is linked to.

   Since
       2.3

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

   query-vnc (Command)
       Returns information about the current VNC server

   Returns
       VncInfo

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-vnc" }
          <- { "return": {
                   "enabled":true,
                   "host":"0.0.0.0",
                   "service":"50402",
                   "auth":"vnc",
                   "family":"ipv4",
                   "clients":[
                      {
                         "host":"127.0.0.1",
                         "service":"50401",
                         "family":"ipv4"
                      }
                   ]
                }
             }

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

   query-vnc-servers (Command)
       Returns a list of vnc servers.  The list can be empty.

   Returns
       a list of VncInfo2

   Since
       2.3

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

   change-vnc-password (Command)
       Change the VNC server password.

   Arguments
       password: string
              the new password to use with VNC authentication

   Since
       1.1

   Notes
       An  empty  password  in  this command will set the password to the empty string.  Existing
       clients are unaffected by executing this command.

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

   VNC_CONNECTED (Event)
       Emitted when a VNC client establishes a connection

   Arguments
       server: VncServerInfo
              server information

       client: VncBasicInfo
              client information

   Note
       This event is emitted before any authentication takes place, thus the authentication ID is
       not provided

   Since
       0.13

   Example
          <- { "event": "VNC_CONNECTED",
               "data": {
                     "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4",
                                 "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0" },
                     "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "58425",
                                 "host": "127.0.0.1" } },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1262976601, "microseconds": 975795 } }

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

   VNC_INITIALIZED (Event)
       Emitted after authentication takes place (if any) and the VNC session is made active

   Arguments
       server: VncServerInfo
              server information

       client: VncClientInfo
              client information

   Since
       0.13

   Example
          <-  { "event": "VNC_INITIALIZED",
                "data": {
                     "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4",
                                 "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0"},
                     "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "46089",
                                 "host": "127.0.0.1", "sasl_username": "luiz" } },
                "timestamp": { "seconds": 1263475302, "microseconds": 150772 } }

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

   VNC_DISCONNECTED (Event)
       Emitted when the connection is closed

   Arguments
       server: VncServerInfo
              server information

       client: VncClientInfo
              client information

   Since
       0.13

   Example
          <- { "event": "VNC_DISCONNECTED",
               "data": {
                     "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4",
                                 "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0" },
                     "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "58425",
                                 "host": "127.0.0.1", "sasl_username": "luiz" } },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1262976601, "microseconds": 975795 } }

   If
       CONFIG_VNC

INPUT

   MouseInfo (Object)
       Information about a mouse device.

   Members
       name: string
              the name of the mouse device

       index: int
              the index of the mouse device

       current: boolean
              true if this device is currently receiving mouse events

       absolute: boolean
              true if this device supports absolute coordinates as input

   Since
       0.14

   query-mice (Command)
       Returns information about each active mouse device

   Returns
       a list of MouseInfo for each device

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-mice" }
          <- { "return": [
                   {
                      "name":"QEMU Microsoft Mouse",
                      "index":0,
                      "current":false,
                      "absolute":false
                   },
                   {
                      "name":"QEMU PS/2 Mouse",
                      "index":1,
                      "current":true,
                      "absolute":true
                   }
                ]
             }

   QKeyCode (Enum)
       An enumeration of key name.

       This is used by the send-key command.

   Values
       unmapped
              since 2.0

       pause  since 2.0

       ro     since 2.4

       kp_comma
              since 2.4

       kp_equals
              since 2.6

       power  since 2.6

       hiragana
              since 2.9

       henkan since 2.9

       yen    since 2.9

       sleep  since 2.10

       wake   since 2.10

       audionext
              since 2.10

       audioprev
              since 2.10

       audiostop
              since 2.10

       audioplay
              since 2.10

       audiomute
              since 2.10

       volumeup
              since 2.10

       volumedown
              since 2.10

       mediaselect
              since 2.10

       mail   since 2.10

       calculator
              since 2.10

       computer
              since 2.10

       ac_home
              since 2.10

       ac_back
              since 2.10

       ac_forward
              since 2.10

       ac_refresh
              since 2.10

       ac_bookmarks
              since 2.10

       muhenkan
              since 2.12

       katakanahiragana
              since 2.12

       lang1  since 6.1

       lang2  since 6.1

       shift  Not documented

       shift_r
              Not documented

       alt    Not documented

       alt_r  Not documented

       ctrl   Not documented

       ctrl_r Not documented

       menu   Not documented

       esc    Not documented

       1      Not documented

       2      Not documented

       3      Not documented

       4      Not documented

       5      Not documented

       6      Not documented

       7      Not documented

       8      Not documented

       9      Not documented

       0      Not documented

       minus  Not documented

       equal  Not documented

       backspace
              Not documented

       tab    Not documented

       q      Not documented

       w      Not documented

       e      Not documented

       r      Not documented

       t      Not documented

       y      Not documented

       u      Not documented

       i      Not documented

       o      Not documented

       p      Not documented

       bracket_left
              Not documented

       bracket_right
              Not documented

       ret    Not documented

       a      Not documented

       s      Not documented

       d      Not documented

       f      Not documented

       g      Not documented

       h      Not documented

       j      Not documented

       k      Not documented

       l      Not documented

       semicolon
              Not documented

       apostrophe
              Not documented

       grave_accent
              Not documented

       backslash
              Not documented

       z      Not documented

       x      Not documented

       c      Not documented

       v      Not documented

       b      Not documented

       n      Not documented

       m      Not documented

       comma  Not documented

       dot    Not documented

       slash  Not documented

       asterisk
              Not documented

       spc    Not documented

       caps_lock
              Not documented

       f1     Not documented

       f2     Not documented

       f3     Not documented

       f4     Not documented

       f5     Not documented

       f6     Not documented

       f7     Not documented

       f8     Not documented

       f9     Not documented

       f10    Not documented

       num_lock
              Not documented

       scroll_lock
              Not documented

       kp_divide
              Not documented

       kp_multiply
              Not documented

       kp_subtract
              Not documented

       kp_add Not documented

       kp_enter
              Not documented

       kp_decimal
              Not documented

       sysrq  Not documented

       kp_0   Not documented

       kp_1   Not documented

       kp_2   Not documented

       kp_3   Not documented

       kp_4   Not documented

       kp_5   Not documented

       kp_6   Not documented

       kp_7   Not documented

       kp_8   Not documented

       kp_9   Not documented

       less   Not documented

       f11    Not documented

       f12    Not documented

       print  Not documented

       home   Not documented

       pgup   Not documented

       pgdn   Not documented

       end    Not documented

       left   Not documented

       up     Not documented

       down   Not documented

       right  Not documented

       insert Not documented

       delete Not documented

       stop   Not documented

       again  Not documented

       props  Not documented

       undo   Not documented

       front  Not documented

       copy   Not documented

       open   Not documented

       paste  Not documented

       find   Not documented

       cut    Not documented

       lf     Not documented

       help   Not documented

       meta_l Not documented

       meta_r Not documented

       compose
              Not documented
       'sysrq'  was  mistakenly  added  to  hack  around  the  fact  that  the ps2 driver was not
       generating correct scancodes sequences when 'alt+print' was  pressed.  This  flaw  is  now
       fixed  and  the  'sysrq' key serves no further purpose. Any further use of 'sysrq' will be
       transparently changed to 'print', so they are effectively synonyms.

   Since
       1.3

   KeyValueKind (Enum)
   Values
       number Not documented

       qcode  Not documented

   Since
       1.3

   IntWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: int
              Not documented

   Since
       1.3

   QKeyCodeWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: QKeyCode
              Not documented

   Since
       1.3

   KeyValue (Object)
       Represents a keyboard key.

   Members
       type: KeyValueKind
              Not documented

       The members of IntWrapper when type is "number"

       The members of QKeyCodeWrapper when type is "qcode"

   Since
       1.3

   send-key (Command)
       Send keys to guest.

   Arguments
       keys: array of KeyValue
              An array of KeyValue elements. All KeyValues in this array are simultaneously  sent
              to  the  guest.  A  KeyValue.number  value  is  sent  directly  to the guest, while
              KeyValue.qcode must be a valid QKeyCode value

       hold-time: int (optional)
              time to delay key up events, milliseconds. Defaults to 100

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If key is unknown or redundant, InvalidParameter

   Since
       1.3

   Example
          -> { "execute": "send-key",
               "arguments": { "keys": [ { "type": "qcode", "data": "ctrl" },
                                        { "type": "qcode", "data": "alt" },
                                        { "type": "qcode", "data": "delete" } ] } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   InputButton (Enum)
       Button of a pointer input device (mouse, tablet).

   Values
       side   front side button of a 5-button mouse (since 2.9)

       extra  rear side button of a 5-button mouse (since 2.9)

       left   Not documented

       middle Not documented

       right  Not documented

       wheel-up
              Not documented

       wheel-down
              Not documented

   Since
       2.0

   InputAxis (Enum)
       Position axis of a pointer input device (mouse, tablet).

   Values
       x      Not documented

       y      Not documented

   Since
       2.0

   InputKeyEvent (Object)
       Keyboard input event.

   Members
       key: KeyValue
              Which key this event is for.

       down: boolean
              True for key-down and false for key-up events.

   Since
       2.0

   InputBtnEvent (Object)
       Pointer button input event.

   Members
       button: InputButton
              Which button this event is for.

       down: boolean
              True for key-down and false for key-up events.

   Since
       2.0

   InputMoveEvent (Object)
       Pointer motion input event.

   Members
       axis: InputAxis
              Which axis is referenced by value.

       value: int
              Pointer position.  For absolute coordinates the valid range is 0 -> 0x7ffff

   Since
       2.0

   InputEventKind (Enum)
   Values
       key    Not documented

       btn    Not documented

       rel    Not documented

       abs    Not documented

   Since
       2.0

   InputKeyEventWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: InputKeyEvent
              Not documented

   Since
       2.0

   InputBtnEventWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: InputBtnEvent
              Not documented

   Since
       2.0

   InputMoveEventWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: InputMoveEvent
              Not documented

   Since
       2.0

   InputEvent (Object)
       Input event union.

   Members
       type: InputEventKind
              the input type, one of:

              • 'key': Input event of Keyboard

              • 'btn': Input event of pointer buttons

              • 'rel': Input event of relative pointer motion

              • 'abs': Input event of absolute pointer motion

       The members of InputKeyEventWrapper when type is "key"

       The members of InputBtnEventWrapper when type is "btn"

       The members of InputMoveEventWrapper when type is "rel"

       The members of InputMoveEventWrapper when type is "abs"

   Since
       2.0

   input-send-event (Command)
       Send input event(s) to guest.

       The device and head parameters can be used to send  the  input  event  to  specific  input
       devices  in  case  (a)  multiple  input  devices of the same kind are added to the virtual
       machine and (b) you have configured input routing (see docs/multiseat.txt) for those input
       devices.   The  parameters  work  exactly  like  the  device  and head properties of input
       devices.  If device is missing, only  devices  that  have  no  input  routing  config  are
       admissible.   If  device  is  specified, both input devices with and without input routing
       config are admissible, but devices with input routing config take precedence.

   Arguments
       device: string (optional)
              display device to send event(s) to.

       head: int (optional)
              head to send event(s) to, in case the display device supports multiple scanouts.

       events: array of InputEvent
              List of InputEvent union.

   Returns
       Nothing on success.

   Since
       2.6

   Note
       The consoles are visible in the qom tree,  under  /backend/console[$index].  They  have  a
       device  link  and  head  property, so it is possible to map which console belongs to which
       device and display.

   Example
          1. Press left mouse button.

          -> { "execute": "input-send-event",
              "arguments": { "device": "video0",
                             "events": [ { "type": "btn",
                             "data" : { "down": true, "button": "left" } } ] } }
          <- { "return": {} }

          -> { "execute": "input-send-event",
              "arguments": { "device": "video0",
                             "events": [ { "type": "btn",
                             "data" : { "down": false, "button": "left" } } ] } }
          <- { "return": {} }

          2. Press ctrl-alt-del.

          -> { "execute": "input-send-event",
               "arguments": { "events": [
                  { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true,
                    "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "ctrl" } } },
                  { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true,
                    "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "alt" } } },
                  { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true,
                    "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "delete" } } } ] } }
          <- { "return": {} }

          3. Move mouse pointer to absolute coordinates (20000, 400).

          -> { "execute": "input-send-event" ,
            "arguments": { "events": [
                         { "type": "abs", "data" : { "axis": "x", "value" : 20000 } },
                         { "type": "abs", "data" : { "axis": "y", "value" : 400 } } ] } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   DisplayGTK (Object)
       GTK display options.

   Members
       grab-on-hover: boolean (optional)
              Grab keyboard input on mouse hover.

       zoom-to-fit: boolean (optional)
              Zoom guest display to fit into the host window.  When turned off  the  host  window
              will be resized instead.  In case the display device can notify the guest on window
              resizes (virtio-gpu) this will default to "on", assuming the guest will resize  the
              display to match the window size then.  Otherwise it defaults to "off".  Since 3.1

   Since
       2.12

   DisplayEGLHeadless (Object)
       EGL headless display options.

   Members
       rendernode: string (optional)
              Which  DRM  render  node should be used. Default is the first available node on the
              host.

   Since
       3.1

   DisplayGLMode (Enum)
       Display OpenGL mode.

   Values
       off    Disable OpenGL (default).

       on     Use OpenGL, pick context type automatically.  Would better be named 'auto'  but  is
              called 'on' for backward compatibility with bool type.

       core   Use OpenGL with Core (desktop) Context.

       es     Use OpenGL with ES (embedded systems) Context.

   Since
       3.0

   DisplayCurses (Object)
       Curses display options.

   Members
       charset: string (optional)
              Font charset used by guest (default: CP437).

   Since
       4.0

   DisplayType (Enum)
       Display (user interface) type.

   Values
       default
              The  default user interface, selecting from the first available of gtk, sdl, cocoa,
              and vnc.

       none   No user interface or video output display. The guest will  still  see  an  emulated
              graphics card, but its output will not be displayed to the QEMU user.

       gtk (If: CONFIG_GTK)
              The GTK user interface.

       sdl (If: CONFIG_SDL)
              The SDL user interface.

       egl-headless (If: CONFIG_OPENGL and CONFIG_GBM)
              No  user  interface, offload GL operations to a local DRI device. Graphical display
              need to be paired with VNC or Spice. (Since 3.1)

       curses (If: CONFIG_CURSES)
              Display video output via curses.  For graphics device models which support  a  text
              mode,  QEMU  can  display  this output using a curses/ncurses interface. Nothing is
              displayed when the graphics device is in graphical mode or if the  graphics  device
              does  not  support  a  text mode. Generally only the VGA device models support text
              mode.

       cocoa (If: CONFIG_COCOA)
              The Cocoa user interface.

       spice-app (If: CONFIG_SPICE)
              Set up a Spice server and run the default associated application to connect to  it.
              The server will redirect the serial console and QEMU monitors. (Since 4.0)

   Since
       2.12

   DisplayOptions (Object)
       Display (user interface) options.

   Members
       type: DisplayType
              Which DisplayType qemu should use.

       full-screen: boolean (optional)
              Start user interface in fullscreen mode (default: off).

       window-close: boolean (optional)
              Allow to quit qemu with window close button (default: on).

       show-cursor: boolean (optional)
              Force showing the mouse cursor (default: off).  (since: 5.0)

       gl: DisplayGLMode (optional)
              Enable OpenGL support (default: off).

       The members of DisplayGTK when type is "gtk" (If: CONFIG_GTK)

       The members of DisplayCurses when type is "curses" (If: CONFIG_CURSES)

       The  members  of  DisplayEGLHeadless  when  type  is "egl-headless" (If: CONFIG_OPENGL and
       CONFIG_GBM)

   Since
       2.12

   query-display-options (Command)
       Returns information about display configuration

   Returns
       DisplayOptions

   Since
       3.1

   DisplayReloadType (Enum)
       Available DisplayReload types.

   Values
       vnc    VNC display

   Since
       6.0

   DisplayReloadOptionsVNC (Object)
       Specify the VNC reload options.

   Members
       tls-certs: boolean (optional)
              reload tls certs or not.

   Since
       6.0

   DisplayReloadOptions (Object)
       Options of the display configuration reload.

   Members
       type: DisplayReloadType
              Specify the display type.

       The members of DisplayReloadOptionsVNC when type is "vnc"

   Since
       6.0

   display-reload (Command)
       Reload display configuration.

   Arguments
       The members of DisplayReloadOptions

   Returns
       Nothing on success.

   Since
       6.0

   Example
          -> { "execute": "display-reload",
               "arguments": { "type": "vnc", "tls-certs": true  } }
          <- { "return": {} }

USER AUTHORIZATION

   QAuthZListPolicy (Enum)
       The authorization policy result

   Values
       deny   deny access

       allow  allow access

   Since
       4.0

   QAuthZListFormat (Enum)
       The authorization policy match format

   Values
       exact  an exact string match

       glob   string with ? and * shell wildcard support

   Since
       4.0

   QAuthZListRule (Object)
       A single authorization rule.

   Members
       match: string
              a string or glob to match against a user identity

       policy: QAuthZListPolicy
              the result to return if match evaluates to true

       format: QAuthZListFormat (optional)
              the format of the match rule (default 'exact')

   Since
       4.0

   AuthZListProperties (Object)
       Properties for authz-list objects.

   Members
       policy: QAuthZListPolicy (optional)
              Default policy to apply when no rule matches (default: deny)

       rules: array of QAuthZListRule (optional)
              Authorization rules based on matching user

   Since
       4.0

   AuthZListFileProperties (Object)
       Properties for authz-listfile objects.

   Members
       filename: string
              File name to load the configuration from. The file  must  contain  valid  JSON  for
              AuthZListProperties.

       refresh: boolean (optional)
              If  true,  inotify is used to monitor the file, automatically reloading changes. If
              an error occurs during reloading, all authorizations will fail until  the  file  is
              next   successfully   loaded.   (default:   true  if  the  binary  was  built  with
              CONFIG_INOTIFY1, false otherwise)

   Since
       4.0

   AuthZPAMProperties (Object)
       Properties for authz-pam objects.

   Members
       service: string
              PAM service name to use for authorization

   Since
       4.0

   AuthZSimpleProperties (Object)
       Properties for authz-simple objects.

   Members
       identity: string
              Identifies the allowed user.  Its  format  depends  on  the  network  service  that
              authorization  object  is  associated  with.  For  authorizing  based  on  TLS x509
              certificates, the identity must be the x509 distinguished name.

   Since
       4.0

MIGRATION

   MigrationStats (Object)
       Detailed migration status.

   Members
       transferred: int
              amount of bytes already transferred to the target VM

       remaining: int
              amount of bytes remaining to be transferred to the target VM

       total: int
              total amount of bytes involved in the migration process

       duplicate: int
              number of duplicate (zero) pages (since 1.2)

       skipped: int
              number of skipped zero pages (since 1.5)

       normal: int
              number of normal pages (since 1.2)

       normal-bytes: int
              number of normal bytes sent (since 1.2)

       dirty-pages-rate: int
              number of pages dirtied by second by the guest (since 1.3)

       mbps: number
              throughput in megabits/sec. (since 1.6)

       dirty-sync-count: int
              number of times that dirty ram was synchronized (since 2.1)

       postcopy-requests: int
              The number of page requests received from the destination (since 2.7)

       page-size: int
              The number of bytes per page for the various page-based statistics (since 2.10)

       multifd-bytes: int
              The number of bytes sent through multifd (since 3.0)

       pages-per-second: int
              the number of memory pages transferred per second (Since 4.0)

   Since
       0.14

   XBZRLECacheStats (Object)
       Detailed XBZRLE migration cache statistics

   Members
       cache-size: int
              XBZRLE cache size

       bytes: int
              amount of bytes already transferred to the target VM

       pages: int
              amount of pages transferred to the target VM

       cache-miss: int
              number of cache miss

       cache-miss-rate: number
              rate of cache miss (since 2.1)

       encoding-rate: number
              rate of encoded bytes (since 5.1)

       overflow: int
              number of overflows

   Since
       1.2

   CompressionStats (Object)
       Detailed migration compression statistics

   Members
       pages: int
              amount of pages compressed and transferred to the target VM

       busy: int
              count of times that no free thread was available to compress data

       busy-rate: number
              rate of thread busy

       compressed-size: int
              amount of bytes after compression

       compression-rate: number
              rate of compressed size

   Since
       3.1

   MigrationStatus (Enum)
       An enumeration of migration status.

   Values
       none   no migration has ever happened.

       setup  migration process has been initiated.

       cancelling
              in the process of cancelling migration.

       cancelled
              cancelling migration is finished.

       active in the process of doing migration.

       postcopy-active
              like active, but now in postcopy mode. (since 2.5)

       postcopy-paused
              during postcopy but paused. (since 3.0)

       postcopy-recover
              trying to recover from a paused postcopy. (since 3.0)

       completed
              migration is finished.

       failed some error occurred during migration process.

       colo   VM is in the process of fault tolerance, VM can not get into this state unless colo
              capability is enabled for migration. (since 2.8)

       pre-switchover
              Paused before device serialisation. (since 2.11)

       device During device serialisation when pause-before-switchover is enabled (since 2.11)

       wait-unplug
              wait for device unplug request by guest OS to be completed.  (since 4.2)

   Since
       2.3

   VfioStats (Object)
       Detailed VFIO devices migration statistics

   Members
       transferred: int
              amount of bytes transferred to the target VM by VFIO devices

   Since
       5.2

   MigrationInfo (Object)
       Information about current migration process.

   Members
       status: MigrationStatus (optional)
              MigrationStatus  describing  the  current  migration  status.  If this field is not
              returned, no migration process has been initiated

       ram: MigrationStats (optional)
              MigrationStats containing detailed migration status, only  returned  if  status  is
              'active' or 'completed'(since 1.2)

       disk: MigrationStats (optional)
              MigrationStats  containing  detailed disk migration status, only returned if status
              is 'active' and it is a block migration

       xbzrle-cache: XBZRLECacheStats (optional)
              XBZRLECacheStats containing detailed XBZRLE migration statistics, only returned  if
              XBZRLE feature is on and status is 'active' or 'completed' (since 1.2)

       total-time: int (optional)
              total  amount  of milliseconds since migration started.  If migration has ended, it
              returns the total migration time. (since 1.2)

       downtime: int (optional)
              only present when migration finishes correctly total downtime in  milliseconds  for
              the guest.  (since 1.3)

       expected-downtime: int (optional)
              only  present  while  migration is active expected downtime in milliseconds for the
              guest in last walk of the dirty bitmap. (since 1.3)

       setup-time: int (optional)
              amount of setup time in milliseconds before the iterations begin but after the  QMP
              command  is  issued.  This  is  designed to provide an accounting of any activities
              (such as RDMA pinning) which may be expensive, but do not actually occur during the
              iterative migration rounds themselves. (since 1.6)

       cpu-throttle-percentage: int (optional)
              percentage  of  time  guest  cpus are being throttled during auto-converge. This is
              only present when auto-converge has started throttling guest cpus. (Since 2.7)

       error-desc: string (optional)
              the human readable error description  string,  when  status  is  'failed'.  Clients
              should not attempt to parse the error strings. (Since 2.7)

       postcopy-blocktime: int (optional)
              total  time when all vCPU were blocked during postcopy live migration. This is only
              present when the postcopy-blocktime migration capability is enabled. (Since 3.0)

       postcopy-vcpu-blocktime: array of int (optional)
              list  of  the  postcopy  blocktime  per  vCPU.   This  is  only  present  when  the
              postcopy-blocktime migration capability is enabled. (Since 3.0)

       compression: CompressionStats (optional)
              migration  compression  statistics,  only returned if compression feature is on and
              status is 'active' or 'completed' (Since 3.1)

       socket-address: array of SocketAddress (optional)
              Only used for tcp, to know what the real port is (Since 4.0)

       vfio: VfioStats (optional)
              VfioStats containing detailed VFIO devices migration statistics, only  returned  if
              VFIO  device  is  present, migration is supported by all VFIO devices and status is
              'active' or 'completed' (since 5.2)

       blocked-reasons: array of string (optional)
              A list of reasons an outgoing migration is blocked.   Present  and  non-empty  when
              migration is blocked.  (since 6.0)

   Since
       0.14

   query-migrate (Command)
       Returns  information about current migration process. If migration is active there will be
       another json-object with RAM migration status and if block migration is active another one
       with block migration status.

   Returns
       MigrationInfo

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          1. Before the first migration

          -> { "execute": "query-migrate" }
          <- { "return": {} }

          2. Migration is done and has succeeded

          -> { "execute": "query-migrate" }
          <- { "return": {
                  "status": "completed",
                  "total-time":12345,
                  "setup-time":12345,
                  "downtime":12345,
                  "ram":{
                    "transferred":123,
                    "remaining":123,
                    "total":246,
                    "duplicate":123,
                    "normal":123,
                    "normal-bytes":123456,
                    "dirty-sync-count":15
                  }
               }
             }

          3. Migration is done and has failed

          -> { "execute": "query-migrate" }
          <- { "return": { "status": "failed" } }

          4. Migration is being performed and is not a block migration:

          -> { "execute": "query-migrate" }
          <- {
                "return":{
                   "status":"active",
                   "total-time":12345,
                   "setup-time":12345,
                   "expected-downtime":12345,
                   "ram":{
                      "transferred":123,
                      "remaining":123,
                      "total":246,
                      "duplicate":123,
                      "normal":123,
                      "normal-bytes":123456,
                      "dirty-sync-count":15
                   }
                }
             }

          5. Migration is being performed and is a block migration:

          -> { "execute": "query-migrate" }
          <- {
                "return":{
                   "status":"active",
                   "total-time":12345,
                   "setup-time":12345,
                   "expected-downtime":12345,
                   "ram":{
                      "total":1057024,
                      "remaining":1053304,
                      "transferred":3720,
                      "duplicate":123,
                      "normal":123,
                      "normal-bytes":123456,
                      "dirty-sync-count":15
                   },
                   "disk":{
                      "total":20971520,
                      "remaining":20880384,
                      "transferred":91136
                   }
                }
             }

          6. Migration is being performed and XBZRLE is active:

          -> { "execute": "query-migrate" }
          <- {
                "return":{
                   "status":"active",
                   "total-time":12345,
                   "setup-time":12345,
                   "expected-downtime":12345,
                   "ram":{
                      "total":1057024,
                      "remaining":1053304,
                      "transferred":3720,
                      "duplicate":10,
                      "normal":3333,
                      "normal-bytes":3412992,
                      "dirty-sync-count":15
                   },
                   "xbzrle-cache":{
                      "cache-size":67108864,
                      "bytes":20971520,
                      "pages":2444343,
                      "cache-miss":2244,
                      "cache-miss-rate":0.123,
                      "encoding-rate":80.1,
                      "overflow":34434
                   }
                }
             }

   MigrationCapability (Enum)
       Migration capabilities enumeration

   Values
       xbzrle Migration  supports  xbzrle  (Xor  Based  Zero  Run Length Encoding).  This feature
              allows us to  minimize  migration  traffic  for  certain  work  loads,  by  sending
              compressed difference of the pages

       rdma-pin-all
              Controls  whether  or  not the entire VM memory footprint is mlock()'d on demand or
              all at once. Refer to docs/rdma.txt for usage.  Disabled by default. (since 2.0)

       zero-blocks
              During storage migration encode blocks  of  zeroes  efficiently.  This  essentially
              saves  1MB  of zeroes per block on the wire. Enabling requires source and target VM
              to support this feature. To enable it is sufficient to enable the capability on the
              source VM. The feature is disabled by default. (since 1.6)

       compress
              Use  multiple  compression  threads to accelerate live migration.  This feature can
              help to reduce the migration traffic, by sending compressed pages. Please note that
              if  compress  and  xbzrle  are  both on, compress only takes effect in the ram bulk
              stage, after that, it will be disabled and only xbzrle takes effect, this can  help
              to minimize migration traffic. The feature is disabled by default.  (since 2.4 )

       events generate events for each migration state change (since 2.4 )

       auto-converge
              If enabled, QEMU will automatically throttle down the guest to speed up convergence
              of RAM migration. (since 1.6)

       postcopy-ram
              Start executing on the migration target  before  all  of  RAM  has  been  migrated,
              pulling  the  remaining  pages  along  as  needed.  The capacity must have the same
              setting on both source and target or migration will not even start.  NOTE:  If  the
              migration fails during postcopy the VM will fail.  (since 2.6)

       x-colo If  enabled,  migration will never end, and the state of the VM on the primary side
              will be migrated continuously to the VM on secondary side, this process  is  called
              COarse-Grain LOck Stepping (COLO) for Non-stop Service. (since 2.8)

       release-ram
              if enabled, qemu will free the migrated ram pages on the source during postcopy-ram
              migration. (since 2.9)

       block  If enabled, QEMU will also migrate the contents of all block devices.   Default  is
              disabled.   A  possible alternative uses mirror jobs to a builtin NBD server on the
              destination, which offers more flexibility.  (Since 2.10)

       return-path
              If enabled, migration will use the return path even for precopy. (since 2.10)

       pause-before-switchover
              Pause outgoing migration before serialising device state and before disabling block
              IO (since 2.11)

       multifd
              Use more than one fd for migration (since 4.0)

       dirty-bitmaps
              If enabled, QEMU will migrate named dirty bitmaps.  (since 2.12)

       postcopy-blocktime
              Calculate downtime for postcopy live migration (since 3.0)

       late-block-activate
              If  enabled,  the destination will not activate block devices (and thus take locks)
              immediately at the end of migration.  (since 3.0)

       x-ignore-shared
              If enabled, QEMU will not migrate shared memory (since 4.0)

       validate-uuid
              Send the UUID of the source to allow the destination to  ensure  it  is  the  same.
              (since 4.2)

       background-snapshot
              If  enabled, the migration stream will be a snapshot of the VM exactly at the point
              when the migration procedure starts. The VM RAM is saved with running  VM.   (since
              6.0)

   Features
       unstable
              Members x-colo and x-ignore-shared are experimental.

   Since
       1.2

   MigrationCapabilityStatus (Object)
       Migration capability information

   Members
       capability: MigrationCapability
              capability enum

       state: boolean
              capability state bool

   Since
       1.2

   migrate-set-capabilities (Command)
       Enable/Disable the following migration capabilities (like xbzrle)

   Arguments
       capabilities: array of MigrationCapabilityStatus
              json array of capability modifications to make

   Since
       1.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "migrate-set-capabilities" , "arguments":
               { "capabilities": [ { "capability": "xbzrle", "state": true } ] } }

   query-migrate-capabilities (Command)
       Returns information about the current migration capabilities status

   Returns
       MigrationCapabilitiesStatus

   Since
       1.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-migrate-capabilities" }
          <- { "return": [
                {"state": false, "capability": "xbzrle"},
                {"state": false, "capability": "rdma-pin-all"},
                {"state": false, "capability": "auto-converge"},
                {"state": false, "capability": "zero-blocks"},
                {"state": false, "capability": "compress"},
                {"state": true, "capability": "events"},
                {"state": false, "capability": "postcopy-ram"},
                {"state": false, "capability": "x-colo"}
             ]}

   MultiFDCompression (Enum)
       An enumeration of multifd compression methods.

   Values
       none   no compression.

       zlib   use zlib compression method.

       zstd (If: CONFIG_ZSTD)
              use zstd compression method.

   Since
       5.0

   BitmapMigrationBitmapAliasTransform (Object)
   Members
       persistent: boolean (optional)
              If  present,  the  bitmap  will  be  made persistent or transient depending on this
              parameter.

   Since
       6.0

   BitmapMigrationBitmapAlias (Object)
   Members
       name: string
              The name of the bitmap.

       alias: string
              An alias name for migration (for example the bitmap name on the opposite site).

       transform: BitmapMigrationBitmapAliasTransform (optional)
              Allows the modification of the migrated bitmap.  (since 6.0)

   Since
       5.2

   BitmapMigrationNodeAlias (Object)
       Maps a block node name and the bitmaps it has to aliases for dirty bitmap migration.

   Members
       node-name: string
              A block node name.

       alias: string
              An alias block node name for migration (for example the node name on  the  opposite
              site).

       bitmaps: array of BitmapMigrationBitmapAlias
              Mappings for the bitmaps on this node.

   Since
       5.2

   MigrationParameter (Enum)
       Migration parameters enumeration

   Values
       announce-initial
              Initial delay (in milliseconds) before sending the first announce (Since 4.0)

       announce-max
              Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the announcement (Since 4.0)

       announce-rounds
              Number of self-announce packets sent after migration (Since 4.0)

       announce-step
              Increase  in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent packets in the announcement
              (Since 4.0)

       compress-level
              Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an
              integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression
              speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU.

       compress-threads
              Set compression thread count to be used in live migration, the  compression  thread
              count is an integer between 1 and 255.

       compress-wait-thread
              Controls  behavior  when  all  compression  threads  are  currently  busy.  If true
              (default), wait for a free compression thread to become available; otherwise,  send
              the page uncompressed. (Since 3.1)

       decompress-threads
              Set  decompression  thread  count  to  be used in live migration, the decompression
              thread count is an integer between 1 and 255. Usually, decompression is at least  4
              times as fast as compression, so set the decompress-threads to the number about 1/4
              of compress-threads is adequate.

       throttle-trigger-threshold
              The ratio of bytes_dirty_period and bytes_xfer_period to trigger throttling. It  is
              expressed as percentage.  The default value is 50. (Since 5.0)

       cpu-throttle-initial
              Initial percentage of time guest cpus are throttled when migration auto-converge is
              activated. The default value is 20. (Since 2.7)

       cpu-throttle-increment
              throttle percentage increase each time auto-converge detects that migration is  not
              making progress. The default value is 10. (Since 2.7)

       cpu-throttle-tailslow
              Make CPU throttling slower at tail stage At the tail stage of throttling, the Guest
              is very sensitive to CPU percentage while the cpu-throttle -increment is  excessive
              usually  at  tail  stage.  If this parameter is true, we will compute the ideal CPU
              percentage used by the Guest, which may exactly make the dirty rate match the dirty
              rate  threshold.  Then  we will choose a smaller throttle increment between the one
              specified by cpu-throttle-increment and the one generated by ideal CPU  percentage.
              Therefore,  it  is  compatible  to  traditional  throttling, meanwhile the throttle
              increment won't be excessive at tail stage.  The default  value  is  false.  (Since
              5.1)

       tls-creds
              ID  of  the  'tls-creds'  object  that  provides credentials for establishing a TLS
              connection over the migration data channel.  On the outgoing side of the migration,
              the  credentials  must  be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the incoming side the
              credentials must be for a 'server' endpoint. Setting this will enable TLS  for  all
              migrations.  The  default  is  unset,  resulting in unsecured migration at the QEMU
              level. (Since 2.7)

       tls-hostname
              hostname of the target host for the migration. This is  required  when  using  x509
              based  TLS  credentials  and the migration URI does not already include a hostname.
              For example if using fd: or exec: based migration, the hostname must be provided so
              that the server's x509 certificate identity can be validated. (Since 2.7)

       tls-authz
              ID  of the 'authz' object subclass that provides access control checking of the TLS
              x509 certificate distinguished name.  This object is only resolved at time of  use,
              so  can  be  deleted and recreated on the fly while the migration server is active.
              If missing, it will default to denying access (Since 4.0)

       max-bandwidth
              to set maximum speed for migration. maximum speed in bytes per second. (Since 2.8)

       downtime-limit
              set maximum tolerated downtime for  migration.  maximum  downtime  in  milliseconds
              (Since 2.8)

       x-checkpoint-delay
              The delay time (in ms) between two COLO checkpoints in periodic mode. (Since 2.8)

       block-incremental
              Affects  how  much  storage  is  migrated  when  the  block migration capability is
              enabled.  When false, the entire storage backing chain is migrated into a flattened
              image  at  the  destination; when true, only the active qcow2 layer is migrated and
              the destination must already have access to the same backing chain as was  used  on
              the source.  (since 2.10)

       multifd-channels
              Number  of  channels used to migrate data in parallel. This is the same number that
              the number of sockets used for migration.  The default value is 2 (since 4.0)

       xbzrle-cache-size
              cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration.  It needs to be a multiple of the target
              page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11)

       max-postcopy-bandwidth
              Background  transfer  bandwidth  during  postcopy.   Defaults to 0 (unlimited).  In
              bytes per second.  (Since 3.0)

       max-cpu-throttle
              maximum cpu throttle percentage.  Defaults to 99. (Since 3.1)

       multifd-compression
              Which compression method to use.  Defaults to none. (Since 5.0)

       multifd-zlib-level
              Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an
              integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression
              speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU.  Defaults to
              1. (Since 5.0)

       multifd-zstd-level
              Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an
              integer between 0  and  20,  where  0  means  no  compression,  1  means  the  best
              compression speed, and 20 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU.
              Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0)

       block-bitmap-mapping
              Maps block nodes and bitmaps on them to aliases for the  purpose  of  dirty  bitmap
              migration.  Such aliases may for example be the corresponding names on the opposite
              site.  The mapping must be one-to-one, but not necessarily complete: On the source,
              unmapped  bitmaps  and  all  bitmaps  on  unmapped  nodes  will be ignored.  On the
              destination, encountering an unmapped alias in the incoming migration  stream  will
              result  in  a report, and all further bitmap migration data will then be discarded.
              Note that the destination does not know about bitmaps it does not receive, so there
              is  no  limitation  or requirement regarding the number of bitmaps received, or how
              they are named, or on which nodes they are placed.  By default (when this parameter
              has  never  been  set), bitmap names are mapped to themselves.  Nodes are mapped to
              their block device name if there is one, and to their node name  otherwise.  (Since
              5.2)

   Features
       unstable
              Member x-checkpoint-delay is experimental.

   Since
       2.4

   MigrateSetParameters (Object)
   Members
       announce-initial: int (optional)
              Initial delay (in milliseconds) before sending the first announce (Since 4.0)

       announce-max: int (optional)
              Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the announcement (Since 4.0)

       announce-rounds: int (optional)
              Number of self-announce packets sent after migration (Since 4.0)

       announce-step: int (optional)
              Increase  in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent packets in the announcement
              (Since 4.0)

       compress-level: int (optional)
              compression level

       compress-threads: int (optional)
              compression thread count

       compress-wait-thread: boolean (optional)
              Controls behavior  when  all  compression  threads  are  currently  busy.  If  true
              (default),  wait for a free compression thread to become available; otherwise, send
              the page uncompressed. (Since 3.1)

       decompress-threads: int (optional)
              decompression thread count

       throttle-trigger-threshold: int (optional)
              The ratio of bytes_dirty_period and bytes_xfer_period to trigger throttling. It  is
              expressed as percentage.  The default value is 50. (Since 5.0)

       cpu-throttle-initial: int (optional)
              Initial percentage of time guest cpus are throttled when migration auto-converge is
              activated.  The default value is 20. (Since 2.7)

       cpu-throttle-increment: int (optional)
              throttle percentage increase each time auto-converge detects that migration is  not
              making progress. The default value is 10. (Since 2.7)

       cpu-throttle-tailslow: boolean (optional)
              Make CPU throttling slower at tail stage At the tail stage of throttling, the Guest
              is very sensitive to CPU percentage while the cpu-throttle -increment is  excessive
              usually  at  tail  stage.  If this parameter is true, we will compute the ideal CPU
              percentage used by the Guest, which may exactly make the dirty rate match the dirty
              rate  threshold.  Then  we will choose a smaller throttle increment between the one
              specified by cpu-throttle-increment and the one generated by ideal CPU  percentage.
              Therefore,  it  is  compatible  to  traditional  throttling, meanwhile the throttle
              increment won't be excessive at tail stage.  The default  value  is  false.  (Since
              5.1)

       tls-creds: StrOrNull (optional)
              ID  of  the  'tls-creds'  object  that  provides credentials for establishing a TLS
              connection over the migration data channel. On the outgoing side of the  migration,
              the  credentials  must  be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the incoming side the
              credentials must be for a 'server' endpoint. Setting this  to  a  non-empty  string
              enables  TLS  for  all  migrations.  An empty string means that QEMU will use plain
              text mode for migration, rather than TLS (Since 2.9) Previously (since  2.7),  this
              was reported by omitting tls-creds instead.

       tls-hostname: StrOrNull (optional)
              hostname  of  the  target  host for the migration. This is required when using x509
              based TLS credentials and the migration URI does not already  include  a  hostname.
              For example if using fd: or exec: based migration, the hostname must be provided so
              that the server's x509 certificate identity can be validated. (Since 2.7) An  empty
              string  means that QEMU will use the hostname associated with the migration URI, if
              any. (Since 2.9) Previously (since 2.7), this was reported by omitting tls-hostname
              instead.

       max-bandwidth: int (optional)
              to set maximum speed for migration. maximum speed in bytes per second. (Since 2.8)

       downtime-limit: int (optional)
              set  maximum  tolerated  downtime  for  migration. maximum downtime in milliseconds
              (Since 2.8)

       x-checkpoint-delay: int (optional)
              the delay time between two COLO checkpoints. (Since 2.8)

       block-incremental: boolean (optional)
              Affects how much storage  is  migrated  when  the  block  migration  capability  is
              enabled.  When false, the entire storage backing chain is migrated into a flattened
              image at the destination; when true, only the active qcow2 layer  is  migrated  and
              the  destination  must already have access to the same backing chain as was used on
              the source.  (since 2.10)

       multifd-channels: int (optional)
              Number of channels used to migrate data in parallel. This is the same  number  that
              the number of sockets used for migration.  The default value is 2 (since 4.0)

       xbzrle-cache-size: int (optional)
              cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration.  It needs to be a multiple of the target
              page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11)

       max-postcopy-bandwidth: int (optional)
              Background transfer bandwidth during postcopy.   Defaults  to  0  (unlimited).   In
              bytes per second.  (Since 3.0)

       max-cpu-throttle: int (optional)
              maximum cpu throttle percentage.  The default value is 99. (Since 3.1)

       multifd-compression: MultiFDCompression (optional)
              Which compression method to use.  Defaults to none. (Since 5.0)

       multifd-zlib-level: int (optional)
              Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an
              integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression
              speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU.  Defaults to
              1. (Since 5.0)

       multifd-zstd-level: int (optional)
              Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an
              integer  between  0  and  20,  where  0  means  no  compression,  1  means the best
              compression speed, and 20 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU.
              Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0)

       block-bitmap-mapping: array of BitmapMigrationNodeAlias (optional)
              Maps  block  nodes  and  bitmaps on them to aliases for the purpose of dirty bitmap
              migration.  Such aliases may for example be the corresponding names on the opposite
              site.  The mapping must be one-to-one, but not necessarily complete: On the source,
              unmapped bitmaps and all bitmaps  on  unmapped  nodes  will  be  ignored.   On  the
              destination,  encountering  an unmapped alias in the incoming migration stream will
              result in a report, and all further bitmap migration data will then  be  discarded.
              Note that the destination does not know about bitmaps it does not receive, so there
              is no limitation or requirement regarding the number of bitmaps  received,  or  how
              they are named, or on which nodes they are placed.  By default (when this parameter
              has never been set), bitmap names are mapped to themselves.  Nodes  are  mapped  to
              their  block  device name if there is one, and to their node name otherwise. (Since
              5.2)

       tls-authz: StrOrNull (optional)
              Not documented

   Features
       unstable
              Member x-checkpoint-delay is experimental.

   Since
       2.4

   migrate-set-parameters (Command)
       Set various migration parameters.

   Arguments
       The members of MigrateSetParameters

   Since
       2.4

   Example
          -> { "execute": "migrate-set-parameters" ,
               "arguments": { "compress-level": 1 } }

   MigrationParameters (Object)
       The optional members aren't actually optional.

   Members
       announce-initial: int (optional)
              Initial delay (in milliseconds) before sending the first announce (Since 4.0)

       announce-max: int (optional)
              Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the announcement (Since 4.0)

       announce-rounds: int (optional)
              Number of self-announce packets sent after migration (Since 4.0)

       announce-step: int (optional)
              Increase in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent packets in the  announcement
              (Since 4.0)

       compress-level: int (optional)
              compression level

       compress-threads: int (optional)
              compression thread count

       compress-wait-thread: boolean (optional)
              Controls  behavior  when  all  compression  threads  are  currently  busy.  If true
              (default), wait for a free compression thread to become available; otherwise,  send
              the page uncompressed. (Since 3.1)

       decompress-threads: int (optional)
              decompression thread count

       throttle-trigger-threshold: int (optional)
              The  ratio of bytes_dirty_period and bytes_xfer_period to trigger throttling. It is
              expressed as percentage.  The default value is 50. (Since 5.0)

       cpu-throttle-initial: int (optional)
              Initial percentage of time guest cpus are throttled when migration auto-converge is
              activated.  (Since 2.7)

       cpu-throttle-increment: int (optional)
              throttle  percentage increase each time auto-converge detects that migration is not
              making progress. (Since 2.7)

       cpu-throttle-tailslow: boolean (optional)
              Make CPU throttling slower at tail stage At the tail stage of throttling, the Guest
              is  very sensitive to CPU percentage while the cpu-throttle -increment is excessive
              usually at tail stage.  If this parameter is true, we will compute  the  ideal  CPU
              percentage used by the Guest, which may exactly make the dirty rate match the dirty
              rate threshold. Then we will choose a smaller throttle increment  between  the  one
              specified  by cpu-throttle-increment and the one generated by ideal CPU percentage.
              Therefore, it is compatible  to  traditional  throttling,  meanwhile  the  throttle
              increment  won't  be  excessive  at tail stage.  The default value is false. (Since
              5.1)

       tls-creds: string (optional)
              ID of the 'tls-creds' object that  provides  credentials  for  establishing  a  TLS
              connection  over the migration data channel. On the outgoing side of the migration,
              the credentials must be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the  incoming  side  the
              credentials  must be for a 'server' endpoint.  An empty string means that QEMU will
              use plain text mode for migration, rather than TLS (Since 2.7)  Note:  2.8  reports
              this by omitting tls-creds instead.

       tls-hostname: string (optional)
              hostname  of  the  target  host for the migration. This is required when using x509
              based TLS credentials and the migration URI does not already  include  a  hostname.
              For example if using fd: or exec: based migration, the hostname must be provided so
              that the server's x509 certificate identity can be validated. (Since 2.7) An  empty
              string  means that QEMU will use the hostname associated with the migration URI, if
              any. (Since 2.9) Note: 2.8 reports this by omitting tls-hostname instead.

       tls-authz: string (optional)
              ID of the 'authz' object subclass that provides access control checking of the  TLS
              x509 certificate distinguished name. (Since 4.0)

       max-bandwidth: int (optional)
              to set maximum speed for migration. maximum speed in bytes per second. (Since 2.8)

       downtime-limit: int (optional)
              set  maximum  tolerated  downtime  for  migration. maximum downtime in milliseconds
              (Since 2.8)

       x-checkpoint-delay: int (optional)
              the delay time between two COLO checkpoints. (Since 2.8)

       block-incremental: boolean (optional)
              Affects how much storage  is  migrated  when  the  block  migration  capability  is
              enabled.  When false, the entire storage backing chain is migrated into a flattened
              image at the destination; when true, only the active qcow2 layer  is  migrated  and
              the  destination  must already have access to the same backing chain as was used on
              the source.  (since 2.10)

       multifd-channels: int (optional)
              Number of channels used to migrate data in parallel. This is the same  number  that
              the number of sockets used for migration.  The default value is 2 (since 4.0)

       xbzrle-cache-size: int (optional)
              cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration.  It needs to be a multiple of the target
              page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11)

       max-postcopy-bandwidth: int (optional)
              Background transfer bandwidth during postcopy.   Defaults  to  0  (unlimited).   In
              bytes per second.  (Since 3.0)

       max-cpu-throttle: int (optional)
              maximum cpu throttle percentage.  Defaults to 99.  (Since 3.1)

       multifd-compression: MultiFDCompression (optional)
              Which compression method to use.  Defaults to none. (Since 5.0)

       multifd-zlib-level: int (optional)
              Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an
              integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression
              speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU.  Defaults to
              1. (Since 5.0)

       multifd-zstd-level: int (optional)
              Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an
              integer  between  0  and  20,  where  0  means  no  compression,  1  means the best
              compression speed, and 20 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU.
              Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0)

       block-bitmap-mapping: array of BitmapMigrationNodeAlias (optional)
              Maps  block  nodes  and  bitmaps on them to aliases for the purpose of dirty bitmap
              migration.  Such aliases may for example be the corresponding names on the opposite
              site.  The mapping must be one-to-one, but not necessarily complete: On the source,
              unmapped bitmaps and all bitmaps  on  unmapped  nodes  will  be  ignored.   On  the
              destination,  encountering  an unmapped alias in the incoming migration stream will
              result in a report, and all further bitmap migration data will then  be  discarded.
              Note that the destination does not know about bitmaps it does not receive, so there
              is no limitation or requirement regarding the number of bitmaps  received,  or  how
              they are named, or on which nodes they are placed.  By default (when this parameter
              has never been set), bitmap names are mapped to themselves.  Nodes  are  mapped  to
              their  block  device name if there is one, and to their node name otherwise. (Since
              5.2)

   Features
       unstable
              Member x-checkpoint-delay is experimental.

   Since
       2.4

   query-migrate-parameters (Command)
       Returns information about the current migration parameters

   Returns
       MigrationParameters

   Since
       2.4

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-migrate-parameters" }
          <- { "return": {
                   "decompress-threads": 2,
                   "cpu-throttle-increment": 10,
                   "compress-threads": 8,
                   "compress-level": 1,
                   "cpu-throttle-initial": 20,
                   "max-bandwidth": 33554432,
                   "downtime-limit": 300
                }
             }

   client_migrate_info (Command)
       Set migration information for remote display.  This makes the server  ask  the  client  to
       automatically  reconnect  using  the  new parameters once migration finished successfully.
       Only implemented for SPICE.

   Arguments
       protocol: string
              must be "spice"

       hostname: string
              migration target hostname

       port: int (optional)
              spice tcp port for plaintext channels

       tls-port: int (optional)
              spice tcp port for tls-secured channels

       cert-subject: string (optional)
              server certificate subject

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "client_migrate_info",
               "arguments": { "protocol": "spice",
                              "hostname": "virt42.lab.kraxel.org",
                              "port": 1234 } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   migrate-start-postcopy (Command)
       Followup  to  a  migration  command  to  switch  the  migration  to  postcopy  mode.   The
       postcopy-ram  capability  must  be  set on both source and destination before the original
       migration command.

   Since
       2.5

   Example
          -> { "execute": "migrate-start-postcopy" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   MIGRATION (Event)
       Emitted when a migration event happens

   Arguments
       status: MigrationStatus
              MigrationStatus describing the current migration status.

   Since
       2.4

   Example
          <- {"timestamp": {"seconds": 1432121972, "microseconds": 744001},
              "event": "MIGRATION",
              "data": {"status": "completed"} }

   MIGRATION_PASS (Event)
       Emitted from the source side of a migration at the start of each pass (when it  syncs  the
       dirty bitmap)

   Arguments
       pass: int
              An incrementing count (starting at 1 on the first pass)

   Since
       2.6

   Example
          { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1449669631, "microseconds": 239225},
            "event": "MIGRATION_PASS", "data": {"pass": 2} }

   COLOMessage (Enum)
       The message transmission between Primary side and Secondary side.

   Values
       checkpoint-ready
              Secondary VM (SVM) is ready for checkpointing

       checkpoint-request
              Primary VM (PVM) tells SVM to prepare for checkpointing

       checkpoint-reply
              SVM gets PVM's checkpoint request

       vmstate-send
              VM's state will be sent by PVM.

       vmstate-size
              The total size of VMstate.

       vmstate-received
              VM's state has been received by SVM.

       vmstate-loaded
              VM's state has been loaded by SVM.

   Since
       2.8

   COLOMode (Enum)
       The COLO current mode.

   Values
       none   COLO is disabled.

       primary
              COLO node in primary side.

       secondary
              COLO node in slave side.

   Since
       2.8

   FailoverStatus (Enum)
       An enumeration of COLO failover status

   Values
       none   no failover has ever happened

       require
              got failover requirement but not handled

       active in the process of doing failover

       completed
              finish the process of failover

       relaunch
              restart the failover process, from 'none' -> 'completed' (Since 2.9)

   Since
       2.8

   COLO_EXIT (Event)
       Emitted  when  VM  finishes  COLO  mode  due to some errors happening or at the request of
       users.

   Arguments
       mode: COLOMode
              report COLO mode when COLO exited.

       reason: COLOExitReason
              describes the reason for the COLO exit.

   Since
       3.1

   Example
          <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 2032141960, "microseconds": 417172},
               "event": "COLO_EXIT", "data": {"mode": "primary", "reason": "request" } }

   COLOExitReason (Enum)
       The reason for a COLO exit.

   Values
       none   failover has never happened. This state does not occur in the COLO_EXIT event,  and
              is only visible in the result of query-colo-status.

       request
              COLO exit is due to an external request.

       error  COLO exit is due to an internal error.

       processing
              COLO is currently handling a failover (since 4.0).

   Since
       3.1

   x-colo-lost-heartbeat (Command)
       Tell  qemu  that heartbeat is lost, request it to do takeover procedures.  If this command
       is sent to the PVM, the Primary side will exit COLO mode.  If sent to the  Secondary,  the
       Secondary  side  will  run  failover  work, then takes over server operation to become the
       service VM.

   Features
       unstable
              This command is experimental.

   Since
       2.8

   Example
          -> { "execute": "x-colo-lost-heartbeat" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   migrate_cancel (Command)
       Cancel the current executing migration process.

   Returns
       nothing on success

   Notes
       This command succeeds even if there is no migration process running.

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "migrate_cancel" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   migrate-continue (Command)
       Continue migration when it's in a paused state.

   Arguments
       state: MigrationStatus
              The state the migration is currently expected to be in

   Returns
       nothing on success

   Since
       2.11

   Example
          -> { "execute": "migrate-continue" , "arguments":
               { "state": "pre-switchover" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   migrate (Command)
       Migrates the current running guest to another Virtual Machine.

   Arguments
       uri: string
              the Uniform Resource Identifier of the destination VM

       blk: boolean (optional)
              do block migration (full disk copy)

       inc: boolean (optional)
              incremental disk copy migration

       detach: boolean (optional)
              this argument exists only for compatibility reasons and is ignored by QEMU

       resume: boolean (optional)
              resume one paused migration, default "off". (since 3.0)

   Returns
       nothing on success

   Since
       0.14

   Notes
       1. The 'query-migrate' command should be used to  check  migration's  progress  and  final
          result (this information is provided by the 'status' member)

       2. All boolean arguments default to false

       3. The user Monitor's "detach" argument is invalid in QMP and should not be used

   Example
          -> { "execute": "migrate", "arguments": { "uri": "tcp:0:4446" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   migrate-incoming (Command)
       Start an incoming migration, the qemu must have been started with -incoming defer

   Arguments
       uri: string
              The Uniform Resource Identifier identifying the source or address to listen on

   Returns
       nothing on success

   Since
       2.3

   Notes
       1. It's  a  bad  idea  to  use  a string for the uri, but it needs to stay compatible with
          -incoming and the format of the uri is already exposed above libvirt.

       2. QEMU must be started with -incoming defer to allow migrate-incoming to be used.

       3. The uri format is the same as for -incoming

   Example
          -> { "execute": "migrate-incoming",
               "arguments": { "uri": "tcp::4446" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   xen-save-devices-state (Command)
       Save the state of all devices to file. The RAM and the block devices of  the  VM  are  not
       saved by this command.

   Arguments
       filename: string
              the   file   to   save   the   state   of  the  devices  to  as  binary  data.  See
              xen-save-devices-state.txt for a description of the binary format.

       live: boolean (optional)
              Optional argument to ask QEMU to treat this command as part of  a  live  migration.
              Default to true. (since 2.11)

   Returns
       Nothing on success

   Since
       1.1

   Example
          -> { "execute": "xen-save-devices-state",
               "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/save" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   xen-set-global-dirty-log (Command)
       Enable or disable the global dirty log mode.

   Arguments
       enable: boolean
              true to enable, false to disable.

   Returns
       nothing

   Since
       1.3

   Example
          -> { "execute": "xen-set-global-dirty-log",
               "arguments": { "enable": true } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   xen-load-devices-state (Command)
       Load  the  state of all devices from file. The RAM and the block devices of the VM are not
       loaded by this command.

   Arguments
       filename: string
              the  file  to  load  the  state  of  the  devices  from   as   binary   data.   See
              xen-save-devices-state.txt for a description of the binary format.

   Since
       2.7

   Example
          -> { "execute": "xen-load-devices-state",
               "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/resume" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   xen-set-replication (Command)
       Enable or disable replication.

   Arguments
       enable: boolean
              true to enable, false to disable.

       primary: boolean
              true for primary or false for secondary.

       failover: boolean (optional)
              true  to  do  failover, false to stop. but cannot be specified if 'enable' is true.
              default value is false.

   Returns
       nothing.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "xen-set-replication",
               "arguments": {"enable": true, "primary": false} }
          <- { "return": {} }

   Since
       2.9

   If
       CONFIG_REPLICATION

   ReplicationStatus (Object)
       The result format for 'query-xen-replication-status'.

   Members
       error: boolean
              true if an error happened, false if replication is normal.

       desc: string (optional)
              the human readable error description string, when error is 'true'.

   Since
       2.9

   If
       CONFIG_REPLICATION

   query-xen-replication-status (Command)
       Query replication status while the vm is running.

   Returns
       A ReplicationResult object showing the status.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-xen-replication-status" }
          <- { "return": { "error": false } }

   Since
       2.9

   If
       CONFIG_REPLICATION

   xen-colo-do-checkpoint (Command)
       Xen uses this command to notify replication to trigger a checkpoint.

   Returns
       nothing.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "xen-colo-do-checkpoint" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   Since
       2.9

   If
       CONFIG_REPLICATION

   COLOStatus (Object)
       The result format for 'query-colo-status'.

   Members
       mode: COLOMode
              COLO running mode. If  COLO  is  running,  this  field  will  return  'primary'  or
              'secondary'.

       last-mode: COLOMode
              COLO  last  running mode. If COLO is running, this field will return same like mode
              field, after failover we can use this field to get last colo mode. (since 4.0)

       reason: COLOExitReason
              describes the reason for the COLO exit.

   Since
       3.1

   query-colo-status (Command)
       Query COLO status while the vm is running.

   Returns
       A COLOStatus object showing the status.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-colo-status" }
          <- { "return": { "mode": "primary", "reason": "request" } }

   Since
       3.1

   migrate-recover (Command)
       Provide a recovery migration stream URI.

   Arguments
       uri: string
              the URI to be used for the recovery of migration stream.

   Returns
       nothing.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "migrate-recover",
               "arguments": { "uri": "tcp:192.168.1.200:12345" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   Since
       3.0

   migrate-pause (Command)
       Pause a migration.  Currently it only supports postcopy.

   Returns
       nothing.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "migrate-pause" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   Since
       3.0

   UNPLUG_PRIMARY (Event)
       Emitted from source side of a migration when migration state is  WAIT_UNPLUG.  Device  was
       unplugged  by  guest operating system.  Device resources in QEMU are kept on standby to be
       able to re-plug it in case of migration failure.

   Arguments
       device-id: string
              QEMU device id of the unplugged device

   Since
       4.2

   Example
          {"event": "UNPLUG_PRIMARY", "data": {"device-id": "hostdev0"} }

   DirtyRateVcpu (Object)
       Dirty rate of vcpu.

   Members
       id: int
              vcpu index.

       dirty-rate: int
              dirty rate.

   Since
       6.2

   DirtyRateStatus (Enum)
       An enumeration of dirtyrate status.

   Values
       unstarted
              the dirtyrate thread has not been started.

       measuring
              the dirtyrate thread is measuring.

       measured
              the dirtyrate thread has measured and results are available.

   Since
       5.2

   DirtyRateMeasureMode (Enum)
       An enumeration of mode of measuring dirtyrate.

   Values
       page-sampling
              calculate dirtyrate by sampling pages.

       dirty-ring
              calculate dirtyrate by dirty ring.

       dirty-bitmap
              calculate dirtyrate by dirty bitmap.

   Since
       6.2

   DirtyRateInfo (Object)
       Information about current dirty page rate of vm.

   Members
       dirty-rate: int (optional)
              an estimate of the dirty page rate of the VM in units of MB/s,  present  only  when
              estimating the rate has completed.

       status: DirtyRateStatus
              status  containing  dirtyrate  query  status includes 'unstarted' or 'measuring' or
              'measured'

       start-time: int
              start time in units of second for calculation

       calc-time: int
              time in units of second for sample dirty pages

       sample-pages: int
              page count per GB for sample dirty pages the default value is 512 (since 6.1)

       mode: DirtyRateMeasureMode
              mode  containing  method  of  calculate  dirtyrate  includes  'page-sampling'   and
              'dirty-ring' (Since 6.2)

       vcpu-dirty-rate: array of DirtyRateVcpu (optional)
              dirtyrate for each vcpu if dirty-ring mode specified (Since 6.2)

   Since
       5.2

   calc-dirty-rate (Command)
       start calculating dirty page rate for vm

   Arguments
       calc-time: int
              time in units of second for sample dirty pages

       sample-pages: int (optional)
              page count per GB for sample dirty pages the default value is 512 (since 6.1)

       mode: DirtyRateMeasureMode (optional)
              mechanism of calculating dirtyrate includes 'page-sampling' and 'dirty-ring' (Since
              6.1)

   Since
       5.2

   Example
          {"command": "calc-dirty-rate", "data": {"calc-time": 1,
                                                    'sample-pages': 512} }

   query-dirty-rate (Command)
       query dirty page rate in units of MB/s for vm

   Since
       5.2

   snapshot-save (Command)
       Save a VM snapshot

   Arguments
       job-id: string
              identifier for the newly created job

       tag: string
              name of the snapshot to create

       vmstate: string
              block device node name to save vmstate to

       devices: array of string
              list of block device node names to save a snapshot to
       Applications should not assume that the  snapshot  save  is  complete  when  this  command
       returns.  The  job  commands  /  events  must be used to determine completion and to fetch
       details of any errors that arise.

       Note that execution of the guest CPUs may be stopped during the time it takes to save  the
       snapshot. A future version of QEMU may ensure CPUs are executing continuously.

       It  is  strongly  recommended  that  devices  contain all writable block device nodes if a
       consistent snapshot is required.

       If tag already exists, an error will be reported

   Returns
       nothing

   Example
          -> { "execute": "snapshot-save",
               "data": {
                  "job-id": "snapsave0",
                  "tag": "my-snap",
                  "vmstate": "disk0",
                  "devices": ["disk0", "disk1"]
               }
             }
          <- { "return": { } }
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "created", "id": "snapsave0"}}
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "running", "id": "snapsave0"}}
          <- {"event": "STOP"}
          <- {"event": "RESUME"}
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "waiting", "id": "snapsave0"}}
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "pending", "id": "snapsave0"}}
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "concluded", "id": "snapsave0"}}
          -> {"execute": "query-jobs"}
          <- {"return": [{"current-progress": 1,
                          "status": "concluded",
                          "total-progress": 1,
                          "type": "snapshot-save",
                          "id": "snapsave0"}]}

   Since
       6.0

   snapshot-load (Command)
       Load a VM snapshot

   Arguments
       job-id: string
              identifier for the newly created job

       tag: string
              name of the snapshot to load.

       vmstate: string
              block device node name to load vmstate from

       devices: array of string
              list of block device node names to load a snapshot from
       Applications should not assume that the  snapshot  load  is  complete  when  this  command
       returns.  The  job  commands  /  events  must be used to determine completion and to fetch
       details of any errors that arise.

       Note that execution of the guest CPUs will be stopped during the time it takes to load the
       snapshot.

       It  is  strongly recommended that devices contain all writable block device nodes that can
       have changed since the original snapshot-save command execution.

   Returns
       nothing

   Example
          -> { "execute": "snapshot-load",
               "data": {
                  "job-id": "snapload0",
                  "tag": "my-snap",
                  "vmstate": "disk0",
                  "devices": ["disk0", "disk1"]
               }
             }
          <- { "return": { } }
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "created", "id": "snapload0"}}
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "running", "id": "snapload0"}}
          <- {"event": "STOP"}
          <- {"event": "RESUME"}
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "waiting", "id": "snapload0"}}
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "pending", "id": "snapload0"}}
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "concluded", "id": "snapload0"}}
          -> {"execute": "query-jobs"}
          <- {"return": [{"current-progress": 1,
                          "status": "concluded",
                          "total-progress": 1,
                          "type": "snapshot-load",
                          "id": "snapload0"}]}

   Since
       6.0

   snapshot-delete (Command)
       Delete a VM snapshot

   Arguments
       job-id: string
              identifier for the newly created job

       tag: string
              name of the snapshot to delete.

       devices: array of string
              list of block device node names to delete a snapshot from
       Applications should not assume that the snapshot delete  is  complete  when  this  command
       returns.  The  job  commands  /  events  must be used to determine completion and to fetch
       details of any errors that arise.

   Returns
       nothing

   Example
          -> { "execute": "snapshot-delete",
               "data": {
                  "job-id": "snapdelete0",
                  "tag": "my-snap",
                  "devices": ["disk0", "disk1"]
               }
             }
          <- { "return": { } }
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "created", "id": "snapdelete0"}}
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "running", "id": "snapdelete0"}}
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "waiting", "id": "snapdelete0"}}
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "pending", "id": "snapdelete0"}}
          <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
              "data": {"status": "concluded", "id": "snapdelete0"}}
          -> {"execute": "query-jobs"}
          <- {"return": [{"current-progress": 1,
                          "status": "concluded",
                          "total-progress": 1,
                          "type": "snapshot-delete",
                          "id": "snapdelete0"}]}

   Since
       6.0

TRANSACTIONS

   Abort (Object)
       This action can be used to test transaction failure.

   Since
       1.6

   ActionCompletionMode (Enum)
       An enumeration of Transactional completion modes.

   Values
       individual
              Do not attempt  to  cancel  any  other  Actions  if  any  Actions  fail  after  the
              Transaction request succeeds. All Actions that can complete successfully will do so
              without waiting on others.  This is the default.

       grouped
              If any Action fails after the Transaction succeeds, cancel all Actions. Actions  do
              not  complete  until  all Actions are ready to complete. May be rejected by Actions
              that do not support this completion mode.

   Since
       2.5

   TransactionActionKind (Enum)
   Values
       abort  Since 1.6

       block-dirty-bitmap-add
              Since 2.5

       block-dirty-bitmap-remove
              Since 4.2

       block-dirty-bitmap-clear
              Since 2.5

       block-dirty-bitmap-enable
              Since 4.0

       block-dirty-bitmap-disable
              Since 4.0

       block-dirty-bitmap-merge
              Since 4.0

       blockdev-backup
              Since 2.3

       blockdev-snapshot
              Since 2.5

       blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync
              Since 1.7

       blockdev-snapshot-sync
              since 1.1

       drive-backup
              Since 1.6

   Features
       deprecated
              Member drive-backup is deprecated.  Use member blockdev-backup instead.

   Since
       1.1

   AbortWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: Abort
              Not documented

   Since
       1.6

   BlockDirtyBitmapAddWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: BlockDirtyBitmapAdd
              Not documented

   Since
       2.5

   BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: BlockDirtyBitmap
              Not documented

   Since
       2.5

   BlockDirtyBitmapMergeWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: BlockDirtyBitmapMerge
              Not documented

   Since
       4.0

   BlockdevBackupWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: BlockdevBackup
              Not documented

   Since
       2.3

   BlockdevSnapshotWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: BlockdevSnapshot
              Not documented

   Since
       2.5

   BlockdevSnapshotInternalWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: BlockdevSnapshotInternal
              Not documented

   Since
       1.7

   BlockdevSnapshotSyncWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: BlockdevSnapshotSync
              Not documented

   Since
       1.1

   DriveBackupWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: DriveBackup
              Not documented

   Since
       1.6

   TransactionAction (Object)
       A discriminated record of operations that can be performed with transaction.

   Members
       type: TransactionActionKind
              Not documented

       The members of AbortWrapper when type is "abort"

       The members of BlockDirtyBitmapAddWrapper when type is "block-dirty-bitmap-add"

       The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper when type is "block-dirty-bitmap-remove"

       The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper when type is "block-dirty-bitmap-clear"

       The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper when type is "block-dirty-bitmap-enable"

       The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper when type is "block-dirty-bitmap-disable"

       The members of BlockDirtyBitmapMergeWrapper when type is "block-dirty-bitmap-merge"

       The members of BlockdevBackupWrapper when type is "blockdev-backup"

       The members of BlockdevSnapshotWrapper when type is "blockdev-snapshot"

       The      members      of      BlockdevSnapshotInternalWrapper      when      type       is
       "blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync"

       The members of BlockdevSnapshotSyncWrapper when type is "blockdev-snapshot-sync"

       The members of DriveBackupWrapper when type is "drive-backup"

   Since
       1.1

   TransactionProperties (Object)
       Optional arguments to modify the behavior of a Transaction.

   Members
       completion-mode: ActionCompletionMode (optional)
              Controls  how  jobs  launched  asynchronously by Actions will complete or fail as a
              group.  See ActionCompletionMode for details.

   Since
       2.5

   transaction (Command)
       Executes a number of transactionable QMP commands atomically. If any operation fails, then
       the entire set of actions will be abandoned and the appropriate error returned.

       For  external  snapshots,  the dictionary contains the device, the file to use for the new
       snapshot, and the format.  The default format, if not specified, is qcow2.

       Each new snapshot defaults to being created by QEMU  (wiping  any  contents  if  the  file
       already  exists),  but  it  is  also possible to reuse an externally-created file.  In the
       latter case, you should ensure that the new image  file  has  the  same  contents  as  the
       current  one;  QEMU  cannot  perform  any meaningful check.  Typically this is achieved by
       using the current image file as the backing file for the new image.

       On failure, the original disks pre-snapshot attempt will be used.

       For internal snapshots, the dictionary contains the device and the snapshot's name.  If an
       internal  snapshot  matching name already exists, the request will be rejected.  Only some
       image formats support it, for example, qcow2, and rbd,

       On failure, qemu will try delete the newly created internal snapshot in  the  transaction.
       When  an I/O error occurs during deletion, the user needs to fix it later with qemu-img or
       other command.

   Arguments
       actions: array of TransactionAction
              List of TransactionAction; information needed for the respective operations.

       properties: TransactionProperties (optional)
              structure of additional options to control the execution of  the  transaction.  See
              TransactionProperties for additional detail.

   Returns
       nothing on success

       Errors depend on the operations of the transaction

   Note
       The transaction aborts on the first failure.  Therefore, there will be information on only
       one failed operation returned in an error condition, and subsequent actions will not  have
       been attempted.

   Since
       1.1

   Example
          -> { "execute": "transaction",
               "arguments": { "actions": [
                   { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "data" : { "device": "ide-hd0",
                                               "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image",
                                               "format": "qcow2" } },
                   { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "data" : { "node-name": "myfile",
                                               "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image2",
                                               "snapshot-node-name": "node3432",
                                               "mode": "existing",
                                               "format": "qcow2" } },
                   { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "data" : { "device": "ide-hd1",
                                               "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image2",
                                               "mode": "existing",
                                               "format": "qcow2" } },
                   { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync", "data" : {
                                               "device": "ide-hd2",
                                               "name": "snapshot0" } } ] } }
          <- { "return": {} }

TRACING

   TraceEventState (Enum)
       State of a tracing event.

   Values
       unavailable
              The event is statically disabled.

       disabled
              The event is dynamically disabled.

       enabled
              The event is dynamically enabled.

   Since
       2.2

   TraceEventInfo (Object)
       Information of a tracing event.

   Members
       name: string
              Event name.

       state: TraceEventState
              Tracing state.

       vcpu: boolean
              Whether this is a per-vCPU event (since 2.7).
       An event is per-vCPU if it has the "vcpu" property in the "trace-events" files.

   Since
       2.2

   trace-event-get-state (Command)
       Query the state of events.

   Arguments
       name: string
              Event name pattern (case-sensitive glob).

       vcpu: int (optional)
              The vCPU to query (any by default; since 2.7).

   Returns
       a list of TraceEventInfo for the matching events

       An event is returned if:

       • its name matches the name pattern, and

       • if vcpu is given, the event has the "vcpu" property.

       Therefore,  if  vcpu  is  given,  the operation will only match per-vCPU events, returning
       their state on the specified vCPU. Special case: if name is an exact match, vcpu is  given
       and the event does not have the "vcpu" property, an error is returned.

   Since
       2.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "trace-event-get-state",
               "arguments": { "name": "qemu_memalign" } }
          <- { "return": [ { "name": "qemu_memalign", "state": "disabled" } ] }

   trace-event-set-state (Command)
       Set the dynamic tracing state of events.

   Arguments
       name: string
              Event name pattern (case-sensitive glob).

       enable: boolean
              Whether to enable tracing.

       ignore-unavailable: boolean (optional)
              Do not match unavailable events with name.

       vcpu: int (optional)
              The vCPU to act upon (all by default; since 2.7).
       An  event's  state  is  modified if: - its name matches the name pattern, and - if vcpu is
       given, the event has the "vcpu" property.

       Therefore, if vcpu is given, the operation will only match per-vCPU events, setting  their
       state  on  the  specified vCPU. Special case: if name is an exact match, vcpu is given and
       the event does not have the "vcpu" property, an error is returned.

   Since
       2.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "trace-event-set-state",
               "arguments": { "name": "qemu_memalign", "enable": true } }
          <- { "return": {} }

COMPATIBILITY POLICY

   CompatPolicyInput (Enum)
       Policy for handling "funny" input.

   Values
       accept Accept silently

       reject Reject with an error

       crash  abort() the process

   Since
       6.0

   CompatPolicyOutput (Enum)
       Policy for handling "funny" output.

   Values
       accept Pass on unchanged

       hide   Filter out

   Since
       6.0

   CompatPolicy (Object)
       Policy for handling deprecated management interfaces.

       This is intended for testing users of the management interfaces.

       Limitation: covers  only  syntactic  aspects  of  QMP,  i.e.  stuff  tagged  with  feature
       'deprecated'.   We  may want to extend it to cover semantic aspects, CLI, and experimental
       features.

       Limitation: deprecated-output policy hide is not implemented for enumeration values.  They
       behave the same as with policy accept.

   Members
       deprecated-input: CompatPolicyInput (optional)
              how to handle deprecated input (default 'accept')

       deprecated-output: CompatPolicyOutput (optional)
              how to handle deprecated output (default 'accept')

       unstable-input: CompatPolicyInput (optional)
              how to handle unstable input (default 'accept') (since 6.2)

       unstable-output: CompatPolicyOutput (optional)
              how to handle unstable output (default 'accept') (since 6.2)

   Since
       6.0

QMP MONITOR CONTROL

   qmp_capabilities (Command)
       Enable QMP capabilities.

       Arguments:

   Arguments
       enable: array of QMPCapability (optional)
              An optional list of QMPCapability values to enable.  The client must not enable any
              capability that is not mentioned in the QMP greeting message.  If the field is  not
              provided, it means no QMP capabilities will be enabled.  (since 2.12)

   Example
          -> { "execute": "qmp_capabilities",
               "arguments": { "enable": [ "oob" ] } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   Notes
       This  command  is  valid exactly when first connecting: it must be issued before any other
       command will be accepted, and will fail once the monitor is accepting other commands. (see
       qemu docs/interop/qmp-spec.txt)

       The  QMP  client  needs  to  explicitly  enable  QMP  capabilities,  otherwise all the QMP
       capabilities will be turned off by default.

   Since
       0.13

   QMPCapability (Enum)
       Enumeration of capabilities to be advertised during initial client  connection,  used  for
       agreeing on particular QMP extension behaviors.

   Values
       oob    QMP  ability  to  support  out-of-band requests.  (Please refer to qmp-spec.txt for
              more information on OOB)

   Since
       2.12

   VersionTriple (Object)
       A three-part version number.

   Members
       major: int
              The major version number.

       minor: int
              The minor version number.

       micro: int
              The micro version number.

   Since
       2.4

   VersionInfo (Object)
       A description of QEMU's version.

   Members
       qemu: VersionTriple
              The version of QEMU.  By current convention, a micro  version  of  50  signifies  a
              development  branch.   A  micro  version  greater  than  or equal to 90 signifies a
              release candidate for the next minor version.  A micro  version  of  less  than  50
              signifies a stable release.

       package: string
              QEMU  will  always  set this field to an empty string.  Downstream versions of QEMU
              should set this to a non-empty string.  The exact format depends on the  downstream
              however it highly recommended that a unique name is used.

   Since
       0.14

   query-version (Command)
       Returns the current version of QEMU.

   Returns
       A VersionInfo object describing the current version of QEMU.

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-version" }
          <- {
                "return":{
                   "qemu":{
                      "major":0,
                      "minor":11,
                      "micro":5
                   },
                   "package":""
                }
             }

   CommandInfo (Object)
       Information about a QMP command

   Members
       name: string
              The command name

   Since
       0.14

   query-commands (Command)
       Return a list of supported QMP commands by this server

   Returns
       A list of CommandInfo for all supported commands

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-commands" }
          <- {
               "return":[
                  {
                     "name":"query-balloon"
                  },
                  {
                     "name":"system_powerdown"
                  }
               ]
             }

   Note
       This example has been shortened as the real response is too long.

   quit (Command)
       This  command will cause the QEMU process to exit gracefully.  While every attempt is made
       to send the QMP response before terminating, this is  not  guaranteed.   When  using  this
       interface, a premature EOF would not be unexpected.

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "quit" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   MonitorMode (Enum)
       An enumeration of monitor modes.

   Values
       readline
              HMP monitor (human-oriented command line interface)

       control
              QMP monitor (JSON-based machine interface)

   Since
       5.0

   MonitorOptions (Object)
       Options to be used for adding a new monitor.

   Members
       id: string (optional)
              Name of the monitor

       mode: MonitorMode (optional)
              Selects  the  monitor  mode  (default:  readline in the system emulator, control in
              qemu-storage-daemon)

       pretty: boolean (optional)
              Enables pretty printing (QMP only)

       chardev: string
              Name of a character device to expose the monitor on

   Since
       5.0

QMP INTROSPECTION

   query-qmp-schema (Command)
       Command query-qmp-schema exposes the QMP wire ABI as an array of  SchemaInfo.   This  lets
       QMP  clients  figure  out  what  commands and events are available in this QEMU, and their
       parameters and results.

       However, the SchemaInfo can't reflect all the rules and restrictions that  apply  to  QMP.
       It's  interface  introspection  (figuring  out what's there), not interface specification.
       The specification is in the QAPI schema.

       Furthermore, while we strive to keep the QMP wire format backwards-compatible across  qemu
       versions,  the  introspection  output  is  not guaranteed to have the same stability.  For
       example, one version of qemu may list an object member as an optional  non-variant,  while
       another  lists the same member only through the object's variants; or the type of a member
       may change from a generic string into a specific enum or from one specific  type  into  an
       alternate that includes the original type alongside something else.

   Returns
       array  of  SchemaInfo,  where each element describes an entity in the ABI: command, event,
       type, ...

       The order of the various SchemaInfo is unspecified; however, all names are  guaranteed  to
       be unique (no name will be duplicated with different meta-types).

   Note
       the  QAPI  schema is also used to help define internal interfaces, by defining QAPI types.
       These are not part of the QMP wire ABI, and therefore not returned by this command.

   Since
       2.5

   SchemaMetaType (Enum)
       This is a SchemaInfo's meta type, i.e. the kind of entity it describes.

   Values
       builtin
              a predefined type such as 'int' or 'bool'.

       enum   an enumeration type

       array  an array type

       object an object type (struct or union)

       alternate
              an alternate type

       command
              a QMP command

       event  a QMP event

   Since
       2.5

   SchemaInfo (Object)
   Members
       name: string
              the entity's name, inherited from base.  The SchemaInfo  is  always  referenced  by
              this  name.   Commands and events have the name defined in the QAPI schema.  Unlike
              command and event names, type names are not part of the  wire  ABI.   Consequently,
              type  names are meaningless strings here, although they are still guaranteed unique
              regardless of meta-type.

       meta-type: SchemaMetaType
              the entity's meta type, inherited from base.

       features: array of string (optional)
              names of features associated with the entity, in no particular order.   (since  4.1
              for object types, 4.2 for commands, 5.0 for the rest)

       The members of SchemaInfoBuiltin when meta-type is "builtin"

       The members of SchemaInfoEnum when meta-type is "enum"

       The members of SchemaInfoArray when meta-type is "array"

       The members of SchemaInfoObject when meta-type is "object"

       The members of SchemaInfoAlternate when meta-type is "alternate"

       The members of SchemaInfoCommand when meta-type is "command"

       The members of SchemaInfoEvent when meta-type is "event"
       Additional members depend on the value of meta-type.

   Since
       2.5

   SchemaInfoBuiltin (Object)
       Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'builtin'.

   Members
       json-type: JSONType
              the JSON type used for this type on the wire.

   Since
       2.5

   JSONType (Enum)
       The  four  primitive  and two structured types according to RFC 8259 section 1, plus 'int'
       (split off 'number'), plus the obvious top type 'value'.

   Values
       string Not documented

       number Not documented

       int    Not documented

       boolean
              Not documented

       null   Not documented

       object Not documented

       array  Not documented

       value  Not documented

   Since
       2.5

   SchemaInfoEnum (Object)
       Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'enum'.

   Members
       members: array of SchemaInfoEnumMember
              the enum type's members, in no particular order (since 6.2).

       values: array of string
              the enumeration type's member  names,  in  no  particular  order.   Redundant  with
              members.  Just for backward compatibility.

   Features
       deprecated
              Member values is deprecated.  Use members instead.
       Values of this type are JSON string on the wire.

   Since
       2.5

   SchemaInfoEnumMember (Object)
       An object member.

   Members
       name: string
              the member's name, as defined in the QAPI schema.

       features: array of string (optional)
              names of features associated with the member, in no particular order.

   Since
       6.2

   SchemaInfoArray (Object)
       Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'array'.

   Members
       element-type: string
              the array type's element type.
       Values of this type are JSON array on the wire.

   Since
       2.5

   SchemaInfoObject (Object)
       Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'object'.

   Members
       members: array of SchemaInfoObjectMember
              the object type's (non-variant) members, in no particular order.

       tag: string (optional)
              the  name  of the member serving as type tag.  An element of members with this name
              must exist.

       variants: array of SchemaInfoObjectVariant (optional)
              variant members, i.e. additional members that  depend  on  the  type  tag's  value.
              Present  exactly when tag is present.  The variants are in no particular order, and
              may even differ from the order of the values of the enum type of the tag.
       Values of this type are JSON object on the wire.

   Since
       2.5

   SchemaInfoObjectMember (Object)
       An object member.

   Members
       name: string
              the member's name, as defined in the QAPI schema.

       type: string
              the name of the member's type.

       default: value (optional)
              default when used as command parameter.  If absent, the parameter is mandatory.  If
              present, the value must be null.  The parameter is optional, and behavior when it's
              missing is not specified here.  Future extension:  if  present  and  non-null,  the
              parameter is optional, and defaults to this value.

       features: array of string (optional)
              names of features associated with the member, in no particular order.  (since 5.0)

   Since
       2.5

   SchemaInfoObjectVariant (Object)
       The variant members for a value of the type tag.

   Members
       case: string
              a value of the type tag.

       type: string
              the name of the object type that provides the variant members when the type tag has
              value case.

   Since
       2.5

   SchemaInfoAlternate (Object)
       Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'alternate'.

   Members
       members: array of SchemaInfoAlternateMember
              the alternate type's members, in no particular order.  The members'  wire  encoding
              is distinct, see docs/devel/qapi-code-gen.txt section Alternate types.
       On the wire, this can be any of the members.

   Since
       2.5

   SchemaInfoAlternateMember (Object)
       An alternate member.

   Members
       type: string
              the name of the member's type.

   Since
       2.5

   SchemaInfoCommand (Object)
       Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'command'.

   Members
       arg-type: string
              the name of the object type that provides the command's parameters.

       ret-type: string
              the name of the command's result type.

       allow-oob: boolean (optional)
              whether the command allows out-of-band execution, defaults to false (Since: 2.12)

   TODO
       success-response (currently irrelevant, because it's QGA, not QMP)

   Since
       2.5

   SchemaInfoEvent (Object)
       Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'event'.

   Members
       arg-type: string
              the name of the object type that provides the event's parameters.

   Since
       2.5

QEMU OBJECT MODEL (QOM)

   ObjectPropertyInfo (Object)
   Members
       name: string
              the name of the property

       type: string
              the type of the property.  This will typically come in one of four forms:

              1. A  primitive  type such as 'u8', 'u16', 'bool', 'str', or 'double'.  These types
                 are mapped to the appropriate JSON type.

              2. A child type in the form 'child<subtype>' where subtype is a  qdev  device  type
                 name.  Child properties create the composition tree.

              3. A  link  type  in  the  form 'link<subtype>' where subtype is a qdev device type
                 name.  Link properties form the device model graph.

       description: string (optional)
              if specified, the description of the property.

       default-value: value (optional)
              the default value, if any (since 5.0)

   Since
       1.2

   qom-list (Command)
       This command will list any properties of a object given a path in the object model.

   Arguments
       path: string
              the path within the object model.  See qom-get for a description of this parameter.

   Returns
       a list of ObjectPropertyInfo that describe the properties of the object.

   Since
       1.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "qom-list",
               "arguments": { "path": "/chardevs" } }
          <- { "return": [ { "name": "type", "type": "string" },
                           { "name": "parallel0", "type": "child<chardev-vc>" },
                           { "name": "serial0", "type": "child<chardev-vc>" },
                           { "name": "mon0", "type": "child<chardev-stdio>" } ] }

   qom-get (Command)
       This command will get a property from a object model path and return the value.

   Arguments
       path: string
              The path within the object model.  There are two forms of supported paths--absolute
              and partial paths.

              Absolute  paths  are  derived from the root object and can follow child<> or link<>
              properties.  Since they can follow link<> properties, they can be arbitrarily long.
              Absolute paths look like absolute filenames and are prefixed  with a leading slash.

              Partial  paths look like relative filenames.  They do not begin with a prefix.  The
              matching rules for partial paths are subtle but designed to make specifying objects
              easy.   At  each  level  of the composition tree, the partial path is matched as an
              absolute path.  The first match is not returned.  At least two matches are searched
              for.   A  successful  result  is only returned if only one match is found.  If more
              than one match is found, a flag is return to indicate that the match was ambiguous.

       property: string
              The property name to read

   Returns
       The property value.  The type depends on the property type. child<> and link<>  properties
       are returned as #str pathnames.  All integer property types (u8, u16, etc) are returned as
       #int.

   Since
       1.2

   Example
          1. Use absolute path

          -> { "execute": "qom-get",
               "arguments": { "path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]",
                              "property": "hotplugged" } }
          <- { "return": false }

          2. Use partial path

          -> { "execute": "qom-get",
               "arguments": { "path": "unattached/sysbus",
                              "property": "type" } }
          <- { "return": "System" }

   qom-set (Command)
       This command will set a property from a object model path.

   Arguments
       path: string
              see qom-get for a description of this parameter

       property: string
              the property name to set

       value: value
              a value who's type is appropriate  for  the  property  type.   See  qom-get  for  a
              description of type mapping.

   Since
       1.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "qom-set",
               "arguments": { "path": "/machine",
                              "property": "graphics",
                              "value": false } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   ObjectTypeInfo (Object)
       This structure describes a search result from qom-list-types

   Members
       name: string
              the type name found in the search

       abstract: boolean (optional)
              the  type is abstract and can't be directly instantiated.  Omitted if false. (since
              2.10)

       parent: string (optional)
              Name of parent type, if any (since 2.10)

   Since
       1.1

   qom-list-types (Command)
       This command will return a list of types given search parameters

   Arguments
       implements: string (optional)
              if specified, only return types that implement this type name

       abstract: boolean (optional)
              if true, include abstract types in the results

   Returns
       a list of ObjectTypeInfo or an empty list if no results are found

   Since
       1.1

   qom-list-properties (Command)
       List properties associated with a QOM object.

   Arguments
       typename: string
              the type name of an object

   Note
       objects can create properties at runtime, for example to describe links between  different
       devices and/or objects. These properties are not included in the output of this command.

   Returns
       a list of ObjectPropertyInfo describing object properties

   Since
       2.12

   CanHostSocketcanProperties (Object)
       Properties for can-host-socketcan objects.

   Members
       if: string
              interface name of the host system CAN bus to connect to

       canbus: string
              object ID of the can-bus object to connect to the host interface

   Since
       2.12

   ColoCompareProperties (Object)
       Properties for colo-compare objects.

   Members
       primary_in: string
              name of the character device backend to use for the primary input (incoming packets
              are redirected to outdev)

       secondary_in: string
              name of the character device backend to use for secondary input  (incoming  packets
              are only compared to the input on primary_in and then dropped)

       outdev: string
              name of the character device backend to use for output

       iothread: string
              name of the iothread to run in

       notify_dev: string (optional)
              name  of  the  character  device  backend to be used to communicate with the remote
              colo-frame (only for Xen COLO)

       compare_timeout: int (optional)
              the maximum time to hold a packet from primary_in for comparison with  an  incoming
              packet on secondary_in in milliseconds (default: 3000)

       expired_scan_cycle: int (optional)
              the  interval  at which colo-compare checks whether packets from primary have timed
              out, in milliseconds (default: 3000)

       max_queue_size: int (optional)
              the maximum number of packets to keep in the  queue  for  comparing  with  incoming
              packets  from  secondary_in.   If  the  queue  is  full  and additional packets are
              received, the additional packets are dropped. (default: 1024)

       vnet_hdr_support: boolean (optional)
              if true, vnet header support is enabled (default: false)

   Since
       2.8

   CryptodevBackendProperties (Object)
       Properties for cryptodev-backend and cryptodev-backend-builtin objects.

   Members
       queues: int (optional)
              the number of queues for the cryptodev backend. Ignored for  cryptodev-backend  and
              must be 1 for cryptodev-backend-builtin.  (default: 1)

   Since
       2.8

   CryptodevVhostUserProperties (Object)
       Properties for cryptodev-vhost-user objects.

   Members
       chardev: string
              the  name  of a Unix domain socket character device that connects to the vhost-user
              server

       The members of CryptodevBackendProperties

   Since
       2.12

   DBusVMStateProperties (Object)
       Properties for dbus-vmstate objects.

   Members
       addr: string
              the name of the DBus bus to connect to

       id-list: string (optional)
              a comma separated list of DBus IDs of helpers whose data should be included in  the
              VM state on migration

   Since
       5.0

   NetfilterInsert (Enum)
       Indicates where to insert a netfilter relative to a given other filter.

   Values
       before insert before the specified filter

       behind insert behind the specified filter

   Since
       5.0

   NetfilterProperties (Object)
       Properties for objects of classes derived from netfilter.

   Members
       netdev: string
              id of the network device backend to filter

       queue: NetFilterDirection (optional)
              indicates which queue(s) to filter (default: all)

       status: string (optional)
              indicates whether the filter is enabled ("on") or disabled ("off") (default: "on")

       position: string (optional)
              specifies where the filter should be inserted in the filter list.  "head" means the
              filter is inserted at the head of the filter list,  before  any  existing  filters.
              "tail"  means  the  filter  is  inserted at the tail of the filter list, behind any
              existing filters (default).  "id=<id>" means  the  filter  is  inserted  before  or
              behind  the  filter specified by <id>, depending on the insert property.  (default:
              "tail")

       insert: NetfilterInsert (optional)
              where to insert the filter relative to the filter given in  position.   Ignored  if
              position is "head" or "tail". (default: behind)

   Since
       2.5

   FilterBufferProperties (Object)
       Properties for filter-buffer objects.

   Members
       interval: int
              a  non-zero  interval  in microseconds.  All packets arriving in the given interval
              are delayed until the end of the interval.

       The members of NetfilterProperties

   Since
       2.5

   FilterDumpProperties (Object)
       Properties for filter-dump objects.

   Members
       file: string
              the filename where the dumped packets should be stored

       maxlen: int (optional)
              maximum number of bytes in a packet that are stored (default: 65536)

       The members of NetfilterProperties

   Since
       2.5

   FilterMirrorProperties (Object)
       Properties for filter-mirror objects.

   Members
       outdev: string
              the name of a character device backend to which all incoming packets are mirrored

       vnet_hdr_support: boolean (optional)
              if true, vnet header support is enabled (default: false)

       The members of NetfilterProperties

   Since
       2.6

   FilterRedirectorProperties (Object)
       Properties for filter-redirector objects.

       At least one of indev or outdev must be present.  If both are present, they must not refer
       to the same character device backend.

   Members
       indev: string (optional)
              the  name  of  a  character  device  backend  from  which  packets are received and
              redirected to the filtered network device

       outdev: string (optional)
              the name of a character device backend to which all incoming packets are redirected

       vnet_hdr_support: boolean (optional)
              if true, vnet header support is enabled (default: false)

       The members of NetfilterProperties

   Since
       2.6

   FilterRewriterProperties (Object)
       Properties for filter-rewriter objects.

   Members
       vnet_hdr_support: boolean (optional)
              if true, vnet header support is enabled (default: false)

       The members of NetfilterProperties

   Since
       2.8

   InputBarrierProperties (Object)
       Properties for input-barrier objects.

   Members
       name: string
              the screen name as declared in the screens section of barrier.conf

       server: string (optional)
              hostname of the Barrier server (default: "localhost")

       port: string (optional)
              TCP port of the Barrier server (default: "24800")

       x-origin: string (optional)
              x coordinate of the leftmost pixel on the guest screen (default: "0")

       y-origin: string (optional)
              y coordinate of the topmost pixel on the guest screen (default: "0")

       width: string (optional)
              the width of secondary screen in pixels (default: "1920")

       height: string (optional)
              the height of secondary screen in pixels (default: "1080")

   Since
       4.2

   InputLinuxProperties (Object)
       Properties for input-linux objects.

   Members
       evdev: string
              the path of the host evdev device to use

       grab_all: boolean (optional)
              if true, grab is toggled for all devices (e.g. both keyboard and mouse) instead  of
              just one device (default: false)

       repeat: boolean (optional)
              enables auto-repeat events (default: false)

       grab-toggle: GrabToggleKeys (optional)
              the key or key combination that toggles device grab (default: ctrl-ctrl)

   Since
       2.6

   IothreadProperties (Object)
       Properties for iothread objects.

   Members
       poll-max-ns: int (optional)
              the  maximum  number  of  nanoseconds  to busy wait for events.  0 means polling is
              disabled (default: 32768 on POSIX hosts, 0 otherwise)

       poll-grow: int (optional)
              the multiplier used to increase the polling time when the algorithm detects  it  is
              missing  events  due  to  not  polling  long  enough. 0 selects a default behaviour
              (default: 0)

       poll-shrink: int (optional)
              the divisor used to decrease the polling time when  the  algorithm  detects  it  is
              spending  too  long  polling  without  encountering  events.  0  selects  a default
              behaviour (default: 0)

       aio-max-batch: int (optional)
              maximum number of requests in a batch for the AIO engine, 0 means that  the  engine
              will use its default (default:0, since 6.1)

   Since
       2.0

   MemoryBackendProperties (Object)
       Properties for objects of classes derived from memory-backend.

   Members
       merge: boolean (optional)
              if true, mark the memory as mergeable (default depends on the machine type)

       dump: boolean (optional)
              if true, include the memory in core dumps (default depends on the machine type)

       host-nodes: array of int (optional)
              the list of NUMA host nodes to bind the memory to

       policy: HostMemPolicy (optional)
              the NUMA policy (default: 'default')

       prealloc: boolean (optional)
              if true, preallocate memory (default: false)

       prealloc-threads: int (optional)
              number of CPU threads to use for prealloc (default: 1)

       share: boolean (optional)
              if false, the memory is private to QEMU; if true, it is shared (default: false)

       reserve: boolean (optional)
              if  true,  reserve  swap space (or huge pages) if applicable (default: true) (since
              6.1)

       size: int
              size of the memory region in bytes

       x-use-canonical-path-for-ramblock-id: boolean (optional)
              if true, the canoncial path is used for ramblock-id. Disable this for  4.0  machine
              types  or  older  to  allow  migration  with  newer QEMU versions.  (default: false
              generally, but true for machine types <= 4.0)

   Note
       prealloc=true and reserve=false cannot be set at the same  time.  With  reserve=true,  the
       behavior  depends  on the operating system: for example, Linux will not reserve swap space
       for shared file mappings -- "not applicable". In contrast, reserve=false will bail out  if
       it cannot be configured accordingly.

   Since
       2.1

   MemoryBackendFileProperties (Object)
       Properties for memory-backend-file objects.

   Members
       align: int (optional)
              the  base  address  alignment  when  QEMU  mmap(2)s  mem-path.  Some backend stores
              specified by mem-path require an alignment different than the default one  used  by
              QEMU, e.g. the device DAX /dev/dax0.0 requires 2M alignment rather than 4K. In such
              cases, users can specify the required alignment  via  this  option.   0  selects  a
              default alignment (currently the page size). (default: 0)

       discard-data: boolean (optional)
              if true, the file contents can be destroyed when QEMU exits, to avoid unnecessarily
              flushing data to the backing file. Note that discard-data is only an  optimization,
              and QEMU might not discard file contents if it aborts unexpectedly or is terminated
              using SIGKILL. (default: false)

       mem-path: string
              the path to either a shared memory or huge page filesystem mount

       pmem: boolean (optional) (If: CONFIG_LIBPMEM)
              specifies whether the backing file specified by  mem-path  is  in  host  persistent
              memory  that  can  be  accessed  using  the  SNIA NVM programming model (e.g. Intel
              NVDIMM).

       readonly: boolean (optional)
              if true, the backing file is opened read-only; if false, it is  opened  read-write.
              (default: false)

       The members of MemoryBackendProperties

   Since
       2.1

   MemoryBackendMemfdProperties (Object)
       Properties for memory-backend-memfd objects.

       The share boolean option is true by default with memfd.

   Members
       hugetlb: boolean (optional)
              if  true,  the  file  to  be  created resides in the hugetlbfs filesystem (default:
              false)

       hugetlbsize: int (optional)
              the hugetlb page size on systems that support multiple hugetlb page sizes (it  must
              be a power of 2 value supported by the system). 0 selects a default page size. This
              option is ignored if hugetlb is false. (default: 0)

       seal: boolean (optional)
              if true, create a sealed-file, which will block  further  resizing  of  the  memory
              (default: true)

       The members of MemoryBackendProperties

   Since
       2.12

   MemoryBackendEpcProperties (Object)
       Properties for memory-backend-epc objects.

       The share boolean option is true by default with epc

       The merge boolean option is false by default with epc

       The dump boolean option is false by default with epc

   Members
       The members of MemoryBackendProperties

   Since
       6.2

   PrManagerHelperProperties (Object)
       Properties for pr-manager-helper objects.

   Members
       path: string
              the path to a Unix domain socket for connecting to the external helper

   Since
       2.11

   QtestProperties (Object)
       Properties for qtest objects.

   Members
       chardev: string
              the chardev to be used to receive qtest commands on.

       log: string (optional)
              the path to a log file

   Since
       6.0

   RemoteObjectProperties (Object)
       Properties for x-remote-object objects.

   Members
       fd: string
              file descriptor name previously passed via 'getfd' command

       devid: string
              the id of the device to be associated with the file descriptor

   Since
       6.0

   RngProperties (Object)
       Properties for objects of classes derived from rng.

   Members
       opened: boolean (optional)
              if  true,  the  device  is  opened  immediately  when applying this option and will
              probably fail when processing  the  next  option.  Don't  use;  only  provided  for
              compatibility. (default: false)

   Features
       deprecated
              Member opened is deprecated.  Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already
              the default.

   Since
       1.3

   RngEgdProperties (Object)
       Properties for rng-egd objects.

   Members
       chardev: string
              the name of a character device backend that provides  the  connection  to  the  RNG
              daemon

       The members of RngProperties

   Since
       1.3

   RngRandomProperties (Object)
       Properties for rng-random objects.

   Members
       filename: string (optional)
              the  filename  of  the  device  on  the  host  to  obtain  entropy  from  (default:
              "/dev/urandom")

       The members of RngProperties

   Since
       1.3

   SevGuestProperties (Object)
       Properties for sev-guest objects.

   Members
       sev-device: string (optional)
              SEV device to use (default: "/dev/sev")

       dh-cert-file: string (optional)
              guest owners DH certificate (encoded with base64)

       session-file: string (optional)
              guest owners session parameters (encoded with base64)

       policy: int (optional)
              SEV policy value (default: 0x1)

       handle: int (optional)
              SEV firmware handle (default: 0)

       cbitpos: int (optional)
              C-bit location in page table entry (default: 0)

       reduced-phys-bits: int
              number of bits in physical addresses that become unavailable when SEV is enabled

       kernel-hashes: boolean (optional)
              if true, add hashes of kernel/initrd/cmdline to a designated  guest  firmware  page
              for measured boot with -kernel (default: false) (since 6.2)

   Since
       2.12

   ObjectType (Enum)
   Values
       authz-list
              Not documented

       authz-listfile
              Not documented

       authz-pam
              Not documented

       authz-simple
              Not documented

       can-bus
              Not documented

       can-host-socketcan (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
              Not documented

       colo-compare
              Not documented

       cryptodev-backend
              Not documented

       cryptodev-backend-builtin
              Not documented

       cryptodev-vhost-user (If: CONFIG_VHOST_CRYPTO)
              Not documented

       dbus-vmstate
              Not documented

       filter-buffer
              Not documented

       filter-dump
              Not documented

       filter-mirror
              Not documented

       filter-redirector
              Not documented

       filter-replay
              Not documented

       filter-rewriter
              Not documented

       input-barrier
              Not documented

       input-linux (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
              Not documented

       iothread
              Not documented

       memory-backend-epc (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
              Not documented

       memory-backend-file
              Not documented

       memory-backend-memfd (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
              Not documented

       memory-backend-ram
              Not documented

       pef-guest
              Not documented

       pr-manager-helper (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
              Not documented

       qtest  Not documented

       rng-builtin
              Not documented

       rng-egd
              Not documented

       rng-random (If: CONFIG_POSIX)
              Not documented

       secret Not documented

       secret_keyring (If: CONFIG_SECRET_KEYRING)
              Not documented

       sev-guest
              Not documented

       s390-pv-guest
              Not documented

       throttle-group
              Not documented

       tls-creds-anon
              Not documented

       tls-creds-psk
              Not documented

       tls-creds-x509
              Not documented

       tls-cipher-suites
              Not documented

       x-remote-object
              Not documented

   Features
       unstable
              Member x-remote-object is experimental.

   Since
       6.0

   ObjectOptions (Object)
       Describes the options of a user creatable QOM object.

   Members
       qom-type: ObjectType
              the class name for the object to be created

       id: string
              the name of the new object

       The members of AuthZListProperties when qom-type is "authz-list"

       The members of AuthZListFileProperties when qom-type is "authz-listfile"

       The members of AuthZPAMProperties when qom-type is "authz-pam"

       The members of AuthZSimpleProperties when qom-type is "authz-simple"

       The  members  of  CanHostSocketcanProperties  when  qom-type  is "can-host-socketcan" (If:
       CONFIG_LINUX)

       The members of ColoCompareProperties when qom-type is "colo-compare"

       The members of CryptodevBackendProperties when qom-type is "cryptodev-backend"

       The members of CryptodevBackendProperties when qom-type is "cryptodev-backend-builtin"

       The members of CryptodevVhostUserProperties when qom-type is  "cryptodev-vhost-user"  (If:
       CONFIG_VHOST_CRYPTO)

       The members of DBusVMStateProperties when qom-type is "dbus-vmstate"

       The members of FilterBufferProperties when qom-type is "filter-buffer"

       The members of FilterDumpProperties when qom-type is "filter-dump"

       The members of FilterMirrorProperties when qom-type is "filter-mirror"

       The members of FilterRedirectorProperties when qom-type is "filter-redirector"

       The members of NetfilterProperties when qom-type is "filter-replay"

       The members of FilterRewriterProperties when qom-type is "filter-rewriter"

       The members of InputBarrierProperties when qom-type is "input-barrier"

       The members of InputLinuxProperties when qom-type is "input-linux" (If: CONFIG_LINUX)

       The members of IothreadProperties when qom-type is "iothread"

       The  members  of  MemoryBackendEpcProperties  when  qom-type  is "memory-backend-epc" (If:
       CONFIG_LINUX)

       The members of MemoryBackendFileProperties when qom-type is "memory-backend-file"

       The members of MemoryBackendMemfdProperties when qom-type is  "memory-backend-memfd"  (If:
       CONFIG_LINUX)

       The members of MemoryBackendProperties when qom-type is "memory-backend-ram"

       The  members  of  PrManagerHelperProperties  when  qom-type  is  "pr-manager-helper"  (If:
       CONFIG_LINUX)

       The members of QtestProperties when qom-type is "qtest"

       The members of RngProperties when qom-type is "rng-builtin"

       The members of RngEgdProperties when qom-type is "rng-egd"

       The members of RngRandomProperties when qom-type is "rng-random" (If: CONFIG_POSIX)

       The members of SecretProperties when qom-type is "secret"

       The  members  of  SecretKeyringProperties   when   qom-type   is   "secret_keyring"   (If:
       CONFIG_SECRET_KEYRING)

       The members of SevGuestProperties when qom-type is "sev-guest"

       The members of ThrottleGroupProperties when qom-type is "throttle-group"

       The members of TlsCredsAnonProperties when qom-type is "tls-creds-anon"

       The members of TlsCredsPskProperties when qom-type is "tls-creds-psk"

       The members of TlsCredsX509Properties when qom-type is "tls-creds-x509"

       The members of TlsCredsProperties when qom-type is "tls-cipher-suites"

       The members of RemoteObjectProperties when qom-type is "x-remote-object"

   Since
       6.0

   object-add (Command)
       Create a QOM object.

   Arguments
       The members of ObjectOptions

   Returns
       Nothing on success Error if qom-type is not a valid class name

   Since
       2.0

   Example
          -> { "execute": "object-add",
               "arguments": { "qom-type": "rng-random", "id": "rng1",
                              "filename": "/dev/hwrng" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   object-del (Command)
       Remove a QOM object.

   Arguments
       id: string
              the name of the QOM object to remove

   Returns
       Nothing on success Error if id is not a valid id for a QOM object

   Since
       2.0

   Example
          -> { "execute": "object-del", "arguments": { "id": "rng1" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

DEVICE INFRASTRUCTURE (QDEV)

   device-list-properties (Command)
       List properties associated with a device.

   Arguments
       typename: string
              the type name of a device

   Returns
       a list of ObjectPropertyInfo describing a devices properties

   Note
       objects  can create properties at runtime, for example to describe links between different
       devices and/or objects. These properties are not included in the output of this command.

   Since
       1.2

   device_add (Command)
       Add a device.

   Arguments
       driver: string
              the name of the new device's driver

       bus: string (optional)
              the device's parent bus (device tree path)

       id: string (optional)
              the device's ID, must be unique

   Features
       json-cli
              If present, the "-device" command line option supports JSON syntax with a structure
              identical to the arguments of this command.

   Notes
       Additional arguments depend on the type.

       1. For    detailed    information    about    this    command,   please   refer   to   the
          'docs/qdev-device-use.txt' file.

       2. It's possible to list device properties by running QEMU with the "-device  DEVICE,help"
          command-line argument, where DEVICE is the device's name

   Example
          -> { "execute": "device_add",
               "arguments": { "driver": "e1000", "id": "net1",
                              "bus": "pci.0",
                              "mac": "52:54:00:12:34:56" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   TODO
       This  command  effectively  bypasses  QAPI  completely  due  to its "additional arguments"
       business.  It shouldn't have been added to the schema in this form.  It should be qapified
       properly, or replaced by a properly qapified command.

   Since
       0.13

   device_del (Command)
       Remove a device from a guest

   Arguments
       id: string
              the device's ID or QOM path

   Returns
       Nothing on success If id is not a valid device, DeviceNotFound

   Notes
       When this command completes, the device may not be removed from the guest.  Hot removal is
       an operation that requires guest cooperation.  This command merely requests that the guest
       begin  the hot removal process.  Completion of the device removal process is signaled with
       a DEVICE_DELETED event. Guest reset will automatically complete removal for  all  devices.
       If  a  guest-side  error  in  the  hot removal process is detected, the device will not be
       removed and a DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR event is sent.  Some errors cannot be detected.

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "device_del",
               "arguments": { "id": "net1" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

          -> { "execute": "device_del",
               "arguments": { "id": "/machine/peripheral-anon/device[0]" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   DEVICE_DELETED (Event)
       Emitted whenever the device removal completion is acknowledged  by  the  guest.   At  this
       point,  it's safe to reuse the specified device ID. Device removal can be initiated by the
       guest or by HMP/QMP commands.

   Arguments
       device: string (optional)
              the device's ID if it has one

       path: string
              the device's QOM path

   Since
       1.5

   Example
          <- { "event": "DEVICE_DELETED",
               "data": { "device": "virtio-net-pci-0",
                         "path": "/machine/peripheral/virtio-net-pci-0" },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

   DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR (Event)
       Emitted when a device hot unplug fails due to a guest reported error.

   Arguments
       device: string (optional)
              the device's ID if it has one

       path: string
              the device's QOM path

   Since
       6.2

   Example
          <- { "event": "DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR"
               "data": { "device": "core1",
                         "path": "/machine/peripheral/core1" },
               },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1615570772, "microseconds": 202844 } }

MACHINES

   SysEmuTarget (Enum)
       The  comprehensive  enumeration  of  QEMU  system  emulation  ("softmmu")   targets.   Run
       "./configure  --help"  in  the  project root directory, and look for the *-softmmu targets
       near the "--target-list" option. The individual target constants are not documented  here,
       for the time being.

   Values
       rx     since 5.0

       avr    since 5.1

       aarch64
              Not documented

       alpha  Not documented

       arm    Not documented

       cris   Not documented

       hppa   Not documented

       i386   Not documented

       m68k   Not documented

       microblaze
              Not documented

       microblazeel
              Not documented

       mips   Not documented

       mips64 Not documented

       mips64el
              Not documented

       mipsel Not documented

       nios2  Not documented

       or1k   Not documented

       ppc    Not documented

       ppc64  Not documented

       riscv32
              Not documented

       riscv64
              Not documented

       s390x  Not documented

       sh4    Not documented

       sh4eb  Not documented

       sparc  Not documented

       sparc64
              Not documented

       tricore
              Not documented

       x86_64 Not documented

       xtensa Not documented

       xtensaeb
              Not documented

   Notes
       The  resulting  QMP  strings  can  be appended to the "qemu-system-" prefix to produce the
       corresponding QEMU executable name. This is true even for "qemu-system-x86_64".

   Since
       3.0

   CpuS390State (Enum)
       An enumeration of cpu states that can be assumed by a virtual S390 CPU

   Values
       uninitialized
              Not documented

       stopped
              Not documented

       check-stop
              Not documented

       operating
              Not documented

       load   Not documented

   Since
       2.12

   CpuInfoS390 (Object)
       Additional information about a virtual S390 CPU

   Members
       cpu-state: CpuS390State
              the virtual CPU's state

   Since
       2.12

   CpuInfoFast (Object)
       Information about a virtual CPU

   Members
       cpu-index: int
              index of the virtual CPU

       qom-path: string
              path to the CPU object in the QOM tree

       thread-id: int
              ID of the underlying host thread

       props: CpuInstanceProperties (optional)
              properties describing to which  node/socket/core/thread  virtual  CPU  belongs  to,
              provided if supported by board

       target: SysEmuTarget
              the  QEMU system emulation target, which determines which additional fields will be
              listed (since 3.0)

       The members of CpuInfoS390 when target is "s390x"

   Since
       2.12

   query-cpus-fast (Command)
       Returns information about all virtual CPUs.

   Returns
       list of CpuInfoFast

   Since
       2.12

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-cpus-fast" }
          <- { "return": [
                  {
                      "thread-id": 25627,
                      "props": {
                          "core-id": 0,
                          "thread-id": 0,
                          "socket-id": 0
                      },
                      "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]",
                      "arch":"x86",
                      "target":"x86_64",
                      "cpu-index": 0
                  },
                  {
                      "thread-id": 25628,
                      "props": {
                          "core-id": 0,
                          "thread-id": 0,
                          "socket-id": 1
                      },
                      "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[2]",
                      "arch":"x86",
                      "target":"x86_64",
                      "cpu-index": 1
                  }
              ]
          }

   MachineInfo (Object)
       Information describing a machine.

   Members
       name: string
              the name of the machine

       alias: string (optional)
              an alias for the machine name

       is-default: boolean (optional)
              whether the machine is default

       cpu-max: int
              maximum number of CPUs supported by the machine type (since 1.5)

       hotpluggable-cpus: boolean
              cpu hotplug via -device is supported (since 2.7)

       numa-mem-supported: boolean
              true if '-numa node,mem'  option  is  supported  by  the  machine  type  and  false
              otherwise (since 4.1)

       deprecated: boolean
              if  true,  the  machine type is deprecated and may be removed in future versions of
              QEMU according to the QEMU deprecation policy (since 4.1)

       default-cpu-type: string (optional)
              default CPU model typename if none is requested via the -cpu argument. (since 4.2)

       default-ram-id: string (optional)
              the default ID of initial RAM memory backend (since 5.2)

   Since
       1.2

   query-machines (Command)
       Return a list of supported machines

   Returns
       a list of MachineInfo

   Since
       1.2

   CurrentMachineParams (Object)
       Information describing the running machine parameters.

   Members
       wakeup-suspend-support: boolean
              true if the machine supports wake up from suspend

   Since
       4.0

   query-current-machine (Command)
       Return information on the current virtual machine.

   Returns
       CurrentMachineParams

   Since
       4.0

   TargetInfo (Object)
       Information describing the QEMU target.

   Members
       arch: SysEmuTarget
              the target architecture

   Since
       1.2

   query-target (Command)
       Return information about the target for this QEMU

   Returns
       TargetInfo

   Since
       1.2

   UuidInfo (Object)
       Guest UUID information (Universally Unique Identifier).

   Members
       UUID: string
              the UUID of the guest

   Since
       0.14

   Notes
       If no UUID was specified for the guest, a null UUID is returned.

   query-uuid (Command)
       Query the guest UUID information.

   Returns
       The UuidInfo for the guest

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-uuid" }
          <- { "return": { "UUID": "550e8400-e29b-41d4-a716-446655440000" } }

   GuidInfo (Object)
       GUID information.

   Members
       guid: string
              the globally unique identifier

   Since
       2.9

   query-vm-generation-id (Command)
       Show Virtual Machine Generation ID

   Since
       2.9

   system_reset (Command)
       Performs a hard reset of a guest.

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "system_reset" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   system_powerdown (Command)
       Requests that a guest perform a powerdown operation.

   Since
       0.14

   Notes
       A guest may or may not respond to this command.  This command returning does not  indicate
       that  a guest has accepted the request or that it has shut down.  Many guests will respond
       to this command by prompting the user in some way.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "system_powerdown" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   system_wakeup (Command)
       Wake up guest from suspend.  If  the  guest  has  wake-up  from  suspend  support  enabled
       (wakeup-suspend-support  flag  from  query-current-machine), wake-up guest from suspend if
       the guest is in SUSPENDED state. Return an error otherwise.

   Since
       1.1

   Returns
       nothing.

   Note
       prior to 4.0, this command does nothing in case the guest isn't suspended.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "system_wakeup" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   LostTickPolicy (Enum)
       Policy for handling lost ticks in timer devices.  Ticks end  up  getting  lost  when,  for
       example, the guest is paused.

   Values
       discard
              throw away the missed ticks and continue with future injection normally.  The guest
              OS will see the timer jump ahead by a potentially quite significant amount  all  at
              once,  as if the intervening chunk of time had simply not existed; needless to say,
              such a sudden jump can easily confuse a guest OS which is not specifically prepared
              to  deal with it.  Assuming the guest OS can deal correctly with the time jump, the
              time in the guest and in the host should now match.

       delay  continue to deliver ticks at the  normal  rate.   The  guest  OS  will  not  notice
              anything  is  amiss,  as  from  its  point of view time will have continued to flow
              normally.  The time in the guest should now be behind  the  time  in  the  host  by
              exactly the amount of time during which ticks have been missed.

       slew   deliver  ticks  at  a  higher rate to catch up with the missed ticks.  The guest OS
              will not notice anything is amiss, as  from  its  point  of  view  time  will  have
              continued  to  flow  normally.  Once the timer has managed to catch up with all the
              missing ticks, the time in the guest and in the host should match.

   Since
       2.0

   inject-nmi (Command)
       Injects a Non-Maskable Interrupt into the default CPU (x86/s390) or all CPUs (ppc64).  The
       command fails when the guest doesn't support injecting.

   Returns
       If successful, nothing

   Since
       0.14

   Note
       prior to 2.1, this command was only supported for x86 and s390 VMs

   Example
          -> { "execute": "inject-nmi" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   KvmInfo (Object)
       Information about support for KVM acceleration

   Members
       enabled: boolean
              true if KVM acceleration is active

       present: boolean
              true if KVM acceleration is built into this executable

   Since
       0.14

   query-kvm (Command)
       Returns information about KVM acceleration

   Returns
       KvmInfo

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-kvm" }
          <- { "return": { "enabled": true, "present": true } }

   NumaOptionsType (Enum)
   Values
       node   NUMA nodes configuration

       dist   NUMA distance configuration (since 2.10)

       cpu    property based CPU(s) to node mapping (Since: 2.10)

       hmat-lb
              memory latency and bandwidth information (Since: 5.0)

       hmat-cache
              memory side cache information (Since: 5.0)

   Since
       2.1

   NumaOptions (Object)
       A discriminated record of NUMA options. (for OptsVisitor)

   Members
       type: NumaOptionsType
              Not documented

       The members of NumaNodeOptions when type is "node"

       The members of NumaDistOptions when type is "dist"

       The members of NumaCpuOptions when type is "cpu"

       The members of NumaHmatLBOptions when type is "hmat-lb"

       The members of NumaHmatCacheOptions when type is "hmat-cache"

   Since
       2.1

   NumaNodeOptions (Object)
       Create a guest NUMA node. (for OptsVisitor)

   Members
       nodeid: int (optional)
              NUMA node ID (increase by 1 from 0 if omitted)

       cpus: array of int (optional)

              VCPUs belonging to this node (assign VCPUS round-robin
                     if omitted)

       mem: int (optional)
              memory  size  of  this  node; mutually exclusive with memdev.  Equally divide total
              memory among nodes if both mem and memdev are omitted.

       memdev: string (optional)
              memory backend object.  If specified for one node, it must  be  specified  for  all
              nodes.

       initiator: int (optional)
              defined  in  ACPI  6.3 Chapter 5.2.27.3 Table 5-145, points to the nodeid which has
              the  memory  controller  responsible  for  this  NUMA  node.  This  field  provides
              additional  information  as  to  the initiator node that is closest (as in directly
              attached) to this node, and therefore has the best performance (since 5.0)

   Since
       2.1

   NumaDistOptions (Object)
       Set the distance between 2 NUMA nodes.

   Members
       src: int
              source NUMA node.

       dst: int
              destination NUMA node.

       val: int
              NUMA distance from source node to destination node.  When  a  node  is  unreachable
              from another node, set the distance between them to 255.

   Since
       2.10

   X86CPURegister32 (Enum)
       A X86 32-bit register

   Values
       EAX    Not documented

       EBX    Not documented

       ECX    Not documented

       EDX    Not documented

       ESP    Not documented

       EBP    Not documented

       ESI    Not documented

       EDI    Not documented

   Since
       1.5

   X86CPUFeatureWordInfo (Object)
       Information about a X86 CPU feature word

   Members
       cpuid-input-eax: int
              Input EAX value for CPUID instruction for that feature word

       cpuid-input-ecx: int (optional)
              Input ECX value for CPUID instruction for that feature word

       cpuid-register: X86CPURegister32
              Output register containing the feature bits

       features: int
              value of output register, containing the feature bits

   Since
       1.5

   DummyForceArrays (Object)
       Not used by QMP; hack to let us use X86CPUFeatureWordInfoList internally

   Members
       unused: array of X86CPUFeatureWordInfo
              Not documented

   Since
       2.5

   NumaCpuOptions (Object)
       Option  "-numa cpu" overrides default cpu to node mapping.  It accepts the same set of cpu
       properties as returned by query-hotpluggable-cpus[].props, where node-id could be used  to
       override default node mapping.

   Members
       The members of CpuInstanceProperties

   Since
       2.10

   HmatLBMemoryHierarchy (Enum)
       The memory hierarchy in the System Locality Latency and Bandwidth Information Structure of
       HMAT (Heterogeneous Memory Attribute Table)

       For more information about HmatLBMemoryHierarchy, see chapter 5.2.27.4: Table 5-146: Field
       "Flags" of ACPI 6.3 spec.

   Values
       memory the structure represents the memory performance

       first-level
              first level of memory side cache

       second-level
              second level of memory side cache

       third-level
              third level of memory side cache

   Since
       5.0

   HmatLBDataType (Enum)
       Data  type  in  the  System  Locality  Latency and Bandwidth Information Structure of HMAT
       (Heterogeneous Memory Attribute Table)

       For more information about HmatLBDataType, see chapter 5.2.27.4: Table 5-146:  Field "Data
       Type" of ACPI 6.3 spec.

   Values
       access-latency
              access latency (nanoseconds)

       read-latency
              read latency (nanoseconds)

       write-latency
              write latency (nanoseconds)

       access-bandwidth
              access bandwidth (Bytes per second)

       read-bandwidth
              read bandwidth (Bytes per second)

       write-bandwidth
              write bandwidth (Bytes per second)

   Since
       5.0

   NumaHmatLBOptions (Object)
       Set  the  system  locality  latency and bandwidth information between Initiator and Target
       proximity Domains.

       For more information about NumaHmatLBOptions, see chapter 5.2.27.4: Table  5-146  of  ACPI
       6.3 spec.

   Members
       initiator: int
              the Initiator Proximity Domain.

       target: int
              the Target Proximity Domain.

       hierarchy: HmatLBMemoryHierarchy
              the Memory Hierarchy. Indicates the performance of memory or side cache.

       data-type: HmatLBDataType
              presents the type of data, access/read/write latency or hit latency.

       latency: int (optional)
              the value of latency from initiator to target proximity domain, the latency unit is
              "ns(nanosecond)".

       bandwidth: int (optional)
              the value of bandwidth between initiator and target proximity domain, the bandwidth
              unit is "Bytes per second".

   Since
       5.0

   HmatCacheAssociativity (Enum)
       Cache associativity in the Memory Side Cache Information Structure of HMAT

       For  more information of HmatCacheAssociativity, see chapter 5.2.27.5: Table 5-147 of ACPI
       6.3 spec.

   Values
       none

              None (no memory side cache in this proximity domain,
                     or cache associativity unknown)

       direct Direct Mapped

       complex
              Complex Cache Indexing (implementation specific)

   Since
       5.0

   HmatCacheWritePolicy (Enum)
       Cache write policy in the Memory Side Cache Information Structure of HMAT

       For more information of HmatCacheWritePolicy, see chapter  5.2.27.5:  Table  5-147:  Field
       "Cache Attributes" of ACPI 6.3 spec.

   Values
       none   None (no memory side cache in this proximity domain, or cache write policy unknown)

       write-back
              Write Back (WB)

       write-through
              Write Through (WT)

   Since
       5.0

   NumaHmatCacheOptions (Object)
       Set the memory side cache information for a given memory domain.

       For  more  information  of  NumaHmatCacheOptions, see chapter 5.2.27.5: Table 5-147: Field
       "Cache Attributes" of ACPI 6.3 spec.

   Members
       node-id: int
              the memory proximity domain to which the memory belongs.

       size: int
              the size of memory side cache in bytes.

       level: int
              the cache level described in this structure.

       associativity: HmatCacheAssociativity
              the cache associativity, none/direct-mapped/complex(complex cache indexing).

       policy: HmatCacheWritePolicy
              the write policy, none/write-back/write-through.

       line: int
              the cache Line size in bytes.

   Since
       5.0

   memsave (Command)
       Save a portion of guest memory to a file.

   Arguments
       val: int
              the virtual address of the guest to start from

       size: int
              the size of memory region to save

       filename: string
              the file to save the memory to as binary data

       cpu-index: int (optional)
              the index of the virtual CPU to use for translating the virtual  address  (defaults
              to CPU 0)

   Returns
       Nothing on success

   Since
       0.14

   Notes
       Errors were not reliably returned until 1.1

   Example
          -> { "execute": "memsave",
               "arguments": { "val": 10,
                              "size": 100,
                              "filename": "/tmp/virtual-mem-dump" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   pmemsave (Command)
       Save a portion of guest physical memory to a file.

   Arguments
       val: int
              the physical address of the guest to start from

       size: int
              the size of memory region to save

       filename: string
              the file to save the memory to as binary data

   Returns
       Nothing on success

   Since
       0.14

   Notes
       Errors were not reliably returned until 1.1

   Example
          -> { "execute": "pmemsave",
               "arguments": { "val": 10,
                              "size": 100,
                              "filename": "/tmp/physical-mem-dump" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   Memdev (Object)
       Information about memory backend

   Members
       id: string (optional)
              backend's ID if backend has 'id' property (since 2.9)

       size: int
              memory backend size

       merge: boolean
              whether memory merge support is enabled

       dump: boolean
              whether memory backend's memory is included in a core dump

       prealloc: boolean
              whether memory was preallocated

       share: boolean
              whether memory is private to QEMU or shared (since 6.1)

       reserve: boolean (optional)
              whether swap space (or huge pages) was reserved if applicable.  This corresponds to
              the user configuration and not the actual behavior implemented in the OS to perform
              the  reservation.  For example, Linux will never reserve swap space for shared file
              mappings. (since 6.1)

       host-nodes: array of int
              host nodes for its memory policy

       policy: HostMemPolicy
              memory policy of memory backend

   Since
       2.1

   query-memdev (Command)
       Returns information for all memory backends.

   Returns
       a list of Memdev.

   Since
       2.1

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-memdev" }
          <- { "return": [
                 {
                   "id": "mem1",
                   "size": 536870912,
                   "merge": false,
                   "dump": true,
                   "prealloc": false,
                   "host-nodes": [0, 1],
                   "policy": "bind"
                 },
                 {
                   "size": 536870912,
                   "merge": false,
                   "dump": true,
                   "prealloc": true,
                   "host-nodes": [2, 3],
                   "policy": "preferred"
                 }
               ]
             }

   CpuInstanceProperties (Object)
       List of properties to be used for hotplugging a CPU  instance,  it  should  be  passed  by
       management with device_add command when a CPU is being hotplugged.

   Members
       node-id: int (optional)
              NUMA node ID the CPU belongs to

       socket-id: int (optional)
              socket number within node/board the CPU belongs to

       die-id: int (optional)
              die number within node/board the CPU belongs to (Since 4.1)

       core-id: int (optional)
              core number within die the CPU belongs to

       thread-id: int (optional)
              thread number within core the CPU belongs to

   Note
       currently  there  are 5 properties that could be present but management should be prepared
       to pass through other properties with device_add command to  allow  for  future  interface
       extension.  This  also  requires  the  filed  names to be kept in sync with the properties
       passed to -device/device_add.

   Since
       2.7

   HotpluggableCPU (Object)
   Members
       type: string
              CPU object type for usage with device_add command

       props: CpuInstanceProperties
              list of properties to be used for hotplugging CPU

       vcpus-count: int
              number of logical VCPU threads HotpluggableCPU provides

       qom-path: string (optional)
              link to existing CPU object if CPU is present or omitted if CPU is not present.

   Since
       2.7

   query-hotpluggable-cpus (Command)
   TODO
       Better documentation; currently there is none.

   Returns
       a list of HotpluggableCPU objects.

   Since
       2.7

   Example
          For pseries machine type started with -smp 2,cores=2,maxcpus=4 -cpu POWER8:

          -> { "execute": "query-hotpluggable-cpus" }
          <- {"return": [
               { "props": { "core": 8 }, "type": "POWER8-spapr-cpu-core",
                 "vcpus-count": 1 },
               { "props": { "core": 0 }, "type": "POWER8-spapr-cpu-core",
                 "vcpus-count": 1, "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]"}
             ]}'

          For pc machine type started with -smp 1,maxcpus=2:

          -> { "execute": "query-hotpluggable-cpus" }
          <- {"return": [
               {
                  "type": "qemu64-x86_64-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1,
                  "props": {"core-id": 0, "socket-id": 1, "thread-id": 0}
               },
               {
                  "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]",
                  "type": "qemu64-x86_64-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1,
                  "props": {"core-id": 0, "socket-id": 0, "thread-id": 0}
               }
             ]}

          For s390x-virtio-ccw machine type started with -smp 1,maxcpus=2 -cpu qemu
          (Since: 2.11):

          -> { "execute": "query-hotpluggable-cpus" }
          <- {"return": [
               {
                  "type": "qemu-s390x-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1,
                  "props": { "core-id": 1 }
               },
               {
                  "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]",
                  "type": "qemu-s390x-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1,
                  "props": { "core-id": 0 }
               }
             ]}

   set-numa-node (Command)
       Runtime equivalent of '-numa' CLI option, available at  preconfigure  stage  to  configure
       numa mapping before initializing machine.

       Since 3.0

   Arguments
       The members of NumaOptions

   balloon (Command)
       Request the balloon driver to change its balloon size.

   Arguments
       value: int
              the  target logical size of the VM in bytes.  We can deduce the size of the balloon
              using this formula:
                 logical_vm_size = vm_ram_size - balloon_size

              From it we have: balloon_size = vm_ram_size - value

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If the balloon driver is enabled but not functional because the KVM kernel module cannot
         support it, KvmMissingCap

       • If no balloon device is present, DeviceNotActive

   Notes
       This  command  just  issues a request to the guest.  When it returns, the balloon size may
       not have changed.  A guest can change the balloon size independent of this command.

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "balloon", "arguments": { "value": 536870912 } }
          <- { "return": {} }

          With a 2.5GiB guest this command inflated the ballon to 3GiB.

   BalloonInfo (Object)
       Information about the guest balloon device.

   Members
       actual: int
              the logical size of the VM in bytes Formula used: logical_vm_size =  vm_ram_size  -
              balloon_size

   Since
       0.14

   query-balloon (Command)
       Return information about the balloon device.

   ReturnsBalloonInfo on success

       • If the balloon driver is enabled but not functional because the KVM kernel module cannot
         support it, KvmMissingCap

       • If no balloon device is present, DeviceNotActive

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-balloon" }
          <- { "return": {
                   "actual": 1073741824,
                }
             }

   BALLOON_CHANGE (Event)
       Emitted when the guest changes the actual BALLOON level. This value is equivalent  to  the
       actual field return by the 'query-balloon' command

   Arguments
       actual: int
              the  logical  size of the VM in bytes Formula used: logical_vm_size = vm_ram_size -
              balloon_size

   Note
       this event is rate-limited.

   Since
       1.2

   Example
          <- { "event": "BALLOON_CHANGE",
               "data": { "actual": 944766976 },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267020223, "microseconds": 435656 } }

   MemoryInfo (Object)
       Actual memory information in bytes.

   Members
       base-memory: int
              size of "base" memory specified with command line option -m.

       plugged-memory: int (optional)
              size of memory that can be hot-unplugged. This field is omitted if  target  doesn't
              support memory hotplug (i.e. CONFIG_MEM_DEVICE not defined at build time).

   Since
       2.11

   query-memory-size-summary (Command)
       Return  the  amount of initially allocated and present hotpluggable (if enabled) memory in
       bytes.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-memory-size-summary" }
          <- { "return": { "base-memory": 4294967296, "plugged-memory": 0 } }

   Since
       2.11

   PCDIMMDeviceInfo (Object)
       PCDIMMDevice state information

   Members
       id: string (optional)
              device's ID

       addr: int
              physical address, where device is mapped

       size: int
              size of memory that the device provides

       slot: int
              slot number at which device is plugged in

       node: int
              NUMA node number where device is plugged in

       memdev: string
              memory backend linked with device

       hotplugged: boolean
              true if device was hotplugged

       hotpluggable: boolean
              true if device if could be added/removed while machine is running

   Since
       2.1

   VirtioPMEMDeviceInfo (Object)
       VirtioPMEM state information

   Members
       id: string (optional)
              device's ID

       memaddr: int
              physical address in memory, where device is mapped

       size: int
              size of memory that the device provides

       memdev: string
              memory backend linked with device

   Since
       4.1

   VirtioMEMDeviceInfo (Object)
       VirtioMEMDevice state information

   Members
       id: string (optional)
              device's ID

       memaddr: int
              physical address in memory, where device is mapped

       requested-size: int
              the user requested size of the device

       size: int
              the (current) size of memory that the device provides

       max-size: int
              the maximum size of memory that the device can provide

       block-size: int
              the block size of memory that the device provides

       node: int
              NUMA node number where device is assigned to

       memdev: string
              memory backend linked with the region

   Since
       5.1

   SgxEPCDeviceInfo (Object)
       Sgx EPC state information

   Members
       id: string (optional)
              device's ID

       memaddr: int
              physical address in memory, where device is mapped

       size: int
              size of memory that the device provides

       memdev: string
              memory backend linked with device

   Since
       6.2

   MemoryDeviceInfoKind (Enum)
   Values
       dimm   Not documented

       nvdimm Not documented

       virtio-pmem
              Not documented

       virtio-mem
              Not documented

       sgx-epc
              Not documented

   Since
       2.1

   PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: PCDIMMDeviceInfo
              Not documented

   Since
       2.1

   VirtioPMEMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: VirtioPMEMDeviceInfo
              Not documented

   Since
       2.1

   VirtioMEMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: VirtioMEMDeviceInfo
              Not documented

   Since
       2.1

   SgxEPCDeviceInfoWrapper (Object)
   Members
       data: SgxEPCDeviceInfo
              Not documented

   Since
       6.2

   MemoryDeviceInfo (Object)
       Union containing information about a memory device

       nvdimm is included since 2.12. virtio-pmem is included since 4.1.  virtio-mem is  included
       since 5.1. sgx-epc is included since 6.2.

   Members
       type: MemoryDeviceInfoKind
              Not documented

       The members of PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper when type is "dimm"

       The members of PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper when type is "nvdimm"

       The members of VirtioPMEMDeviceInfoWrapper when type is "virtio-pmem"

       The members of VirtioMEMDeviceInfoWrapper when type is "virtio-mem"

       The members of SgxEPCDeviceInfoWrapper when type is "sgx-epc"

   Since
       2.1

   SgxEPC (Object)
       Sgx EPC cmdline information

   Members
       memdev: string
              memory backend linked with device

   Since
       6.2

   SgxEPCProperties (Object)
       SGX properties of machine types.

   Members
       sgx-epc: array of SgxEPC
              list of ids of memory-backend-epc objects.

   Since
       6.2

   query-memory-devices (Command)
       Lists available memory devices and their state

   Since
       2.1

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-memory-devices" }
          <- { "return": [ { "data":
                                { "addr": 5368709120,
                                  "hotpluggable": true,
                                  "hotplugged": true,
                                  "id": "d1",
                                  "memdev": "/objects/memX",
                                  "node": 0,
                                  "size": 1073741824,
                                  "slot": 0},
                             "type": "dimm"
                           } ] }

   MEMORY_DEVICE_SIZE_CHANGE (Event)
       Emitted when the size of a memory device changes. Only emitted for memory devices that can
       actually change the size (e.g., virtio-mem due to guest action).

   Arguments
       id: string (optional)
              device's ID

       size: int
              the new size of memory that the device provides

       qom-path: string
              path to the device object in the QOM tree (since 6.2)

   Note
       this event is rate-limited.

   Since
       5.1

   Example
          <- { "event": "MEMORY_DEVICE_SIZE_CHANGE",
               "data": { "id": "vm0", "size": 1073741824},
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1588168529, "microseconds": 201316 } }

   MEM_UNPLUG_ERROR (Event)
       Emitted when memory hot unplug error occurs.

   Arguments
       device: string
              device name

       msg: string
              Informative message

   Features
       deprecated
              This event is deprecated. Use DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR instead.

   Since
       2.4

   Example
          <- { "event": "MEM_UNPLUG_ERROR"
               "data": { "device": "dimm1",
                         "msg": "acpi: device unplug for unsupported device"
               },
               "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

   SMPConfiguration (Object)
       Schema for CPU topology configuration.  A missing value lets QEMU figure  out  a  suitable
       value based on the ones that are provided.

   Members
       cpus: int (optional)
              number of virtual CPUs in the virtual machine

       sockets: int (optional)
              number of sockets in the CPU topology

       dies: int (optional)
              number of dies per socket in the CPU topology

       cores: int (optional)
              number of cores per die in the CPU topology

       threads: int (optional)
              number of threads per core in the CPU topology

       maxcpus: int (optional)
              maximum number of hotpluggable virtual CPUs in the virtual machine

   Since
       6.1

   x-query-irq (Command)
       Query interrupt statistics

   Features
       unstable
              This command is meant for debugging.

   Returns
       interrupt statistics

   Since
       6.2

   x-query-jit (Command)
       Query TCG compiler statistics

   Features
       unstable
              This command is meant for debugging.

   Returns
       TCG compiler statistics

   Since
       6.2

   If
       CONFIG_TCG

   x-query-numa (Command)
       Query NUMA topology information

   Features
       unstable
              This command is meant for debugging.

   Returns
       topology information

   Since
       6.2

   x-query-opcount (Command)
       Query TCG opcode counters

   Features
       unstable
              This command is meant for debugging.

   Returns
       TCG opcode counters

   Since
       6.2

   If
       CONFIG_TCG

   x-query-profile (Command)
       Query TCG profiling information

   Features
       unstable
              This command is meant for debugging.

   Returns
       profile information

   Since
       6.2

   x-query-ramblock (Command)
       Query system ramblock information

   Features
       unstable
              This command is meant for debugging.

   Returns
       system ramblock information

   Since
       6.2

   x-query-rdma (Command)
       Query RDMA state

   Features
       unstable
              This command is meant for debugging.

   Returns
       RDMA state

   Since
       6.2

   x-query-roms (Command)
       Query information on the registered ROMS

   Features
       unstable
              This command is meant for debugging.

   Returns
       registered ROMs

   Since
       6.2

   x-query-usb (Command)
       Query information on the USB devices

   Features
       unstable
              This command is meant for debugging.

   Returns
       USB device information

   Since
       6.2

   CpuModelInfo (Object)
       Virtual CPU model.

       A  CPU  model consists of the name of a CPU definition, to which delta changes are applied
       (e.g. features added/removed). Most magic values that an architecture might require should
       be  hidden  behind  the  name.   However,  if  required, architectures can expose relevant
       properties.

   Members
       name: string
              the name of the CPU definition the model is based on

       props: value (optional)
              a dictionary of QOM properties to be applied

   Since
       2.8

   CpuModelExpansionType (Enum)
       An enumeration of CPU model expansion types.

   Values
       static Expand to a static CPU model, a  combination  of  a  static  base  model  name  and
              property  delta  changes.  As the static base model will never change, the expanded
              CPU model will be the same, independent of  QEMU  version,  machine  type,  machine
              options,  and  accelerator  options.  Therefore, the resulting model can be used by
              tooling without having to specify a compatibility machine -  e.g.  when  displaying
              the "host" model. The static CPU models are migration-safe.

       full   Expand  all  properties. The produced model is not guaranteed to be migration-safe,
              but allows tooling to get an insight and work with model details.

   Note
       When a non-migration-safe CPU model is expanded in static mode, some features  enabled  by
       the  CPU  model  may  be  omitted, because they can't be implemented by a static CPU model
       definition (e.g. cache info passthrough and PMU  passthrough  in  x86).  If  you  need  an
       accurate  representation  of  the  features enabled by a non-migration-safe CPU model, use
       full. If you need a static representation that  will  keep  ABI  compatibility  even  when
       changing QEMU version or machine-type, use static (but keep in mind that some features may
       be omitted).

   Since
       2.8

   CpuModelCompareResult (Enum)
       An enumeration of CPU model comparison results. The result  is  usually  calculated  using
       e.g. CPU features or CPU generations.

   Values
       incompatible
              If model A is incompatible to model B, model A is not guaranteed to run where model
              B runs and the other way around.

       identical
              If model A is identical to model B, model A is guaranteed to run where model B runs
              and the other way around.

       superset
              If  model  A  is  a superset of model B, model B is guaranteed to run where model A
              runs. There are no guarantees about the other way.

       subset If model A is a subset of model B, model A is guaranteed to run where model B runs.
              There are no guarantees about the other way.

   Since
       2.8

   CpuModelBaselineInfo (Object)
       The result of a CPU model baseline.

   Members
       model: CpuModelInfo
              the baselined CpuModelInfo.

   Since
       2.8

   If
       TARGET_S390X

   CpuModelCompareInfo (Object)
       The result of a CPU model comparison.

   Members
       result: CpuModelCompareResult
              The result of the compare operation.

       responsible-properties: array of string
              List of properties that led to the comparison result not being identical.
       responsible-properties  is  a  list  of QOM property names that led to both CPUs not being
       detected as identical. For identical models, this list is empty.  If  a  QOM  property  is
       read-only,  that  means  there's  no  known  way  to make the CPU models identical. If the
       special property name "type" is included, the models are by definition not  identical  and
       cannot be made identical.

   Since
       2.8

   If
       TARGET_S390X

   query-cpu-model-comparison (Command)
       Compares  two  CPU  models,  returning  how  they compare in a specific configuration. The
       results indicates how both models compare regarding runnability. This result can  be  used
       by tooling to make decisions if a certain CPU model will run in a certain configuration or
       if a compatible CPU model has to be created by baselining.

       Usually, a CPU model is compared against the maximum  possible  CPU  model  of  a  certain
       configuration (e.g. the "host" model for KVM). If that CPU model is identical or a subset,
       it will run in that configuration.

       The result returned by this command may be affected by:

       • QEMU version: CPU models may look different depending on the QEMU version.  (Except  for
         CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

       • machine-type:  CPU  model may look different depending on the machine-type.  (Except for
         CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

       • machine options (including accelerator): in some  architectures,  CPU  models  may  look
         different  depending on machine and accelerator options. (Except for CPU models reported
         as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

       • "-cpu" arguments and  global  properties:  arguments  to  the  -cpu  option  and  global
         properties  may  affect  expansion  of CPU models. Using query-cpu-model-expansion while
         using these is not advised.

       Some architectures may not support comparing CPU  models.  s390x  supports  comparing  CPU
       models.

   Arguments
       modela: CpuModelInfo
              Not documented

       modelb: CpuModelInfo
              Not documented

   Returns
       a  CpuModelBaselineInfo.  Returns  an error if comparing CPU models is not supported, if a
       model cannot be used, if  a  model  contains  an  unknown  cpu  definition  name,  unknown
       properties or properties with wrong types.

   Note
       this  command  isn't  specific  to  s390x,  but  is  only implemented on this architecture
       currently.

   Since
       2.8

   If
       TARGET_S390X

   query-cpu-model-baseline (Command)
       Baseline two CPU models, creating a compatible third model. The created model will  always
       be a static, migration-safe CPU model (see "static" CPU model expansion for details).

       This interface can be used by tooling to create a compatible CPU model out two CPU models.
       The created CPU model will be identical to or a subset of both CPU models  when  comparing
       them.  Therefore,  the  created  CPU model is guaranteed to run where the given CPU models
       run.

       The result returned by this command may be affected by:

       • QEMU version: CPU models may look different depending on the QEMU version.  (Except  for
         CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

       • machine-type:  CPU  model may look different depending on the machine-type.  (Except for
         CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

       • machine options (including accelerator): in some  architectures,  CPU  models  may  look
         different  depending on machine and accelerator options. (Except for CPU models reported
         as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

       • "-cpu" arguments and  global  properties:  arguments  to  the  -cpu  option  and  global
         properties  may  affect  expansion  of CPU models. Using query-cpu-model-expansion while
         using these is not advised.

       Some architectures may not support baselining CPU models. s390x  supports  baselining  CPU
       models.

   Arguments
       modela: CpuModelInfo
              Not documented

       modelb: CpuModelInfo
              Not documented

   Returns
       a  CpuModelBaselineInfo.  Returns an error if baselining CPU models is not supported, if a
       model cannot be used, if  a  model  contains  an  unknown  cpu  definition  name,  unknown
       properties or properties with wrong types.

   Note
       this  command  isn't  specific  to  s390x,  but  is  only implemented on this architecture
       currently.

   Since
       2.8

   If
       TARGET_S390X

   CpuModelExpansionInfo (Object)
       The result of a cpu model expansion.

   Members
       model: CpuModelInfo
              the expanded CpuModelInfo.

   Since
       2.8

   If
       TARGET_S390X or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_ARM

   query-cpu-model-expansion (Command)
       Expands a given CPU model (or  a  combination  of  CPU  model  +  additional  options)  to
       different  granularities,  allowing  tooling  to  get an understanding what a specific CPU
       model looks like in QEMU under a certain configuration.

       This interface can be used to query the "host" CPU model.

       The data returned by this command may be affected by:

       • QEMU version: CPU models may look different depending on the QEMU version.  (Except  for
         CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

       • machine-type:  CPU model  may look different depending on the machine-type.  (Except for
         CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

       • machine options (including accelerator): in some  architectures,  CPU  models  may  look
         different  depending on machine and accelerator options. (Except for CPU models reported
         as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

       • "-cpu" arguments and  global  properties:  arguments  to  the  -cpu  option  and  global
         properties  may  affect  expansion  of CPU models. Using query-cpu-model-expansion while
         using these is not advised.

       Some architectures may  not  support  all  expansion  types.  s390x  supports  "full"  and
       "static". Arm only supports "full".

   Arguments
       type: CpuModelExpansionType
              Not documented

       model: CpuModelInfo
              Not documented

   Returns
       a CpuModelExpansionInfo. Returns an error if expanding CPU models is not supported, if the
       model cannot be expanded, if the model contains an unknown CPU  definition  name,  unknown
       properties  or properties with a wrong type. Also returns an error if an expansion type is
       not supported.

   Since
       2.8

   If
       TARGET_S390X or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_ARM

   CpuDefinitionInfo (Object)
       Virtual CPU definition.

   Members
       name: string
              the name of the CPU definition

       migration-safe: boolean (optional)
              whether a CPU definition can be safely used for migration  in  combination  with  a
              QEMU  compatibility  machine  when  migrating  between  different QEMU versions and
              between hosts with different sets of (hardware or software)  capabilities.  If  not
              provided,  information  is  not  available  and  callers  should not assume the CPU
              definition to be migration-safe. (since 2.8)

       static: boolean
              whether a CPU definition is static and will not change depending on  QEMU  version,
              machine  type,  machine  options and accelerator options.  A static model is always
              migration-safe. (since 2.8)

       unavailable-features: array of string (optional)
              List of properties that prevent the CPU model from running  in  the  current  host.
              (since 2.8)

       typename: string
              Type  name  that  can  be used as argument to device-list-properties, to introspect
              properties configurable using -cpu or -global.  (since 2.9)

       alias-of: string (optional)
              Name of CPU model this model is an alias for.  The target of the  CPU  model  alias
              may  change  depending  on  the  machine  type.  Management software is supposed to
              translate CPU model aliases in the VM configuration, because aliases may stop being
              migration-safe in the future (since 4.1)

       deprecated: boolean
              If  true, this CPU model is deprecated and may be removed in in some future version
              of QEMU according to the QEMU deprecation policy. (since 5.2)
       unavailable-features is a list of QOM property names that represent CPU  model  attributes
       that  prevent  the CPU from running.  If the QOM property is read-only, that means there's
       no known way to make the CPU model run in the current host.  Implementations  that  choose
       not  to  provide specific information return the property name "type".  If the property is
       read-write, it means that it MAY be possible to run the CPU model in the current  host  if
       that  property is changed. Management software can use it as hints to suggest or choose an
       alternative for the user, or just to generate meaningful error messages explaining why the
       CPU  model  can't  be  used.   If  unavailable-features is an empty list, the CPU model is
       runnable using the current host and machine-type.  If unavailable-features is not present,
       runnability information for the CPU is not available.

   Since
       1.2

   If
       TARGET_PPC or TARGET_ARM or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_S390X or TARGET_MIPS

   query-cpu-definitions (Command)
       Return a list of supported virtual CPU definitions

   Returns
       a list of CpuDefInfo

   Since
       1.2

   If
       TARGET_PPC or TARGET_ARM or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_S390X or TARGET_MIPS

RECORD/REPLAY

   ReplayMode (Enum)
       Mode of the replay subsystem.

   Values
       none   normal execution mode. Replay or record are not enabled.

       record record mode. All non-deterministic data is written into the replay log.

       play   replay  mode. Non-deterministic data required for system execution is read from the
              log.

   Since
       2.5

   ReplayInfo (Object)
       Record/replay information.

   Members
       mode: ReplayMode
              current mode.

       filename: string (optional)
              name of the record/replay log file.  It is present only in record or replay  modes,
              when the log is recorded or replayed.

       icount: int
              current number of executed instructions.

   Since
       5.2

   query-replay (Command)
       Retrieve  the  record/replay information.  It includes current instruction count which may
       be used for replay-break and replay-seek commands.

   Returns
       record/replay information.

   Since
       5.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-replay" }
          <- { "return": { "mode": "play", "filename": "log.rr", "icount": 220414 } }

   replay-break (Command)
       Set replay breakpoint at instruction count icount.  Execution  stops  when  the  specified
       instruction  is reached.  There can be at most one breakpoint. When breakpoint is set, any
       prior one is removed.  The breakpoint may be set only in replay  mode  and  only  "in  the
       future", i.e. at instruction counts greater than the current one.  The current instruction
       count can be observed with query-replay.

   Arguments
       icount: int
              instruction count to stop at

   Since
       5.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "replay-break", "data": { "icount": 220414 } }

   replay-delete-break (Command)
       Remove replay breakpoint which was set with replay-break.  The  command  is  ignored  when
       there are no replay breakpoints.

   Since
       5.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "replay-delete-break" }

   replay-seek (Command)
       Automatically  proceed  to the instruction count icount, when replaying the execution. The
       command automatically loads nearest snapshot and replays the execution to find the desired
       instruction.   When  there is no preceding snapshot or the execution is not replayed, then
       the command fails.  icount for the reference may be obtained with query-replay command.

   Arguments
       icount: int
              target instruction count

   Since
       5.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "replay-seek", "data": { "icount": 220414 } }

YANK FEATURE

   YankInstanceType (Enum)
       An enumeration of yank instance types. See YankInstance for more information.

   Values
       block-node
              Not documented

       chardev
              Not documented

       migration
              Not documented

   Since
       6.0

   YankInstanceBlockNode (Object)
       Specifies which block graph node to yank. See YankInstance for more information.

   Members
       node-name: string
              the name of the block graph node

   Since
       6.0

   YankInstanceChardev (Object)
       Specifies which character device to yank. See YankInstance for more information.

   Members
       id: string
              the chardev's ID

   Since
       6.0

   YankInstance (Object)
       A yank instance can be yanked with the yank qmp command to recover from a hanging QEMU.

       Currently implemented yank instances:

              • nbd block device: Yanking it will shut down the  connection  to  the  nbd  server
                without attempting to reconnect.

              • socket chardev: Yanking it will shut down the connected socket.

              • migration:   Yanking   it  will  shut  down  all  migration  connections.  Unlike
                migrate_cancel, it will not notify the migration process, so  migration  will  go
                into  failed  state,  instead  of cancelled state. yank should be used to recover
                from hangs.

   Members
       type: YankInstanceType
              Not documented

       The members of YankInstanceBlockNode when type is "block-node"

       The members of YankInstanceChardev when type is "chardev"

   Since
       6.0

   yank (Command)
       Try to recover from hanging QEMU by yanking the specified instances. See YankInstance  for
       more information.

       Takes a list of YankInstance as argument.

   Arguments
       instances: array of YankInstance
              Not documented

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • DeviceNotFound error, if any of the YankInstances doesn't exist

   Example
          -> { "execute": "yank",
               "arguments": {
                   "instances": [
                        { "type": "block-node",
                          "node-name": "nbd0" }
                   ] } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   Since
       6.0

   query-yank (Command)
       Query yank instances. See YankInstance for more information.

   Returns
       list of YankInstance

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-yank" }
          <- { "return": [
                   { "type": "block-node",
                     "node-name": "nbd0" }
               ] }

   Since
       6.0

MISCELLANEA

   add_client (Command)
       Allow client connections for VNC, Spice and socket based character devices to be passed in
       to QEMU via SCM_RIGHTS.

   Arguments
       protocol: string
              protocol name. Valid names are "vnc", "spice" or the name  of  a  character  device
              (eg. from -chardev id=XXXX)

       fdname: string
              file descriptor name previously passed via 'getfd' command

       skipauth: boolean (optional)
              whether to skip authentication. Only applies to "vnc" and "spice" protocols

       tls: boolean (optional)
              whether to perform TLS. Only applies to the "spice" protocol

   Returns
       nothing on success.

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "add_client", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc",
                                                       "fdname": "myclient" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   NameInfo (Object)
       Guest name information.

   Members
       name: string (optional)
              The name of the guest

   Since
       0.14

   query-name (Command)
       Return the name information of a guest.

   Returns
       NameInfo of the guest

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-name" }
          <- { "return": { "name": "qemu-name" } }

   IOThreadInfo (Object)
       Information about an iothread

   Members
       id: string
              the identifier of the iothread

       thread-id: int
              ID of the underlying host thread

       poll-max-ns: int
              maximum polling time in ns, 0 means polling is disabled (since 2.9)

       poll-grow: int
              how  many ns will be added to polling time, 0 means that it's not configured (since
              2.9)

       poll-shrink: int
              how many ns will be removed from polling time, 0 means  that  it's  not  configured
              (since 2.9)

       aio-max-batch: int
              maximum  number  of requests in a batch for the AIO engine, 0 means that the engine
              will use its default (since 6.1)

   Since
       2.0

   query-iothreads (Command)
       Returns a list of information about each iothread.

   Note
       this list excludes the QEMU main loop thread, which is  not  declared  using  the  -object
       iothread command-line option.  It is always the main thread of the process.

   Returns
       a list of IOThreadInfo for each iothread

   Since
       2.0

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-iothreads" }
          <- { "return": [
                   {
                      "id":"iothread0",
                      "thread-id":3134
                   },
                   {
                      "id":"iothread1",
                      "thread-id":3135
                   }
                ]
             }

   stop (Command)
       Stop all guest VCPU execution.

   Since
       0.14

   Notes
       This  function  will  succeed  even  if  the  guest  is  already in the stopped state.  In
       "inmigrate" state, it will ensure that the guest remains paused once  migration  finishes,
       as if the -S option was passed on the command line.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "stop" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   cont (Command)
       Resume guest VCPU execution.

   Since
       0.14

   Returns
       If successful, nothing

   Notes
       This  command will succeed if the guest is currently running.  It will also succeed if the
       guest is in the "inmigrate" state; in this case, the effect of the command is to make sure
       the  guest  starts  once  migration  finishes,  removing the effect of the -S command line
       option if it was passed.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "cont" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   x-exit-preconfig (Command)
       Exit from "preconfig" state

       This command makes QEMU exit the preconfig state and proceed with VM initialization  using
       configuration  data  provided  on  the  command  line  and  via the QMP monitor during the
       preconfig state. The command is only available during the preconfig state (i.e.  when  the
       --preconfig command line option was in use).

   Features
       unstable
              This command is experimental.
       Since 3.0

   Returns
       nothing

   Example
          -> { "execute": "x-exit-preconfig" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   human-monitor-command (Command)
       Execute a command on the human monitor and return the output.

   Arguments
       command-line: string
              the command to execute in the human monitor

       cpu-index: int (optional)
              The CPU to use for commands that require an implicit CPU

   Features
       savevm-monitor-nodes
              If  present,  HMP command savevm only snapshots monitor-owned nodes if they have no
              parents.  This allows the use of 'savevm' with -blockdev. (since 4.2)

   Returns
       the output of the command as a string

   Since
       0.14

   Notes
       This command only exists as a stop-gap.  Its use is highly discouraged.  The semantics  of
       this  command  are  not guaranteed: this means that command names, arguments and responses
       can change or be removed at ANY time.  Applications  that  rely  on  long  term  stability
       guarantees should NOT use this command.

       Known limitations:

       • This  command  is  stateless,  this means that commands that depend on state information
         (such as getfd) might not work

       • Commands that prompt the user for data don't currently work

   Example
          -> { "execute": "human-monitor-command",
               "arguments": { "command-line": "info kvm" } }
          <- { "return": "kvm support: enabled\r\n" }

   getfd (Command)
       Receive a file descriptor via SCM rights and assign it a name

   Arguments
       fdname: string
              file descriptor name

   Returns
       Nothing on success

   Since
       0.14

   Notes
       If fdname already exists, the file descriptor assigned to it will be closed  and  replaced
       by the received file descriptor.

       The  'closefd'  command  can be used to explicitly close the file descriptor when it is no
       longer needed.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "getfd", "arguments": { "fdname": "fd1" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   closefd (Command)
       Close a file descriptor previously passed via SCM rights

   Arguments
       fdname: string
              file descriptor name

   Returns
       Nothing on success

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "closefd", "arguments": { "fdname": "fd1" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   AddfdInfo (Object)
       Information about a file descriptor that was added to an fd set.

   Members
       fdset-id: int
              The ID of the fd set that fd was added to.

       fd: int
              The file descriptor that was received via SCM rights and added to the fd set.

   Since
       1.2

   add-fd (Command)
       Add a file descriptor, that was passed via SCM rights, to an fd set.

   Arguments
       fdset-id: int (optional)
              The ID of the fd set to add the file descriptor to.

       opaque: string (optional)
              A free-form string that can be used to describe the fd.

   ReturnsAddfdInfo on success

       • If file descriptor was not received, FdNotSupplied

       • If fdset-id is a negative value, InvalidParameterValue

   Notes
       The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections.

       If fdset-id is not specified, a new fd set will be created.

   Since
       1.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "add-fd", "arguments": { "fdset-id": 1 } }
          <- { "return": { "fdset-id": 1, "fd": 3 } }

   remove-fd (Command)
       Remove a file descriptor from an fd set.

   Arguments
       fdset-id: int
              The ID of the fd set that the file descriptor belongs to.

       fd: int (optional)
              The file descriptor that is to be removed.

   Returns
       • Nothing on success

       • If fdset-id or fd is not found, FdNotFound

   Since
       1.2

   Notes
       The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections.

       If fd is not specified, all file descriptors in fdset-id will be removed.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "remove-fd", "arguments": { "fdset-id": 1, "fd": 3 } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   FdsetFdInfo (Object)
       Information about a file descriptor that belongs to an fd set.

   Members
       fd: int
              The file descriptor value.

       opaque: string (optional)
              A free-form string that can be used to describe the fd.

   Since
       1.2

   FdsetInfo (Object)
       Information about an fd set.

   Members
       fdset-id: int
              The ID of the fd set.

       fds: array of FdsetFdInfo
              A list of file descriptors that belong to this fd set.

   Since
       1.2

   query-fdsets (Command)
       Return information describing all fd sets.

   Returns
       A list of FdsetInfo

   Since
       1.2

   Note
       The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections.

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-fdsets" }
          <- { "return": [
                 {
                   "fds": [
                     {
                       "fd": 30,
                       "opaque": "rdonly:/path/to/file"
                     },
                     {
                       "fd": 24,
                       "opaque": "rdwr:/path/to/file"
                     }
                   ],
                   "fdset-id": 1
                 },
                 {
                   "fds": [
                     {
                       "fd": 28
                     },
                     {
                       "fd": 29
                     }
                   ],
                   "fdset-id": 0
                 }
               ]
             }

   CommandLineParameterType (Enum)
       Possible types for an option parameter.

   Values
       string accepts a character string

       boolean
              accepts "on" or "off"

       number accepts a number

       size   accepts a number followed by an optional suffix (K)ilo, (M)ega, (G)iga, (T)era

   Since
       1.5

   CommandLineParameterInfo (Object)
       Details about a single parameter of a command line option.

   Members
       name: string
              parameter name

       type: CommandLineParameterType
              parameter CommandLineParameterType

       help: string (optional)
              human readable text string, not suitable for parsing.

       default: string (optional)
              default value string (since 2.1)

   Since
       1.5

   CommandLineOptionInfo (Object)
       Details about a command line option, including its list of parameter details

   Members
       option: string
              option name

       parameters: array of CommandLineParameterInfo
              an array of CommandLineParameterInfo

   Since
       1.5

   query-command-line-options (Command)
       Query command line option schema.

   Arguments
       option: string (optional)
              option name

   Returns
       list of CommandLineOptionInfo for all options (or for the given option).  Returns an error
       if the given option doesn't exist.

   Since
       1.5

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-command-line-options",
               "arguments": { "option": "option-rom" } }
          <- { "return": [
                  {
                      "parameters": [
                          {
                              "name": "romfile",
                              "type": "string"
                          },
                          {
                              "name": "bootindex",
                              "type": "number"
                          }
                      ],
                      "option": "option-rom"
                  }
               ]
             }

   RTC_CHANGE (Event)
       Emitted when the guest changes the RTC time.

   Arguments
       offset: int
              offset between base RTC clock (as specified by -rtc base), and new RTC clock value

   Note
       This event is rate-limited.

   Since
       0.13

   Example
          <-   { "event": "RTC_CHANGE",
                 "data": { "offset": 78 },
                 "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267020223, "microseconds": 435656 } }

   If
       TARGET_ALPHA  or  TARGET_ARM or TARGET_HPPA or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_MIPS or TARGET_MIPS64
       or TARGET_PPC or TARGET_PPC64 or TARGET_S390X or TARGET_SH4 or TARGET_SPARC

   rtc-reset-reinjection (Command)
       This command will reset the RTC interrupt reinjection backlog.  Can  be  used  if  another
       mechanism  to  synchronize  guest  time  is  in  effect,  for  example  QEMU guest agent's
       guest-set-time command.

   Since
       2.1

   Example
          -> { "execute": "rtc-reset-reinjection" }
          <- { "return": {} }

   If
       TARGET_I386

   SevState (Enum)
       An enumeration of SEV state information used during query-sev.

   Values
       uninit The guest is uninitialized.

       launch-update
              The guest is currently being launched; plaintext data and register state  is  being
              imported.

       launch-secret
              The guest is currently being launched; ciphertext data is being imported.

       running
              The guest is fully launched or migrated in.

       send-update
              The guest is currently being migrated out to another machine.

       receive-update
              The guest is currently being migrated from another machine.

   Since
       2.12

   If
       TARGET_I386

   SevInfo (Object)
       Information about Secure Encrypted Virtualization (SEV) support

   Members
       enabled: boolean
              true if SEV is active

       api-major: int
              SEV API major version

       api-minor: int
              SEV API minor version

       build-id: int
              SEV FW build id

       policy: int
              SEV policy value

       state: SevState
              SEV guest state

       handle: int
              SEV firmware handle

   Since
       2.12

   If
       TARGET_I386

   query-sev (Command)
       Returns information about SEV

   Returns
       SevInfo

   Since
       2.12

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-sev" }
          <- { "return": { "enabled": true, "api-major" : 0, "api-minor" : 0,
                           "build-id" : 0, "policy" : 0, "state" : "running",
                           "handle" : 1 } }

   If
       TARGET_I386

   SevLaunchMeasureInfo (Object)
       SEV Guest Launch measurement information

   Members
       data: string
              the measurement value encoded in base64

   Since
       2.12

   If
       TARGET_I386

   query-sev-launch-measure (Command)
       Query the SEV guest launch information.

   Returns
       The SevLaunchMeasureInfo for the guest

   Since
       2.12

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-sev-launch-measure" }
          <- { "return": { "data": "4l8LXeNlSPUDlXPJG5966/8%YZ" } }

   If
       TARGET_I386

   SevCapability (Object)
       The struct describes capability for a Secure Encrypted Virtualization feature.

   Members
       pdh: string
              Platform Diffie-Hellman key (base64 encoded)

       cert-chain: string
              PDH certificate chain (base64 encoded)

       cbitpos: int
              C-bit location in page table entry

       reduced-phys-bits: int
              Number of physical Address bit reduction when SEV is enabled

   Since
       2.12

   If
       TARGET_I386

   query-sev-capabilities (Command)
       This  command  is  used to get the SEV capabilities, and is supported on AMD X86 platforms
       only.

   Returns
       SevCapability objects.

   Since
       2.12

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-sev-capabilities" }
          <- { "return": { "pdh": "8CCDD8DDD", "cert-chain": "888CCCDDDEE",
                           "cbitpos": 47, "reduced-phys-bits": 5}}

   If
       TARGET_I386

   sev-inject-launch-secret (Command)
       This command injects a secret blob into memory of SEV guest.

   Arguments
       packet-header: string
              the launch secret packet header encoded in base64

       secret: string
              the launch secret data to be injected encoded in base64

       gpa: int (optional)
              the guest physical address where secret will be injected.

   Since
       6.0

   If
       TARGET_I386

   SevAttestationReport (Object)
       The struct describes attestation report for a Secure Encrypted Virtualization feature.

   Members
       data: string
              guest attestation report (base64 encoded)

   Since
       6.1

   If
       TARGET_I386

   query-sev-attestation-report (Command)
       This command is used to get the SEV attestation  report,  and  is  supported  on  AMD  X86
       platforms only.

   Arguments
       mnonce: string
              a random 16 bytes value encoded in base64 (it will be included in report)

   Returns
       SevAttestationReport objects.

   Since
       6.1

   Example
          -> { "execute" : "query-sev-attestation-report",
                           "arguments": { "mnonce": "aaaaaaa" } }
          <- { "return" : { "data": "aaaaaaaabbbddddd"} }

   If
       TARGET_I386

   dump-skeys (Command)
       Dump guest's storage keys

   Arguments
       filename: string
              the path to the file to dump to
       This command is only supported on s390 architecture.

   Since
       2.5

   Example
          -> { "execute": "dump-skeys",
               "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/skeys" } }
          <- { "return": {} }

   If
       TARGET_S390X

   GICCapability (Object)
       The struct describes capability for a specific GIC (Generic Interrupt Controller) version.
       These bits are not only decided by QEMU/KVM software version,  but  also  decided  by  the
       hardware that the program is running upon.

   Members
       version: int
              version of GIC to be described. Currently, only 2 and 3 are supported.

       emulated: boolean
              whether current QEMU/hardware supports emulated GIC device in user space.

       kernel: boolean
              whether current QEMU/hardware supports hardware accelerated GIC device in kernel.

   Since
       2.6

   If
       TARGET_ARM

   query-gic-capabilities (Command)
       This command is ARM-only. It will return a list of GICCapability objects that describe its
       capability bits.

   Returns
       a list of GICCapability objects.

   Since
       2.6

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-gic-capabilities" }
          <- { "return": [{ "version": 2, "emulated": true, "kernel": false },
                          { "version": 3, "emulated": false, "kernel": true } ] }

   If
       TARGET_ARM

   SGXInfo (Object)
       Information about intel Safe Guard eXtension (SGX) support

   Members
       sgx: boolean
              true if SGX is supported

       sgx1: boolean
              true if SGX1 is supported

       sgx2: boolean
              true if SGX2 is supported

       flc: boolean
              true if FLC is supported

       section-size: int
              The EPC section size for guest

   Since
       6.2

   If
       TARGET_I386

   query-sgx (Command)
       Returns information about SGX

   Returns
       SGXInfo

   Since
       6.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-sgx" }
          <- { "return": { "sgx": true, "sgx1" : true, "sgx2" : true,
                           "flc": true, "section-size" : 0 } }

   If
       TARGET_I386

   query-sgx-capabilities (Command)
       Returns information from host SGX capabilities

   Returns
       SGXInfo

   Since
       6.2

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-sgx-capabilities" }
          <- { "return": { "sgx": true, "sgx1" : true, "sgx2" : true,
                           "flc": true, "section-size" : 0 } }

   If
       TARGET_I386

AUDIO

   AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (Object)
       General audio backend options that are used for both playback and recording.

   Members
       mixing-engine: boolean (optional)
              use QEMU's mixing engine to mix all streams inside QEMU and convert  audio  formats
              when not supported by the backend. When set to off, fixed-settings must be also off
              (default on, since 4.2)

       fixed-settings: boolean (optional)
              use fixed settings for host input/output. When off, frequency, channels and  format
              must not be specified (default true)

       frequency: int (optional)
              frequency to use when using fixed settings (default 44100)

       channels: int (optional)
              number of channels when using fixed settings (default 2)

       voices: int (optional)
              number of voices to use (default 1)

       format: AudioFormat (optional)
              sample format to use when using fixed settings (default s16)

       buffer-length: int (optional)
              the buffer length in microseconds

   Since
       4.0

   AudiodevGenericOptions (Object)
       Generic driver-specific options.

   Members
       in: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the capture stream

       out: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the playback stream

   Since
       4.0

   AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions (Object)
       Options of the ALSA backend that are used for both playback and recording.

   Members
       dev: string (optional)
              the name of the ALSA device to use (default 'default')

       period-length: int (optional)
              the period length in microseconds

       try-poll: boolean (optional)
              attempt  to  use  poll mode, falling back to non-polling access on failure (default
              true)

       The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions

   Since
       4.0

   AudiodevAlsaOptions (Object)
       Options of the ALSA audio backend.

   Members
       in: AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the capture stream

       out: AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the playback stream

       threshold: int (optional)
              set the threshold (in microseconds) when playback starts

   Since
       4.0

   AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions (Object)
       Options of the Core Audio backend that are used for both playback and recording.

   Members
       buffer-count: int (optional)
              number of buffers

       The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions

   Since
       4.0

   AudiodevCoreaudioOptions (Object)
       Options of the coreaudio audio backend.

   Members
       in: AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the capture stream

       out: AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the playback stream

   Since
       4.0

   AudiodevDsoundOptions (Object)
       Options of the DirectSound audio backend.

   Members
       in: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the capture stream

       out: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the playback stream

       latency: int (optional)
              add extra latency to playback in microseconds (default 10000)

   Since
       4.0

   AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions (Object)
       Options of the JACK backend that are used for both playback and recording.

   Members
       server-name: string (optional)
              select  from  among  several  possible  concurrent   server   instances   (default:
              environment variable $JACK_DEFAULT_SERVER if set, else "default")

       client-name: string (optional)
              the  client  name  to  use.  The  server  will  modify this name to create a unique
              variant, if needed unless exact-name is true (default: the guest's name)

       connect-ports: string (optional)
              if set, a regular expression of  JACK  client  port  name(s)  to  monitor  for  and
              automatically connect to

       start-server: boolean (optional)
              start a jack server process if one is not already present (default: false)

       exact-name: boolean (optional)
              use  the  exact name requested otherwise JACK automatically generates a unique one,
              if needed (default: false)

       The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions

   Since
       5.1

   AudiodevJackOptions (Object)
       Options of the JACK audio backend.

   Members
       in: AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the capture stream

       out: AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the playback stream

   Since
       5.1

   AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions (Object)
       Options of the OSS backend that are used for both playback and recording.

   Members
       dev: string (optional)
              file name of the OSS device (default '/dev/dsp')

       buffer-count: int (optional)
              number of buffers

       try-poll: boolean (optional)
              attempt to use poll mode, falling back to non-polling access  on  failure  (default
              true)

       The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions

   Since
       4.0

   AudiodevOssOptions (Object)
       Options of the OSS audio backend.

   Members
       in: AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the capture stream

       out: AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the playback stream

       try-mmap: boolean (optional)
              try using memory-mapped access, falling back to non-memory-mapped access on failure
              (default true)

       exclusive: boolean (optional)
              open device in exclusive mode (vmix won't work) (default false)

       dsp-policy: int (optional)
              set the timing policy of the device (between 0 and 10, where smaller  number  means
              smaller latency but higher CPU usage) or -1 to use fragment mode (option ignored on
              some platforms) (default 5)

   Since
       4.0

   AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions (Object)
       Options of the Pulseaudio backend that are used for both playback and recording.

   Members
       name: string (optional)
              name of the sink/source to use

       stream-name: string (optional)
              name of the PulseAudio stream created by qemu.  Can be used to identify the  stream
              in  PulseAudio  when  you  create  multiple PulseAudio devices or run multiple qemu
              instances (default: audiodev's id, since 4.2)

       latency: int (optional)
              latency you want PulseAudio to achieve in microseconds (default 15000)

       The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions

   Since
       4.0

   AudiodevPaOptions (Object)
       Options of the PulseAudio audio backend.

   Members
       in: AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the capture stream

       out: AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the playback stream

       server: string (optional)
              PulseAudio server address (default: let PulseAudio choose)

   Since
       4.0

   AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions (Object)
       Options of the SDL audio backend that are used for both playback and recording.

   Members
       buffer-count: int (optional)
              number of buffers (default 4)

       The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions

   Since
       6.0

   AudiodevSdlOptions (Object)
       Options of the SDL audio backend.

   Members
       in: AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the recording stream

       out: AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the playback stream

   Since
       6.0

   AudiodevWavOptions (Object)
       Options of the wav audio backend.

   Members
       in: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the capture stream

       out: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
              options of the playback stream

       path: string (optional)
              name of the wav file to record (default 'qemu.wav')

   Since
       4.0

   AudioFormat (Enum)
       An enumeration of possible audio formats.

   Values
       u8     unsigned 8 bit integer

       s8     signed 8 bit integer

       u16    unsigned 16 bit integer

       s16    signed 16 bit integer

       u32    unsigned 32 bit integer

       s32    signed 32 bit integer

       f32    single precision floating-point (since 5.0)

   Since
       4.0

   AudiodevDriver (Enum)
       An enumeration of possible audio backend drivers.

   Values
       jack   JACK audio backend (since 5.1)

       none   Not documented

       alsa   Not documented

       coreaudio
              Not documented

       dsound Not documented

       oss    Not documented

       pa     Not documented

       sdl    Not documented

       spice  Not documented

       wav    Not documented

   Since
       4.0

   Audiodev (Object)
       Options of an audio backend.

   Members
       id: string
              identifier of the backend

       driver: AudiodevDriver
              the backend driver to use

       timer-period: int (optional)
              timer period (in microseconds, 0: use lowest possible)

       The members of AudiodevGenericOptions when driver is "none"

       The members of AudiodevAlsaOptions when driver is "alsa"

       The members of AudiodevCoreaudioOptions when driver is "coreaudio"

       The members of AudiodevDsoundOptions when driver is "dsound"

       The members of AudiodevJackOptions when driver is "jack"

       The members of AudiodevOssOptions when driver is "oss"

       The members of AudiodevPaOptions when driver is "pa"

       The members of AudiodevSdlOptions when driver is "sdl"

       The members of AudiodevGenericOptions when driver is "spice"

       The members of AudiodevWavOptions when driver is "wav"

   Since
       4.0

ACPI

   AcpiTableOptions (Object)
       Specify an ACPI table on the command line to load.

       At most one of file and data can be specified. The list of files specified by any  one  of
       them is loaded and concatenated in order. If both are omitted, data is implied.

       Other  fields  /  optargs can be used to override fields of the generic ACPI table header;
       refer to the ACPI specification 5.0, section 5.2.6 System Description Table Header.  If  a
       header field is not overridden, then the corresponding value from the concatenated blob is
       used (in case of file), or it is filled in with a hard-coded value (in case of data).

       String fields are copied into the matching ACPI member from lowest  address  upwards,  and
       silently truncated / NUL-padded to length.

   Members
       sig: string (optional)
              table signature / identifier (4 bytes)

       rev: int (optional)
              table revision number (dependent on signature, 1 byte)

       oem_id: string (optional)
              OEM identifier (6 bytes)

       oem_table_id: string (optional)
              OEM table identifier (8 bytes)

       oem_rev: int (optional)
              OEM-supplied revision number (4 bytes)

       asl_compiler_id: string (optional)
              identifier of the utility that created the table (4 bytes)

       asl_compiler_rev: int (optional)
              revision number of the utility that created the table (4 bytes)

       file: string (optional)
              colon  (:)  separated  list of pathnames to load and concatenate as table data. The
              resultant binary blob is expected to have an ACPI table header. At least  one  file
              is required. This field excludes data.

       data: string (optional)
              colon  (:)  separated  list of pathnames to load and concatenate as table data. The
              resultant binary blob must not have an ACPI table header.  At  least  one  file  is
              required. This field excludes file.

   Since
       1.5

   ACPISlotType (Enum)
   Values
       DIMM   memory slot

       CPU    logical CPU slot (since 2.7)

   ACPIOSTInfo (Object)
       OSPM  Status  Indication  for  a  device  For description of possible values of source and
       status fields see "_OST (OSPM Status Indication)" chapter of ACPI5.0 spec.

   Members
       device: string (optional)
              device ID associated with slot

       slot: string
              slot ID, unique per slot of a given slot-type

       slot-type: ACPISlotType
              type of the slot

       source: int
              an integer containing the source event

       status: int
              an integer containing the status code

   Since
       2.1

   query-acpi-ospm-status (Command)
       Return a list of ACPIOSTInfo for devices that  support  status  reporting  via  ACPI  _OST
       method.

   Since
       2.1

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-acpi-ospm-status" }
          <- { "return": [ { "device": "d1", "slot": "0", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 1, "status": 0},
                           { "slot": "1", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0},
                           { "slot": "2", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0},
                           { "slot": "3", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0}
             ]}

   ACPI_DEVICE_OST (Event)
       Emitted when guest executes ACPI _OST method.

   Arguments
       info: ACPIOSTInfo
              OSPM Status Indication

   Since
       2.1

   Example
          <- { "event": "ACPI_DEVICE_OST",
               "data": { "device": "d1", "slot": "0",
                         "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 1, "status": 0 } }

PCI

   PciMemoryRange (Object)
       A PCI device memory region

   Members
       base: int
              the starting address (guest physical)

       limit: int
              the ending address (guest physical)

   Since
       0.14

   PciMemoryRegion (Object)
       Information about a PCI device I/O region.

   Members
       bar: int
              the index of the Base Address Register for this region

       type: string

              • 'io' if the region is a PIO region

              • 'memory' if the region is a MMIO region

       size: int
              memory size

       prefetch: boolean (optional)
              if type is 'memory', true if the memory is prefetchable

       mem_type_64: boolean (optional)
              if type is 'memory', true if the BAR is 64-bit

       address: int
              Not documented

   Since
       0.14

   PciBusInfo (Object)
       Information about a bus of a PCI Bridge device

   Members
       number: int
              primary  bus  interface  number.   This  should be the number of the bus the device
              resides on.

       secondary: int
              secondary bus interface number.  This is the number of the main bus for the bridge

       subordinate: int
              This is the highest number bus that resides below the bridge.

       io_range: PciMemoryRange
              The PIO range for all devices on this bridge

       memory_range: PciMemoryRange
              The MMIO range for all devices on this bridge

       prefetchable_range: PciMemoryRange
              The range of prefetchable MMIO for all devices on this bridge

   Since
       2.4

   PciBridgeInfo (Object)
       Information about a PCI Bridge device

   Members
       bus: PciBusInfo
              information about the bus the device resides on

       devices: array of PciDeviceInfo (optional)
              a list of PciDeviceInfo for each device on this bridge

   Since
       0.14

   PciDeviceClass (Object)
       Information about the Class of a PCI device

   Members
       desc: string (optional)
              a string description of the device's class

       class: int
              the class code of the device

   Since
       2.4

   PciDeviceId (Object)
       Information about the Id of a PCI device

   Members
       device: int
              the PCI device id

       vendor: int
              the PCI vendor id

       subsystem: int (optional)
              the PCI subsystem id (since 3.1)

       subsystem-vendor: int (optional)
              the PCI subsystem vendor id (since 3.1)

   Since
       2.4

   PciDeviceInfo (Object)
       Information about a PCI device

   Members
       bus: int
              the bus number of the device

       slot: int
              the slot the device is located in

       function: int
              the function of the slot used by the device

       class_info: PciDeviceClass
              the class of the device

       id: PciDeviceId
              the PCI device id

       irq: int (optional)
              if an IRQ is assigned to the device, the IRQ number

       irq_pin: int
              the IRQ pin, zero means no IRQ (since 5.1)

       qdev_id: string
              the device name of the PCI device

       pci_bridge: PciBridgeInfo (optional)
              if the device is a PCI bridge, the bridge information

       regions: array of PciMemoryRegion
              a list of the PCI I/O regions associated with the device

   Notes
       the  contents  of  class_info.desc  are  not  stable  and  should  only  be   treated   as
       informational.

   Since
       0.14

   PciInfo (Object)
       Information about a PCI bus

   Members
       bus: int
              the bus index

       devices: array of PciDeviceInfo
              a list of devices on this bus

   Since
       0.14

   query-pci (Command)
       Return information about the PCI bus topology of the guest.

   Returns
       a  list of PciInfo for each PCI bus. Each bus is represented by a json-object, which has a
       key with a json-array of all PCI devices attached to it. Each device is represented  by  a
       json-object.

   Since
       0.14

   Example
          -> { "execute": "query-pci" }
          <- { "return": [
                   {
                      "bus": 0,
                      "devices": [
                         {
                            "bus": 0,
                            "qdev_id": "",
                            "slot": 0,
                            "class_info": {
                               "class": 1536,
                               "desc": "Host bridge"
                            },
                            "id": {
                               "device": 32902,
                               "vendor": 4663
                            },
                            "function": 0,
                            "regions": [
                            ]
                         },
                         {
                            "bus": 0,
                            "qdev_id": "",
                            "slot": 1,
                            "class_info": {
                               "class": 1537,
                               "desc": "ISA bridge"
                            },
                            "id": {
                               "device": 32902,
                               "vendor": 28672
                            },
                            "function": 0,
                            "regions": [
                            ]
                         },
                         {
                            "bus": 0,
                            "qdev_id": "",
                            "slot": 1,
                            "class_info": {
                               "class": 257,
                               "desc": "IDE controller"
                            },
                            "id": {
                               "device": 32902,
                               "vendor": 28688
                            },
                            "function": 1,
                            "regions": [
                               {
                                  "bar": 4,
                                  "size": 16,
                                  "address": 49152,
                                  "type": "io"
                               }
                            ]
                         },
                         {
                            "bus": 0,
                            "qdev_id": "",
                            "slot": 2,
                            "class_info": {
                               "class": 768,
                               "desc": "VGA controller"
                            },
                            "id": {
                               "device": 4115,
                               "vendor": 184
                            },
                            "function": 0,
                            "regions": [
                               {
                                  "prefetch": true,
                                  "mem_type_64": false,
                                  "bar": 0,
                                  "size": 33554432,
                                  "address": 4026531840,
                                  "type": "memory"
                               },
                               {
                                  "prefetch": false,
                                  "mem_type_64": false,
                                  "bar": 1,
                                  "size": 4096,
                                  "address": 4060086272,
                                  "type": "memory"
                               },
                               {
                                  "prefetch": false,
                                  "mem_type_64": false,
                                  "bar": 6,
                                  "size": 65536,
                                  "address": -1,
                                  "type": "memory"
                               }
                            ]
                         },
                         {
                            "bus": 0,
                            "qdev_id": "",
                            "irq": 11,
                            "slot": 4,
                            "class_info": {
                               "class": 1280,
                               "desc": "RAM controller"
                            },
                            "id": {
                               "device": 6900,
                               "vendor": 4098
                            },
                            "function": 0,
                            "regions": [
                               {
                                  "bar": 0,
                                  "size": 32,
                                  "address": 49280,
                                  "type": "io"
                               }
                            ]
                         }
                      ]
                   }
                ]
             }

   Note
       This example has been shortened as the real response is too long.

COPYRIGHT

       2024, The QEMU Project Developers